CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL FlightSafety International, Inc. Marine Air Terminal, LaGuardia Airport Flushing, New York 11371 (718) 565-4100 www.flightsafety.com Pilot courses for the Cessna Caravan aircraft are taught at the following FlightSafety Learning Center: Wichita Cessna Learning Center 1851 Airport Road Wichita, Kansas 67209 Phone: (316) 220-3100 Toll-Free: (800) 488-3214 Fax: (316) 220-3134 Copyright © 2008 by FlightSafety International, Inc. All rights reserved. Printed in the United States of America. INSERT LATEST REVISED PAGES, DESTROY SUPERSEDED PAGES LIST OF EFFECTIVE PAGES Dates of issue for original and changed pages are: Original ......0............. April 2008 Revision .....1.... November 2008 NOTE: For printing purposes, revision numbers in footers occur at the bottom of every page that has changed in any way (grammatical or typographical revisions, reflow of pages, and other changes that do not necessarily affect the meaning of the manual). THIS PUBLICATION CONSISTS OF THE FOLLOWING: Page No. *Revision No. Cover ...................................................... Copyright................................................ i—ii .......................................................... iii—vi ...................................................... 1-i—1-10 ................................................ 2-i—2-18 .................................................. 3-i—3-iv.................................................... 3-1—3-5 .................................................. 3-6—3-8 .................................................. 4-i—4-6 .................................................... 5-i—5-1 .................................................... 5-2—5-3 .................................................. 5-4............................................................ 5-5............................................................ 5-6—5-8 .................................................. 5-9............................................................ 5-10—5-12 .............................................. 6-i—6-ii .................................................... 7-i—7-ii .................................................... 7-iii—7-1 .................................................. 7-2............................................................ 7-3—7-9 .................................................. 7-10—7-11 .............................................. 7-12—7-14 .............................................. 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 Page No. *Revision No. 7-15.......................................................... 7-16—7-19 .............................................. 7-20—7-27 .............................................. 7-28—7-30 .............................................. 8-i ............................................................ 8-ii—8-iv .................................................. 8-1—8-5 .................................................. 8-6............................................................ 8-7—8-8 .................................................. 9-i—9-6 .................................................... 10-i—10-iv................................................ 10-1—10-2 .............................................. 10-3.......................................................... 10-4.......................................................... 10-5—10-16 ............................................ 11-i—11-10 .............................................. 12-i—12-ii ................................................ 13-i—13-ii ................................................ 14-i—14-1 ................................................ 14-2.......................................................... 14-3—14-6 .............................................. 15-i—15-3 ................................................ 15-4—15-6 .............................................. 15-7—15-10 ............................................ *Zero in this column indicates an original page. 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 0 Page No. *Revision No. 16-i—16-3 ................................................ 16-4—16-6 .............................................. 16-7—16-8 .............................................. 16-9—16-11 ............................................ 16-12........................................................ 16-13........................................................ 16-14—16-20 .......................................... 16-21—16-22 .......................................... 16-23—16-26 .......................................... 16-27—16-29 .......................................... 16-30........................................................ 16-31........................................................ 16-32........................................................ 16-33—16-34 .......................................... 16-35........................................................ 16-36........................................................ 16-37—16-39 .......................................... 16-40........................................................ 16-41........................................................ 16-42—16-44 .......................................... 16-45—16-47 .......................................... 16-48........................................................ 16-49........................................................ 16-50........................................................ 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 Page No. *Revision No. 16-51—16-58 .......................................... 17-i—17-6 ................................................ 18-i—18-8 ................................................ 19-i—19-ii ................................................ 19-iii—19-iv .............................................. 19-1—19-2 .............................................. 19-3—19-5 .............................................. 19-6—19-7 .............................................. 19-8.......................................................... 19-9.......................................................... 19-10........................................................ 19-11—19-22 .......................................... 20-i—20-ii ................................................ 21-i—21-10 .............................................. WA-1 ........................................................ WA-2 ........................................................ WA-3 ........................................................ WA-4—WA-6............................................ WA-7 ........................................................ WA-8—WA-10.......................................... WA-11 ...................................................... WA-12—WA-17........................................ WA-18 ...................................................... APP-1—APP-2 ........................................ *Zero in this column indicates an original page. 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 F O R T R A I N I N G P U R P O S E S O N LY NOTICE The material contained in this training manual is based on information obtained from the aircraft manufacturer’s Airplane Flight Manual, Pilot Manual, and Maintenance Manuals. It is to be used for familiarization and training purposes only. At the time of printing it contained then-current information. In the event of conflict between data provided herein and that in publications issued by the manufacturer or the FAA, that of the manufacturer or the FAA shall take precedence. We at FlightSafety want you to have the best training possible. We welcome any suggestions you might have for improving this manual or any other aspect of our training program. F O R T R A I N I N G P U R P O S E S O N LY CONTENTS Chapter 1 AIRCRAFT GENERAL Chapter 2 ELECTRICAL POWER SYSTEMS Chapter 3 LIGHTING Chapter 4 MASTER WARNING SYSTEM Chapter 5 FUEL SYSTEM Chapter 6 AUXILIARY POWER SYSTEM Chapter 7 POWERPLANT Chapter 8 FIRE PROTECTION Chapter 9 PNEUMATICS Chapter 10 ICE AND RAIN PROTECTION Chapter 11 AIR CONDITIONING Chapter 12 PRESSURIZATION Chapter 13 HYDRAULIC POWER SYSTEM Chapter 14 LANDING GEAR AND BRAKES Chapter 15 FLIGHT CONTROLS Chapter 16 AVIONICS Chapter 17 MISCELLANEOUS SYSTEMS Chapter 18 MANEUVERS AND PROCEDURES Chapter 19 WEIGHT AND BALANCE Chapter 20 FLIGHT PLANNING AND PERFORMANCE Chapter 21 CREW RESOURCE MANAGEMENT WALKAROUND APPENDIX CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 1 AIRCRAFT GENERAL CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 1-1 GENERAL............................................................................................................................... 1-1 Model Differences............................................................................................................ 1-2 STRUCTURES ........................................................................................................................ 1-2 Fuselage ........................................................................................................................... 1-2 Wings ............................................................................................................................... 1-2 Empennage....................................................................................................................... 1-2 AIRCRAFT SYSTEMS .......................................................................................................... 1-6 Alerts, Cautions, and Warnings ....................................................................................... 1-6 Electrical System ............................................................................................................. 1-6 Lighting System ............................................................................................................... 1-6 Fuel System...................................................................................................................... 1-6 Powerplant........................................................................................................................ 1-7 Ice and Rain Protection.................................................................................................... 1-7 Landing Gear and Brakes ................................................................................................ 1-7 Flight Controls ................................................................................................................. 1-7 Oxygen System ................................................................................................................ 1-8 LIMITATIONS ........................................................................................................................ 1-8 Windshield/Window Cleaning and Care.......................................................................... 1-8 Noise Characteristics ....................................................................................................... 1-8 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 1-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 1-1 Cessna Grand Caravan ............................................................................................. 1-2 1-2 Exterior Dimensions—208....................................................................................... 1-3 1-3 Exterior Dimensions—208B .................................................................................... 1-4 1-4 Minimum Turning Radii—208 ................................................................................ 1-5 TABLE Table 1-1 Revision 0 Title Page Windshield and Window Care.................................................................................. 1-9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 1-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 1 AIRCRAFT GENERAL INTRODUCTION This training manual describes the airframe and engine systems in the Cessna Caravan 208 G1000 aircraft. This manual does not supercede or substitute any of the manufacturer’s system or operating manuals. This manual provides information from the basic design data. All subsequent changes in aircraft appearance or system operation is covered during academic training and subsequent revisions to this manual. This chapter provides a general description of the aircraft structures and systems. GENERAL The Caravan 208 G1000 is a general-utility allmetal, high-wing, single-engine, tricycle landing gear aircraft. A composite cargo pod is Revision 0 available on all versions except for floatequipped aircraft (Figure 1-1). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 1-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Figure 1-1. Cessna Grand Caravan MODEL DIFFERENCES WINGS The Cessna Caravan 208 G1000 is produced as the 208 Caravan 675, 208B Grand Caravan, and 208B Super Cargomaster. The major differences are the presence or absence of passenger windows and the length of the fuselage. Figures 1-2 and 1-3 illustrate the aircraft dimensions for the various models. Figure 1-4 shows the minimum turning radii. The externally braced wings have integral fuel tanks. The wings have a front and rear spar with formed sheet metal ribs, as well as doubler and stringers. An aluminum skin covers the entire wing. STRUCTURES FUSELAGE The fuselage has a conventional formed sheet metal bulkhead, stringer, and semimonocoque skin design. The main components are: • Front and rear carry-through spars (wings attach to these spars) EMPENNAGE The empennage has a conventional vertical stabilizer, rudder, horizontal stabilizer, and elevator. The leading-edge extension on the top of the rudder has a balance weight. An elevator trim tab attaches to the trailing edge of the elevator by full-length piano hinges. Both elevator tip leading-edge extensions provide aerodynamic balance with balance weights. A row of vortex generators on top of the horizontal stabilizer forward of the elevator enhances nose down elevator and trim authority. • Bulkhead • Main landing gear attachment forgings • Bulkhead with attaching plates at its base for strut-to-fuselage attachment of wing struts 1-2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 14 FEET – 10 INCHES MAX CARGO VERSION 37 FEET – 7 INCHES 20 FEET – 6 INCHES NOTE: 1. DIMENSIONS SHOWN ARE BASED ON STANDARD EMPTY WEIGHT AND PROPER INFLATION OF NOSE AND MAIN GEAR TIRES. TAIL HEIGHT CAN INCREASE WITH OVERSIZE TIRES. 2. WING SPAN DIMENSION INCLUDES STROBE LIGHTS. 3. MAXIMUM HEIGHT SHOWN WITH NOSE GEAR DEPRESSED AS FAR AS POSSIBLE. 4. WHEEL BASE LENGTH IS 11 FEET – 7 1/2 INCHES. 5. WING AREA IS 279.4 SQUARE FEET. 6. MINIMUM TURNING RADIUS (*PIVOT POINT TO OUTBOARD WINGTIP STROBE LIGHT) IS 33 FEET – 8 INCHES. PIVOT POINT PIVOT POINT 52 FEET – 1 INCHES 7. HARTZELL PROPELLER GROUND CLEARANCE WITH STANDARD TIRES AND NOSE GEAR FORK: • NOSE TIRE DEFLATED AND NOSE GEAR BARREL EXTENDED 4 1/2 INCHES: 19 INCHES (See POH) • NOSE TIRE INFLATED AND NOSE STRUT FULLY COMPRESSED: 12 INCHES. PROPELLER GROUND CLEARANCE WITH McCAULEY™ PROPELLER: • NOSE TIRE INFLATED AND NOSE GEAR EXTENDED 4 1/2 INCHES: 16 INCHES. • NOSE TIRE DEFLATED AND NOSE STRUT FULLY COMPRESSED 9 INCHES. 11 FEET – 8 INCHES 100 INCHES (HARTZELL) 106 INCHES (McCAULEY™) Figure 1-2. Exterior Dimensions—208 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 1-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 15 FEET – 5 1/2 INCHES MAX PASSENGER VERSION 41 FEET – 7 INCHES CARGO VERSION 20 FEET – 6 INCHES NOTE: 1. DIMENSIONS SHOWN ARE BASED ON STANDARD EMPTY WEIGHT AND PROPER INFLATION OF NOSE AND MAIN GEAR TIRES. 2. WING SPAN DIMENSION INCLUDES STROBE LIGHTS. 3. MAXIMUM HEIGHT SHOWN WITH NOSE GEAR DEPRESSED AS FAR AS POSSIBLE. 4. WHEEL BASE LENGTH IS 13 FEET – 3 1/2 INCHES. 5. WING AREA IS 279.4 SQUARE FEET. 6. MINIMUM TURNING RADIUS (*PIVOT POINT TO OUTBOARD WING TIP, STROBE LIGHT) IS 33 FEET – 8 INCHES. CABIN SIDE WINDOWS AND THE RIGHT PASSENGER DOOR ARE NOT INSTALLED ON THE CARGO VERSION PIVOT POINT PIVOT POINT 7. HARTZELL PROPELLER GROUND CLEARANCE WITH STANDARD TIRES AND NOSE GEAR FORK: • NOSE TIRE INFLATED AND NOSE GEAR BARREL EXTENDED 3 5/8 INCHES: 14 1/4 INCHES. • NOSE TIRE DEFLATED AND NOSE STRUT FULLY COMPRESSED: 5 1/2 INCHES. HARTZELL PROPELLER GROUND CLEARANCE WITH STANDARD TIRES AND EXTENDED NOSE GEAR FORK: • NOSE TIRE INFLATED AND NOSE GEAR BARREL EXTENDED 3 5/8 INCHES: 17 3/4 INCHES. • NOSE TIRE DEFLATED AND NOSE STRUT FULLY COMPRESSED: 8 7/8 INCHES. 8. MCCAULEY™ PROPELLER GROUND CLEARANCE – STANDARD TIRES AND NOSE GEAR FORK: • NOSE TIRE INFLATED AND NOSE GEAR BARREL EXTENDED 3 5/8 INCHES: 11 1/4 INCHES. • NOSE TIRE DEFLATED AND NOSE STRUT FULLY COMPRESSED: 2 1/2 INCHES. MCCAULEY™ PROPELLER GROUND CLEARANCE – STANDARD TIRES, EXTENDED NOSE GEAR FORK: • NOSE TIRE INFLATED AND NOSE GEAR BARREL EXTENDED 3 5/8 INCHES: 14 3/4 INCHES. • NOSE TIRE DEFLATED AND STRUT FULLY COMPRESSED: 5 7/8 INCHES. 52 FEET – 1 INCHES 11 FEET – 8 INCHES 100 INCHES (HARTZELL) 106 INCHES (MCAULEY™) Figure 1-3. Exterior Dimensions—208B 1-4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 67 FEET 3.6 INCHES (WITH STROBE LIGHTS) 33 FEET 6.5 INCHES (WITH STROBE LIGHTS) 12 FEET 9.7 INCHES 11 FEET 7.0 INCHES NOTE: MINIMUM TURNING RADIUS WITH BRAKE LOCKED, FULL RUDDER, AND POWER Figure 1-4. Minimum Turning Radii—208 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 1-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL AIRCRAFT SYSTEMS • Two strobe lights • Flashing beacon This section describes the following aircraft systems: • Crew alerting system (CAS) messages • Electrical system • Two underwing courtesy lights • Ice detection light All exterior lights, except for the ice detection light, are controlled by toggle switches on the lighting control panel on the left side of the instrument panel. The ice detection light is controlled by a toggle switch on the ANTI-ICE switch panel. • Lighting system • Fuel system • Powerplant • Ice and rain protection • Landing gear and brakes • Flight controls • Oxygen system Each system is described in detail in its respective chapter in this training manual. ALERTS, CAUTIONS, AND WARNINGS Alerts, cautions, and warnings are indicated through CAS messages on each primary flight display (PFD 1 and PFD 2). ELECTRICAL SYSTEM The aircraft uses a 28 volt, direct current (VDC) electrical system. A 24 volt battery and a startergenerator supply primary power to the aircraft. Additional power is available through an external power receptacle and a standby alternator, which is standard on the aircraft. DC power is routed through a power distribution bus, a battery bus, an avionics bus, and a standby alternator bus. CAS messages indicate emergency and abnormal conditions. A single postlight on the overhead panel illuminates both flap switches. A recessed light illuminates the oxygen gauge. Integral lights and floodlights illuminate the instrument panel The integral lights illuminate the high frequency (HF), automatic direction finder (ADF) standby, and radio instruments internally. Note that the G1000 provides its own illumination of the control switches and labels. FUEL SYSTEM The aircraft fuel system includes: • Two vented, integral fuel tanks with shutoff valves • Fuel-selectors-off warning system • Fuel reservoir • Ejector fuel pump • Electric auxiliary boost pump • Reservoir manifold assembly • Firewall shutoff valve • Fuel filter • Oil-to-fuel heater • Engine-driven fuel pump • Fuel control unit LIGHTING SYSTEM • Flow divider Exterior lighting includes: • Dual manifolds • Three navigation lights • Fourteen fuel nozzle assemblies • Two landing lights • Fuel can and drain • Two taxi recognition lights 1-6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Fuel flows from the tanks through the two fuel tank shutoff valves at each tank. Mechanical control of the fuel tank shutoff valves is by two fuel selectors on the overhead panel. Manipulate the fuel selectors to select either left or right fuel tanks, or both at the same time. Normal operation is with both tanks on. POWERPLANT A Pratt and Whitney of Canada, Ltd. PT6A114A free-turbine, two-shaft engine powers the aircraft. The free-turbine engine uses two independent turbines: one drives a compressor in the gas generator section and one drives a reduction gear for the propeller. The turbine is rated at 675 hp. All engine-driven accessories, except for the propeller tachometer-generator and propeller governors, are on the accessory gearbox (AGB) at the rear of the engine. The engine accessories are driven by the compressor turbine via a coupling shaft that extends the drive through a conical tube in the oil tank center section. An internal tank contains the main portion of the engine oil supply. The tank, which forms part of the compressor inlet case, has a capacity of 9.5 U.S. quarts and includes a dipstick and drain plug. Total oil system capacity, including tank, engine sumps, lines, and filter, is 14 U.S. quarts. ICE AND RAIN PROTECTION The fluid-based ice and rain protection system exudes a filmy ice protection fluid (TKS) from porous panels on the leading edges of the aircraft. The fluid minimizes ice formation on all lifting surfaces, propeller blades, wings, wing struts, and horizontal and vertical stabilizers. When the system is activated in-flight, the ice protection fluid flows backwards over the upper and lower surfaces. A fluid slinger on the propeller provides ice protection for the propeller and generates further ice protection for the fuselage and cargo pod forward surfaces. Two, positive displacement, Revision 0 constant volume metering pumps supply fluid to the panels and propeller. Single and combined pump operation and timed pumping provide a range of flow rates for different icing conditions. An on-demand gear pump supplies fluid to the windshield spray bar for clear vision through the windshield. LANDING GEAR AND BRAKES The tricycle landing gear has a steerable nosewheel and two main wheels. Shock absorption is by the following: • The tubular spring-steel main landing gear struts • Interconnecting spring-steel tube between the two main landing gear struts • Nose gear oil-filled shock strut and spring-steel drag link Each main gear wheel has a hydraulically actuated single-disc brake on the inboard side of each wheel. FLIGHT CONTROLS The flight control system includes: • Conventional aileron, elevator, and rudder control surfaces • A pair of spoilers above the outboard ends of the flaps The control surfaces are manually operated with a control wheel, mechanically linked to the ailerons, spoilers, and elevator, and rudder/brake pedals. The wing spoilers improve lateral control of the aircraft at low speeds by disrupting lift over the appropriate flap. A trimmable servo tab on the right aileron provides aileron trim. Elevator trim is controlled through two elevator trim tabs. A vertical control wheel on the top left side of the control pedestal is used to control pitch trim, and a horizontal wheel is used to control rudder trim. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 1-7 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL OXYGEN SYSTEM An oxygen system is available for supplemental oxygen necessary for continuous flight at high altitude or for use if smoke or other noxious fumes are detected in the cabin. Pa s s e n g e r m o d e l s o f t h e a i r c r a f t h ave a 116.95-cubic foot oxygen bottle and 8 or 17 oxygen ports, depending on the model. Cargo models have a 50.67 cubic-foot oxygen bottle and two oxygen ports, with the option for the 116.95-cubic foot bottle. The oxygen system includes an oxygen cylinder, oxygen outlets and masks, and an oxygen pressure gauge. can demonstrate concern for environmental improvement by application of the following suggested procedures, and thereby prevent undue criticism of aviation by the public: • Pilots operating aircraft under visual flight rules (VFR) over outdoor assemblies of persons, recreational and park areas, and other noise-sensitive areas must make every effort to fly not less than 2,000 feet above the surface, weather permitting, even though flight at a lower level can be consistent with the provisions of government regulations. • During departure from or approach to an airport, climb after takeoff and descent for landing must be made so as to avoid prolonged flight at low altitude near noise-sensitive areas. LIMITATIONS NOTE WINDSHIELD/WINDOW CLEANING AND CARE The windshield and windows are constructed of cast acrylic. The surface hardness of acrylic is approximately equal to that of copper or brass. Do not use a canvas cover on the windshield unless freezing rain or sleet is anticipated. Canvas covers can scratch the plastic surface. When cleaning and waxing the windshield and windows, use only the materials and methods listed in Table 1-1. Do not use any of the following on windshields and windows: The above procedures do not apply where they conflict with Air Traffic Control clearances or instructions, or where, in the judgement of the pilot, an altitude of less than 2,000 feet is necessary for the pilot to adequately see and avoid other traffic. The certificated noise level for the Model 208B at 8,750 pounds maximum weight is 75.2 dB(A). No determination has been made by the Federal Aviation Administration that the noise levels of this aircraft are or should be acceptable or unacceptable for operation at, into, or out of any airport. • Methanol • Denatured alcohol • Gasoline • Benzene NOISE CHARACTERISTICS Increased emphasis on improving the quality of our environment requires renewed effort on the part of all pilots to minimize the effect of aircraft noise on the public. Pilots 1-8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 1-1. WINDSHIELD AND WINDOW CARE DESCRIPTION MANUFACTURER USE Mild soap or detergent (hand dishwashing type without abrasives) Commercially available Cleaning windshields and windows Aliphatic naphtha type II conforming to federal specifications TT-N-95 Commerically available Removing deposits that cannot be removed with mild soap solution on acrylic windshields and windows Polishing wax:* • Turtle Wax® (paste) Turtle Wax®, Inc. Chicago, IL 60638 • Great Reflections Paste wax E.I. duPont de Nemours and Co., Inc. Wilmington, DE 19898 • Slipstream Wax (paste) Classic Chemical Grand Prairie, TX 76050 Acrylic polish conforming to Federal Specification P-P-560, such as: • Permatex® Plastic Cleaner, No. 403D Waxing acrylic windshields and windows Cleaning and polishing acrylic windshields and windows Permatex® Company, Inc. Kansas City, KS 66115 • Mirror Glaze® MGH-17 Mirror Bright Polish Co. Pasadena, CA Soft cloth, such as cotton flannel or cotton terry cloth material Commercially available Applying and removing wax and polish *Waxes shown are the only polishing waxes tested and approved for use by Cessna Aircraft Company. Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 1-9 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 2 ELECTRICAL POWER SYSTEMS CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 2-1 GENERAL............................................................................................................................... 2-1 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM ........................................................................................................ 2-3 Description ....................................................................................................................... 2-3 Components ..................................................................................................................... 2-3 Controls and Indications .................................................................................................. 2-5 Operation ....................................................................................................................... 2-10 Limitations ..................................................................................................................... 2-16 Emergency/Abnormal .................................................................................................... 2-16 QUESTIONS ......................................................................................................................... 2-17 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 2-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 2-1 Electrical System...................................................................................................... 2-2 2-2 Lead-Acid Battery .................................................................................................... 2-3 2-3 Starter-Generator ...................................................................................................... 2-4 2-4 Ground Service Receptacle ...................................................................................... 2-4 2-5 Left Sidewall Switch Panel ...................................................................................... 2-5 2-6 Voltage and Amperage Indications........................................................................... 2-7 2-7 CB Panels ................................................................................................................. 2-8 2-8 Electrical System—Battery Start Below 46% Ng .................................................... 2-9 2-9 Electrical System—BATTERY Switch ON........................................................... 2-11 2-10 Electrical System—Battery Start Above 46% Ng.................................................. 2-12 2-11 Electrical System—External Power Start Below 46% Ng..................................... 2-13 2-12 Electrical System—External Power Start Above 46% Ng..................................... 2-14 2-13 Electrical System—Generator On, Battery Charging............................................ 2-15 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 2-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 2 ELECTRICAL POWER SYSTEMS INTRODUCTION This chapter describes the electrical system and standby electrical system in the Cessna Caravan 208 G1000 aircraft. GENERAL The aircraft has a 28 VDC electrical system. The system uses a 24 volt battery and a starter-generator to supply primary power to the aircraft. Additional power is available through an external power unit receptacle and a standby alternator, which is standard equipment on the aircraft. Revision 0 DC power is routed through a power distribution bus, a battery bus, an avionics bus, and a standard, standby alternator bus. Controls and warnings are provided to indicate emergency and abnormal conditions. Figure 2-1 shows a schematic depiction of the electrical system. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 2-1 2-2 ALTERNATOR STARTER-GENERATOR GENERATOR CONTACTOR GEN SHUNT ALTERNATOR CONTROL UNIT EXTERNAL POWER SWITCH FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY NO. 1 BUS INTERNAL START CONTACTOR EXTERNAL START CONTACTOR ALTERNATOR BUS GROUND POWER MONITOR EXTERNAL POWER NO. 2 BUS EXTERNAL POWER CONTACTOR BATTERY CONTACTOR BATT SHUNT NO. 1 BATTERY POWER DISTRIBUTION BUS Revision 0 BATTERY BUS ALTERNATOR CONTACTOR NO. 2 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL GENERATOR CONTROL UNIT ALT SHUNT CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ELECTRICAL SYSTEM A standby electrical system is available as a power source if the main generator system malfunctions (see Figure 2-1). DESCRIPTION The aircraft has a 28 VDC electrical system. The system uses a 24 volt battery as a source of electrical energy and a dual purpose startergenerator, which acts as a motor during engine start and as a generator after engine start. When operating as a generator, the startergenerator powers the aircraft systems and maintains the battery charge. Power to most general electrical and all avionics circuits is through two general buses, two avionics buses, and a battery bus. The hot battery bus energizes continuously for cabin/courtesy lighting and other functions requiring power when the two general buses are off. The two general buses are on when the BATTERY switch is ON. All DC buses are powered on when the BATTERY switch and the two AVIONICS switches are ON. COMPONENTS Lead-Acid Battery A 24 volt, lead-acid battery supplies starting power. The battery is on the right forward side of the firewall on a swing-out tray for easy maintenance. The battery absorbs voltage spikes, which are particularly damaging to electronic components. As such, ensure that the battery is well maintained and never turn it off during normal operation. The battery is in its own manifold case (Figure 2-2). The case helps contain the hydrogen gas emitted by the battery during normal charging cycles. The battery case is ventilated to prevent a concentrated accumulation of hydrogen within the airframe. The overboard vent BOX PIVOT POWER CABLE LATCH RELEASE LATCH BATTERY VENT LINE POWER CABLE FIREWALL Figure 2-2. Lead-Acid Battery Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 2-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL also serves as a drain for any acid condensate produced during system charging. WARNING Battery acid is very corrosive and hydrogen gas is highly explosive. Take measures to protect personnel and the aircraft when handling the lead-acid battery. Generator Control Unit The generator control unit (GCU) is inside the cabin on the left forward fuselage side wall. The GCU provides the electrical control functions of the starter-generator. The GCU allows automatic starter cutoff when the engine rpm is above 46%. Below 46%, the starter-generator functions as a starter. Above 46%, the starter-generator functions as a generator when the STARTER switch is positioned to OFF. The GCU regulates voltage and protects the system from high voltage and reverse current. Starter-Generator The starter-generator is on the engine accessory gearbox (AGB) at the 12 o’clock position and is driven by the engine through a splined shaft (Figure 2-3). The starter-generator functions as starter during engine start and as a generator once the engine is at idle speed. The battery or an external power source powers the starter-generator. After engine start, the unit acts as a 28 volt, 200 amp, or optional 300 amp, generator that powers the electrical equipment and charges the battery. The GCU controls the starter-generator when it operates as a generator. An integral fan and blast tube above the oil cooler in the air inlet on the right forward cowling cools the starter-generator. The unit has a speed sensor for overspeed protection and automatic starter shutoff. 2-4 Figure 2-3. Starter-Generator Ground Service Plug Receptacle A ground service plug receptacle (Figure 2-4) permits the use of an external power source for cold weather starting and during lengthy maintenance on the electrical and avionics equipment. External power control circuits prevent an external power to battery connection during the start. The external power receptacle is in the left side of the engine compartment near the firewall (see Figure 2-1). Figure 2-4. Ground Service Receptacle FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL The ground service circuit has polarity reversal and overvoltage protection. Power from the external power source flows only if the ground service plug is connected correctly to the aircraft.If the plug is accidentally connected backwards or if the ground service voltage is too high, no power flows to the electrical system, thereby preventing damage to the electrical equipment. Ground Power Monitor The ground power monitor is inside the electrical power control assembly on the forward left side of the firewall. The monitor senses the voltage level applied to the external power receptacle and closes the external power contactor when the applied voltage is within the proper limits. Standby Electrical System The standby electrical system has the following components: • 75 amp alternator, belt-driven from the accessory pad on the rear of the engine • Alternator control unit (ACU) forward of the CB panel • Standby alternator contactor on the left side of the firewall • Two switches on the left sidewall switch p a n e l – AV I O N I C S S T B Y P W R a n d AVIONICS BUS TIE CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS The main controls of the electrical system are on the left sidewall switch panel (Figure 2-5) and include controls for: • External power • Battery • Generator • Fuel boost • Standby power • Ignition • Starter • Avionics Revision 0 Figure 2-5. Left Sidewall Switch Panel EXTERNAL POWER Switch The EXTERNAL POWER switch is a guarded, three-position switch. The switch has OFF, STARTER, and BUS positions and is guarded in the OFF position. The OFF position allows external power to the ground power monitor only, with no other circuits receiving power. The STARTER position applies external power to the starter circuit only, with battery power applied to the main bus (Figure 2-5). In the STARTER position, no generator power is available. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 2-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL The BUS position applies power to the distribution bus, with no external power supplied to the starter. To connect the battery to the power distribution bus and external power, position the BATTERY switch to ON. BATTERY Switch The BATTERY toggle switch has ON and OFF positions (see Figure 2-5). The ON position supplies battery power to the two general buses. The OFF position deactivates power to all buses except the battery bus. AVIONICS STBY PWR Switch The guarded, two-position AVIONICS STBY PWR switch is used to control the standby electrical system (see Figure 2-5). AVIONICS BUS TIE Switch GENERATOR Switch The GENERATOR switch is a three-position switch, spring-loaded to the center ON position (see Figure 2-5). The switch can be pressed to the RESET or TRIP positions. IGNITION Switch The IGNITION toggle switch has two-positions: ON and NORM (see Figure 2-5). STARTER Switch The three-position STARTER switch has OFF, START, and MOTOR positions (see Figure 2-5) The OFF position deenergizes the ignition system. The START position energizes the ignition system automatically when the ignition switch is positioned to NORMAL. Once the engine reaches a self-sustaining speed, the STARTER switch must be manually positioned to OFF for generator operation. The MOTOR position motors the engine without the ignition circuit energized, and is used for motoring the engine when an engine start is not desired. Motoring the engine eliminates unburned fuel from the engine after an aborted start and reduces residual high interstage turbine temperature (ITT) after a hot start. 2-6 The STARTER switch is spring-loaded to the OFF position. An interlock between the MOTOR position of the STARTER switch and the IGNITION switch prevents the starter from motoring unless the IGNITION switch is positioned to NORM. The interlock prevents unintentional motoring of the engine when the IGNITION switch is positioned to ON. The AVIONICS BUS TIE switch is a two-position switch, guarded in the OFF position (see Figure 2-5). Lifting the guard and positioning the switch to ON connects the No. 1 and No. 2 avionics buses if either bus feeder circuit fails. A current limiter on the power distribution bus powers each avionics bus. If either current limiter fails, the affected bus also fails. The ON position restores power to the failed bus. Operating without both bus feeder circuits requires an avionics load reduction, depending on the equipment n the aircraft. AVIONICS Switches The AVIONICS 1 switch controls power to the No. 1 avionics bus. The AVIONICS 2 switch controls power to the No. 2 avionics bus. The switches are ON in the forward position and OFF in the aft position. VOLTAGE AND AMPERAGE Indications Electrical system information is indicated on the multifunction flight display (MFD) (nonreversionary mode). Battery current (BAT AMPS) and bus voltage (BUS VOLTS) are indicated on the default EIS–ENGINE page (Figure 2-6). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Circuit Breakers Most of the electrical circuits in the aircraft are protected by pull-off circuit breakers on the left side CB panel. Supplying the battery bus are six circuit breakers, which are forward of the firewall, inside the left engine cowling. If an overload occurs in any circuit, the controlling circuit breaker trips, opening the circuit. Allow the circuit breaker to cool for approximately 3 minutes, and then reset it (Figure 2-7). WARNING Ensure that all circuit breakers are pushed in before all flights. Never operate with tripped circuit breakers without thorough knowledge of the consequences. Crew Alerting System Messages Electrical system monitoring is provided by the following crew alerting system (CAS) messages. VOLTAGE LOW A red VOLTAGE LOW CAS message appears when the electrical bus voltage is below 24.5 volts, and the battery is supplying power. VOLTAGE HIGH Figure 2-6. Voltage and Amperage Indications Pressing the ENGINE softkey, and then pressing the SYSTEM softkey displays the EIS–SYSTEM pages, which display generator current (GEN AMPS) and bus voltage (BUS VOLTS). A negative display on the BAT AMPS indicates battery discharge. Revision 0 A red VOLTAGE HIGH CAS message appears when electrical system bus voltage is greater than 32.0 volts. GENERATOR OFF Under high voltage or reverse current conditions, the generator automatically disconnects from the buses. The GCU controls the generator contactor, which connects generator output to the power distribution bus. If a GCU function deenergizes the generator contactor, then an amber GENERATOR OFF CAS message appears. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 2-7 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL LEFT SIDEWALL SWITCH PANEL CIRCUIT BREAKER PANEL Figure 2-7. CB Panels STBY PWR INOP ALTNR AMPS An amber STBY PWR INOP CAS message (Figure 2-8)appears when electrical power is unavailable from the standby alternator. An amber ALTNR AMPS CAS message appears if the alternator amperage exceeds normal operating ranges. When the system uses the standby electrical system, the maximum electrical load is 75 amps from sea level to 21,000 feet. To ensure adequate alternator cooling at high altitude, reduce the maximum electrical load 5 amps per 1,000 feet above 21,000 feet up to the maximum operating altitude. IGNITION ON Two STBY PWR circuit breakers limit power to the two main buses to 40 amps per bus. A white IGNITION ON CAS message (see Figure 2-8) appears when electrical power is being supplied to the engine ignition system. STBY PWR ON A white STBY PWR ON CAS message appears when the standby alternator is generating electrical power. STARTER ON An amber STARTER ON CAS message appears when the starter is in starter mode (see Figure 2-8). 2-8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 Revision 0 ALTERNATOR STARTER−GENERATOR GENERATOR CONTACTOR GENERATOR CONTROL UNIT ALT SHUNT GEN SHUNT ALTERNATOR CONTROL UNIT EXTERNAL POWER SWITCH FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY EXTERNAL START CONTACTOR ALTERNATOR BUS GROUND POWER MONITOR EXTERNAL POWER NO. 2 BUS EXTERNAL POWER CONTACTOR BATT SHUNT NO. 1 BATTERY POWER DISTRIBUTION BUS BATTERY BUS NO. 2 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NO. 1 BUS INTERNAL START CONTACTOR BATTERY CONTACTOR ALTERNATOR CONTACTOR 2-9 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL OPERATION the generator online because the STARTER switch is still positioned at START. Preflight During the preflight internal inspection, position all switches to OFF and push in all circuit breakers. Position the radar to OFF. If the aircraft has an air conditioner, position the air conditioner controls to OFF. If the aircraft has an inverter switch, position it to OFF. Two deck skin fans cool the avionics system during operation. To check deck skin fans, position the BATTERY switch to ON. Position the AVIONICS No. 1 switch to ON, verify that fan operation is audible, and then position the AVIONICS No. 1 switch to OFF. With the BATTERY switch ON, repeat the same procedure with the AVIONICS No. 2 switch. When finished, position the BATTERY switch to OFF. Starting Positioning the BATTERY switch to ON applies battery power to the battery contactor and connects the battery to the power distribution bus, the internal start contactor, and the generator contactor (Figure 2-9). Battery voltage also is applied to the GCU to provide line contactor sense. Positioning the BATTERY switch to OFF opens the battery contactor and applies battery voltage to the battery bus only. When external power is applied to the aircraft, the configuration is different than when internal power is applied to the aircraft. Figure 2-11 shows the circuit with external power connected correctly—STARTER switch positioned to START, EXTERNAL POWER switch positioned to STARTER, and N g below 46%. The difference between an external power start and a battery start below 46% N g is that the starter obtains power from the external start contactor instead of the internal start contactor. During an external power start, when N g exceeds 46%, the sequence and configuration are similar to those of a battery start above 46% (Figure 2-12). The difference is the GCU opens the external start contactor instead of the internal start contactor when the speed sensor signal exceeds 46% N g . After the engine starts and N g reaches at least 52%, position the STARTER switch to OFF. The OFF position signals the GCU that the start cycle is complete. The GCU then signals the generator to produce power. The GCU also signals the generator contactor to close, which thus applies power to the power distribution bus (Figure 2-13). Since the battery voltage is lower than the generator output voltage, the generator recharges the battery to full capacity. The higher voltage extinguishes the VOLTAGE LOW CAS message. Figure 2-8 shows the electrical system when the BATTERY switch is ON, the STARTER switch is at START, and the EXTERNAL POWER switch is OFF, with N g below 46%. Verify that the STARTER ON CAS message disappears, and then check the engine indications. When these conditions are met, the GCU signals the internal starter contactor to close and applies power to the starter. Position the EXTERNAL POWER switch to OFF, and then turn off and disengage the external power unit. When the speed sensor in the starter-generator detects speed greater than 46% Ng, it signals the GCU to open the internal start contactor (Figure 2-10). When the contactor opens, power is removed from the starter. The GCU does not bring Check the GEN (generator) load on the engine indications, and verify that the GENERATOR OFF CAS message disappears and the BAT AMPS are charging. 2-10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 Revision 0 STARTER–GENERATOR ALTERNATOR GENERATOR CONTACTOR ALT SHUNT GEN SHUNT ALTERNATOR CONTROL UNIT EXTERNAL POWER SWITCH GENERATOR CONTROL UNIT ALTERNATOR CONTACTOR STANDBY ALTERNATOR POWER SWITCH FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY EXTERNAL START CONTACTOR ALTERNATOR BUS GROUND POWER MONITOR AVIONICS STANDBY POWER SWITCH EXTERNAL POWER NO. 2 BUS EXTERNAL POWER CONTACTOR BATTERY CONTACTOR NO. 1 AVIONICS POWER SWITCH BATT SHUNT BATTERY SWITCH BUS TIE SWITCH NO. 1 TO HOURMETER NO. 2 AVIONICS POWER SWITCH TO CABIN LIGHTS BATTERY TO ELT TO ETM TO ANTICYCLE SWITCH POWER DISTRIBUTION BUS NO. 2 BATTERY BUS LEGEND BATTERY POWER GROUND 2-11 Figure 2-9. Electrical System—BATTERY Switch ON CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NO. 1 BUS INTERNAL START CONTACTOR 2-12 STARTER–GENERATOR ALTERNATOR GENERATOR CONTACTOR GENERATOR CONTROL UNIT ALT SHUNT GEN SHUNT ALTERNATOR CONTROL UNIT EXTERNAL POWER SWITCH FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY EXTERNAL START CONTACTOR ALTERNATOR BUS GROUND POWER MONITOR EXTERNAL POWER NO. 2 BUS EXTERNAL POWER CONTACTOR BATT SHUNT NO. 1 BATTERY POWER DISTRIBUTION BUS BATTERY BUS NO. 2 Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NO. 1 BUS INTERNAL START CONTACTOR BATTERY CONTACTOR ALTERNATOR CONTACTOR Revision 0 ALTERNATOR STARTER–GENERATOR GENERATOR CONTACTOR ALT SHUNT GEN SHUNT ALTERNATOR CONTROL UNIT EXTERNAL POWER SWITCH GENERATOR CONTROL UNIT ALTERNATOR CONTACTOR STANDBY ALTERNATOR POWER SWITCH FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY EXTERNAL START CONTACTOR ALTERNATOR BUS GROUND POWER MONITOR AVIONICS STANDBY POWER SWITCH EXTERNAL POWER NO. 2 BUS EXTERNAL POWER CONTACTOR BATTERY CONTACTOR NO. 1 AVIONICS POWER SWITCH BATT SHUNT BATTERY SWITCH BUS TIE SWITCH NO. 1 TO HOURMETER NO. 2 AVIONICS POWER SWITCH TO CABIN LIGHTS BATTERY TO ELT TO ETM TO ANTICYCLE SWITCH POWER DISTRIBUTION BUS NO. 2 BATTERY BUS LEGEND BATTERY POWER EXTERNAL POWER 2-13 Figure 2-11. Electrical System—External Power Start Below 46% Ng GROUND CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NO. 1 BUS INTERNAL START CONTACTOR 2-14 ALTERNATOR STARTER–GENERATOR GENERATOR CONTACTOR ALT SHUNT GEN SHUNT ALTERNATOR CONTROL UNIT EXTERNAL POWER SWITCH GENERATOR CONTROL UNIT ALTERNATOR CONTACTOR STANDBY ALTERNATOR POWER SWITCH FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY EXTERNAL START CONTACTOR ALTERNATOR BUS GROUND POWER MONITOR AVIONICS STANDBY POWER SWITCH EXTERNAL POWER NO. 2 BUS EXTERNAL POWER CONTACTOR BATTERY CONTACTOR NO. 1 AVIONICS POWER SWITCH BATT SHUNT BATTERY SWITCH BUS TIE SWITCH NO. 1 TO HOURMETER NO. 2 AVIONICS POWER SWITCH TO CABIN LIGHTS BATTERY TO ELT TO ETM TO ANTICYCLE SWITCH POWER DISTRIBUTION BUS NO. 2 BATTERY BUS LEGEND BATTERY POWER Revision 0 EXTERNAL POWER Figure 2-12. Electrical System—External Power Start Above 46% Ng GROUND CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NO. 1 BUS INTERNAL START CONTACTOR Revision 0 ALTERNATOR STARTER–GENERATOR GENERATOR CONTACTOR ALT SHUNT GEN SHUNT ALTERNATOR CONTROL UNIT EXTERNAL POWER SWITCH GENERATOR CONTROL UNIT ALTERNATOR CONTACTOR STANDBY ALTERNATOR POWER SWITCH FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY EXTERNAL START CONTACTOR ALTERNATOR BUS GROUND POWER MONITOR AVIONICS STANDBY POWER SWITCH EXTERNAL POWER NO. 2 BUS EXTERNAL POWER CONTACTOR BATTERY CONTACTOR NO. 1 AVIONICS POWER SWITCH BATT SHUNT BATTERY SWITCH BUS TIE SWITCH NO. 1 TO HOURMETER NO. 2 AVIONICS POWER SWITCH TO CABIN LIGHTS BATTERY TO ELT TO ETM TO ANTICYCLE SWITCH POWER DISTRIBUTION BUS NO. 2 BATTERY BUS LEGEND GENERATOR OUTPUT GROUND 2-15 Figure 2-13. Electrical System—Generator On, Battery Charging CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NO. 1 BUS INTERNAL START CONTACTOR CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Position the FUEL BOOST switch to NORM, and then verify that the FUEL BOOST ON CAS message does not appear. Position the AVIONICS No. 2 switch to ON, and position the NAV LIGHTS to ON or OFF as desired. Position the cabin heating, ventilation, and defrosting controls as desired. EMERGENCY/ABNORMAL For specific information on emergency/abnormal procedures, refer to the POH/AFM. Standby Electrical Power System Current to the ACU is supplied through diode logic either from a circuit breaker in the standby alternator or the hourmeter/ACU circuit breaker in the main power relay box. After the alternator control unit (ACU) begins operation, the alternator is self energized. To monitor total amperage from the standby electrical system, position the system button on the lower left side of the MFD to ALT. When the standby electrical system energizes, standby power automatically routes to the main buses if system voltage drops to 27.5 volts. Verify that the AVIONICS STBY PWR and AVIONICS BUS TIE switches are positioned to ON to prevent connecting the standby power system to a possible fault in the primary power system when operating on standby power. All main electrical components on current aircraft remain the same. If a fault in the primary power relay box occurs, isolate the primary power supply system. (Pull the six, 30 amp bus feeder circuit breake r s , a n d t h e n t u r n o f f b o t h AV I O N I C S switches.) Power the avionics by turning on both the AVIONICS STBY PWR and AVIONICS BUS TIE switches. LIMITATIONS For limitations of this aircraft, refer to the Pilot’s Operating Handbook and FAA-approved Airplane Flight Manual (POH/AFM). 2-16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL QUESTIONS 1. The battery is: A. In the tail cone B. Under the right front seat C. On a swing out tray in front of the firewall D. On the floor behind the pilot seat 2. The lead-acid battery case is vented to prevent: A. Concentrated accumulation of hydrogen gas in the airframe B. Pressure differential in the battery C. Contamination from ambient air D. Overcharging of the battery 3. The generator control unit (GCU) controls operation of the: A. Generator only B. Starter only C. Starter-generator D. Standby electrical system 4. The ground power monitor: A. Protects the electrical system B. Controls the external generator C. S e n s e s o p e r a t i o n o f t h e s t a r t e rgenerator D. Regulates generator output 6. Positioning the AVIONICS BUS TIE switch to ON: A. Ties the avionics bus to the battery B. Ties the No. 1 avionics bus to the generator C. Ties the No. 1 avionics bus to the No.2 avionics bus D. Disconnects the avionics buses from each other 7. When the EXTERNAL POWER switch is positioned to BUS: A. External power is applied to the starter B. External power is applied to the avionics bus. C. E x t e r n a l p ow e r i s a p p l i e d t o t h e main bus D. Power is sent from the main bus to the external power receptacle 8. The standby electrical system: A. Is powered by the battery B. Is powered by the engine-driven generator C. Is powered by a belt-driven alternator D. I s a c t u a t e d b y t h e g r o u n d p ow e r monitor 5. The voltmeter and its associated selector button are used to read: A. Generator current B. Alternator current C. Battery current D. All of the above Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 2-17 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 3 LIGHTING CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 3-1 GENERAL............................................................................................................................... 3-1 EXTERIOR LIGHTING ......................................................................................................... 3-2 Description ....................................................................................................................... 3-2 Components ..................................................................................................................... 3-2 Controls and Indications .................................................................................................. 3-3 Operation.......................................................................................................................... 3-4 INTERIOR LIGHTING .......................................................................................................... 3-4 Description ....................................................................................................................... 3-4 Controls and Indications .................................................................................................. 3-5 Operation.......................................................................................................................... 3-6 QUESTIONS ........................................................................................................................... 3-7 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 3-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 3-1 Navigation and Strobe Lights................................................................................... 3-2 3-2 Landing and Taxi/Recognition Lights...................................................................... 3-2 3-3 Flashing Beacon ....................................................................................................... 3-3 3-4 Wing Inspection Light.............................................................................................. 3-3 3-5 Courtesy Lights ........................................................................................................ 3-3 3-6 LIGHTS Control Panel ............................................................................................ 3-4 3-7 Interior Lighting Control Knobs .............................................................................. 3-5 3-8 Postlight Replacement.............................................................................................. 3-6 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 3-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 3 LIGHTING INTRODUCTION This chapter describes the exterior and interior lighting systems on the Caravan 208 G1000. GENERAL Exterior lighting on the aircraft includes navigation lights, landing lights, taxi/recognition lights, strobe lights, ice detection light, courtesy lights, and a flashing beacon light. Revision 1 Interior lighting includes instrument lighting and cabin lighting. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 3-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL EXTERIOR LIGHTING DESCRIPTION The exterior lighting system illuminates the aircraft for day or night operation. The exterior lights include: • Navigation lights on each wingtip and one on the tail cone • Landing lights on each wing • Taxi-recognition lights on each wing for night operation of the aircraft. The strobe lights are protected by the STROBE LIGHT circuit breaker on the CB panel. Landing and Taxi/Recognition Lights A landing light in the leading edge of each wing illuminates the area forward of the aircraft during landing and ground operations (Figure 3-2) The landing lights are protected by the LEFT LDG LIGHT and RIGHT LDG LIGHT circuit breakers on the CB panel. • Strobe lights on each wing • Flashing beacon on top of the tail • Wing inspection light on the leading edge of the left wing • Courtesy lights under each wing COMPONENTS Navigation and Strobe Lights Conventional navigation lights are on the wingtips and tail cone stinger (Figure 3-1). The lights are protected by the NAV LIGHT circuit breaker on the CB panel. Figure 3-2. Landing and Taxi/Recognition Lights A strobe light with a remote power supply is on each wingtip (Figure 3-1). The lights enhance anticollision protection and are required Using the landing lights to enhance aircraft visibility in the traffic pattern or enroute is not recommended because of the short service life of the lights. The taxi/recognition lights have longer service life and are designed for this purpose. NAV STROBE NOTE A taxi/recognition light is inboard of each landing light in the leading edge of each wing (Figure 3-2). The lights illuminate the area forward of the aircraft during ground operation and taxiing. The lights also make the aircraft more visible in the traffic pattern or enroute. The taxi/recognition lights are protected by the TAXI LIGHT circuit breaker on the CB panel. Figure 3-1. Navigation and Strobe Lights 3-2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL WARNING Turn off strobe lights when taxiing. Ground operation of the high-intensity strobe lights considerably annoys ground personnel and other pilots. Do not operate strobe lights in fog, clouds, or haze because reflection of the light beam can cause disorientation or dizziness. Flashing Beacon Light A red flashing beacon light, visible for 360°, is on top of the vertical fin for additional anticollision protection in flight and for recognition on the ground (Figure 3-3). The light is protected by the BEACON LIGHT circuit breaker on the CB panel. Figure 3-4. Wing Inspection Light Courtesy Lights A courtesy light under each wing illuminates the area outside the aircraft next to the door (Figure 3-5). The lights operate in conjunction with the cabin lights and are controlled by the CABIN switch on the lighting control panel. Figure 3-3. Flashing Beacon WARNING Figure 3-5. Courtesy Lights Do not operate the beacon light when flying through clouds or overcast conditions. The light reflects from water particles in the atmosphere, particularly at night, causing disorientation or dizziness. CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS The switches on the LIGHTS panel control all exterior lights (Figure 3-6), except for the wing inspection lights, which are controlled by a switch on the ANTI-ICE panel. Wing Inspection Lights A wing inspection light pointing to the leading edge of the left wing provides illumination for ice detection on the wings (Figure 3-4). Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 3-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL light. The switch is spring-loaded to the off position and must be held in the ON position to illuminate the wing inspection light. OPERATION Refer to the Pilot’s Operating Handbook and Airplane Flight Manual (POH/AFM) for more information on the exterior lighting. INTERIOR LIGHTING DESCRIPTION Instrument and control panel lighting is provided by integral, flood, and post lights. Six lighting control knobs on the DIMMING panel are grouped together on the lower part of the instrument panel left of the control pedestal. Figure 3-6. LIGHTS Control Panel The white-capped switches on the LIGHTS control panel are ON in the up position and OFF in the down position: • LEFT LDG switch— Controls the left landing light. • TAXI/RECOG switch—Controls the taxi/recognition lights during ground operation. • Instrument panel • Pedestal • Overhead panel • Left sidewall panel • LED panels • Avionics displays • Internally lighted instruments • NAV switch—Controls the wingtip and tail cone navigation lights. The interior lighting is protected by the AVN/FLOOD LIGHT and INST LIGHT circuit breakers on the left sidewall CB panel. Other lighting provided or available includes control wheel map lights, cabin lights, passenger reading lights, and a no smoking/seat belt sign. • BCN switch—Controls the beacon light on top of the vertical stabilizer. Postlight • RIGHT LDG switch—Controls the right landing light. • STROBE switch—Controls the wingtip strobe lights. WING LIGHT Switch The two-position WING LIGHT switch on the ANTI-ICE switch panel controls the wing 3-4 The controls vary the brightness of the following panels: A single postlight on the overhead panel illuminates both flap switches. A recessed light illuminates the oxygen gauge. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Electroluminescent Lighting CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS Electroluminescent lights (EL) and floodlights illuminate the instrument panel. The EL lights illuminate the HF, automatic direction finder (ADF) standby, and radio instruments internally. CABIN Switch Floodlights Floodlights illuminate the left sidewall panel, the right sidewall panel, and CB panel. The center light illuminates the control pedestal. Cabin lighting controls consist of a CABIN toggle switch on the LIGHTS panel (see Figure 3-6), a rocker switch forward of the aft passenger door, and a rocker switch forward of the aft cargo door. A map light is on the bottom of the control wheel for checking maps and other flight data during night operations. The CABIN switch controls the four overhead panel lights in the aircraft interior and the courtesy light under each wing. Any of the three switches can be used to toggle all cabin lights on or off at any time, regardless of the other switch position. The cabin lights circuit i s p r o t e c t e d b y t h e C A B I N LT S c i r c u i t breaker.The light circuit requires no power from the main electrical bus for operation. Cabin Lights NO SMOKE Switch Four cabin lights are in the center forward cabin on the ceiling. The lights illuminate the passenger boarding areas and the cargo loading areas. The NO SMOKE toggle switch on the LIGHTS control panel (see Figure 3-6) illuminates and extinguishes the NO SMOKING light. Passenger Reading Lights The controls are used to vary the intensity of the instrument panel, left sidewall CB panel, pedestal, and overhead panel lighting. Map Light Passenger reading lights are near each aft passenger position. Eleven small convenience lights are in the panels above the seats. NO SMOKING/SEAT BELT Light A lighted warning sign in the cabin headliner immediately aft of the overhead console informs passengers when to fasten seat belts and when no smoking is in effect. AVIONICS The AVIONICS knob on the lower part of the instrument panel left of the control pedestal varies the intensity of the avionics displays (Figure 3-7). Rotating the knob clockwise increases panel brightness; rotating the knob counterclockwise decreases brightness. Windshield Ice Detection Light A red windshield ice detection light is on the lower inboard portion of the pilot windshield. If the windshield is clear of ice, a distinct red circle is present above the light. If the windshield is contaminated, the red circle become more diffused and the area of red light increases. Revision 1 Figure 3-7. Interior Lighting Control Knobs FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 3-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL STANDBY IND OPERATION The STANDBY IND knob (Figure 3-7) varies the intensity of the standby airspeed indicator, attitude indicator, altimeter, torque indicator, and magnetic compass. Rotating the knob clockwise increases panel brightness; rotating the knob counterclockwise decreases brightness. Bulb Replacement During Flight SW/CB Panels The SW/CB PANELS knob varies the intensity of backlit panels (see Figure 3-7). The panels have labels for most of the switches, controls, and circuit breakers on the instrument panel. Clockwise rotation of the knob increases panel brightness; counterclockwise rotation of the knob decreases brightness. Ensure that spare bulbs are stored in the map compartment. If a spare bulb is unavailable, an identical bulb from other lights can be substituted for the defective bulb. Postlight To replace the postlight bulb, grasp the lens cap, and pull the bulb straight out of the socket (Figure 3-8). Pull the bulb from the cap and replace it with an MS25237-327 bulb. Replace the cap in the socket, and then rotate it to direct the light in the desired direction. CB/PED/OVHD Control Knob The CB/PED/OVHD knob (see Figure 3-7) varies the intensity of the lights illuminating the left sidewall switch and CB panel, the control pedestal floodlights, and the overhead panel post lights. Rotating the knob clockwise increases panel brightness; rotating the knob counterclockwise decreases brightness. FLOOD Control Knobs The LEFT FLOOD knob (see Figure 3-7) varies the brightness of the left overhead panel floodlight. The RIGHT FLOOD knob varies the brightness of the right overhead panel floodlight. Rotating the knob clockwise increases brightness; rotating the knob counterclockwise decreases brightness. Figure 3-8. Postlight Replacement Control Wheel Map Light A control wheel map light is on the bottom of each control wheel. The map lights illuminate the lower portion of the cabin in front of the pilot and copilot. Rotating the control wheel clockwise increases brightness; rotating the control wheel counterclockwise decreases brightness. 3-6 Control Wheel Map Lights To replace the map light bulb, grasp the rim of the bulb, push it straight up, and then turn the bulb counterclockwise as far as possible. Pull the bulb straight down and out of the socket. The replacement bulb is a 24 RB. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL QUESTIONS 1. Use landing lights during: A. Landing and takeoff B. Landing only C. Taxiing D. Cruising 2. The taxi/recognition lights are: A. On the nose gear B. On the wingtips C. In the wing leading edges D. In the front of the engine cowl 3. The strobe lights are required: A. In instrument conditions B. During night operations C. Whenever the engine is operating D. Only when taxiing 4. The courtesy lights are controlled by the: A. Exterior lighting switch B. Cabin light switch C. Landing light switch D. Battery switch 5. The flashing beacon is used for: A. Anticollision protection B. Recognition during ground operations C. Operation in instrument conditions D. Both A and B Revision-0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 3-7 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 4 MASTER WARNING SYSTEM CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 4-1 GENERAL............................................................................................................................... 4-1 CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS ........................................................................................ 4-2 CAS Messages ................................................................................................................. 4-2 OPERATION ........................................................................................................................... 4-2 QUESTIONS ........................................................................................................................... 4-5 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 4-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL TABLE Title 4-1 Revision 0 Page CAS Message Indications ........................................................................................ 4-3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 4-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 4 MASTER WARNING SYSTEM INTRODUCTION The master warning system on the Cessna Caravan 208 G1000 provides warnings of equipment malfunctions, indications of unsafe operating conditions requiring immediate attention, and indications that specific systems are in operation. GENERAL Warnings, cautions, and advisories for the aircraft are presented on the primary flight display (PFD). The annunciation window is to the right of the altimeter and vertical speed indicator. All aircraft warning alerts can be displayed simultaneously in the annunciation window. The annunciation window displays abbreviated crew alerting system (CAS) messages in red, amber, and white to indicate system conditions and malfunctions. Revision 0 An alerts window can be displayed below the annunciation window. The alerts window displays text messages for up to 64 alert messages, displayed by order of decreasing criticality. The G1000 system automatically adjusts for changing ambient light conditions. Depending on the alert type, an ALERTS softkey can flash with an alert and assume a new label consistent with the alert level (red WARNING, amber CAUTION, or white ADVISORY). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 4-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS CAS MESSAGES Table 4-1 describes each CAS message, its color, and the cause for its appearance. OPERATION When the annunciation window is displayed, the flight management system (FMS) knob can be used to scroll through the messages. A white horizontal line separates acknowledged annunciations from those that are not yet acknowledged. Pressing the ALERTS softkey displays the ALERTS window. The FMS knob can then be used to scroll through the alert messages. Pressing the ALERTS softkey a second time closes the ALERTS window. Selecting the flashing softkey acknowledges the alert, and the softkey returns to the alerts. If alerts are still present the ALERTS label appears in white with black text. WARNING—A WARNING alert, which is accompanied by a continuous chime, requires immediate attention. Pressing the WARNING softkey acknowledges the WARNING alert and stops the chime. CAUTION—A CAUTION alert, which is accompanied by a single chime, indicates abnormal conditions that can require intervention. Pressing the CAUTION softkey acknowledges the alert. ADVISORY—This level of alert, which generates no aural tone, provides general information. Pressing the ADVISORY softkey acknowledges the alert. 4-2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 4-1. CAS MESSAGES INDICATIONS CAS MESSAGE OIL PRESS LOW VOLTAGE LOW VOLTAGE HIGH ENGINE FIRE RSVR FUEL LOW BATTERY OVHT EMERG PWR LVR A-ICE PRESS LOW FUEL SELECT OFF GENERATOR OVHT BETA BATTERY HOT GENERATOR OFF DOOR UNLATCHED L FUEL LOW R FUEL LOW L-R FUEL LOW FUEL BOOST ON STBY PWR INOP ALTNR OVHT A-ICE FLUID LO PROP DI-ICE FUEL PRESS LOW STARTER ON CHIP DETECT A-ICE PRESS HI L P/S HEAT R P/S HEAT L-R P/S HEAT STALL HEAT GENERATOR AMPS ALTNR AMPS ETM EXCEED ETM EXCEED PREV EXCEED ETM CAPTURE IGNITION ON A-ICE NORM A-ICE HIGH SPD NOT AVAIL ETM FAULT PFD1 FAN FAIL PDF2 FAN FAIL MFD FAN FAIL STBY PWR ON Revision 0 ALERTS WINDOW MESSAGE Engine oil pressure is low. Bus voltage is low. Bus voltage is high. Excessive temperature or fire in engine compartment. Fuel starvation imminent. Battery temperature is critically high. Emergency power lever is not normal. Anti-ice system pressure is low. One or both fuel tank selectors are off. Generator temperature is critically high. Propeller is operating in beta mode. Battery temperature is high. Generator is not connected to the aircraft bus. Upper cargo/aft passenger door not latched. Left fuel tank is low. Right fuel tank is low. Both fuel tanks are low. Auxiliary fuel pump is operating. Standby alternator is inoperative. Standby alternator temperature is critically high. Anti-ice system fluid level is low. Propeller heater is inoperative. Fuel pressure is low. Starter-generator is in starter mode. Metal chips detected in oil. Anti-ice system pressure is high. Left pitot/static heater is inoperative. Right pitot/static heater is inoperative. Both pitot/static heaters are inoperative. Stall vane heater is inoperative. Check generator current. Check alternator current. Engine Trend Monitor has detected an exceedance. Engine Trend Monitor has detected an event. Engine Trend Monitor shows a previous exceedance. Engine Trend Monitor is logging trend data. Engine ignition is active. Anti-ice system is operating in normal mode. Anti-ice system is operating in high mode. “SPD” key pressed on Autopilot Mode Control panel. OPTIONAL AUDIO ALERT X REPEATING CHIME X X X X SINGLE CHIME X X X NONE Standby alternator is on. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 4-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK 4-4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL QUESTIONS 1. A WARNING ALERT accompanied by a continuous chime indicates a condition that: A. Is advisory in nature B. Is normal during takeoff and landing C. Requires immediate attention D. The warning system is in error 2. Pressing the ALERTS softkey for the crew alert system displays the: A. ALERTS window B. Status of scheduled maintenance C. Next waypoint in the flight plan D. Hazardous weather detected within 100 NM of the aircraft position Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 4-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 5 FUEL SYSTEM CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 5-1 GENERAL............................................................................................................................... 5-1 DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................... 5-3 COMPONENTS ...................................................................................................................... 5-3 Drain Valves ..................................................................................................................... 5-3 Fuel Pumps....................................................................................................................... 5-4 Fuel Filter......................................................................................................................... 5-4 CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS ........................................................................................ 5-4 FUEL TANK SELECTORS Lever.......................................................................................... 5-4 FUEL SHUTOFF PULL OFF Knob ....................................................................................... 5-4 FUEL BOOST Switch ............................................................................................................. 5-4 Audio Alerts ..................................................................................................................... 5-5 Fuel Filter Bypass Flag .................................................................................................... 5-5 Fuel Flow Indication ........................................................................................................ 5-5 Fuel Quantity Indication .................................................................................................. 5-5 CAS Messages ................................................................................................................. 5-6 OPERATION ........................................................................................................................... 5-6 Preflight............................................................................................................................ 5-6 LIMITATIONS ........................................................................................................................ 5-7 Fuel Quantity Indications................................................................................................. 5-7 Approved Fuel Grades (Specifications)........................................................................... 5-7 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 5-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL EMERGENCY/ABNORMAL ................................................................................................ 5-9 Fuel Tank Selection OFF During Engine Start................................................................ 5-9 Fuel System Failure or Fuel Flow Interruption .............................................................. 5-9 QUESTIONS ......................................................................................................................... 5-11 5-ii FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 5-1 Fuel System .............................................................................................................. 5-2 5-2 Fuel Filter Bypass Flag ............................................................................................ 5-3 5-3 FUEL TANK SELECTORS Levers ......................................................................... 5-4 5-4 FUEL SHUTOFF PULL OFF Knob........................................................................ 5-4 5-5 FUEL BOOST Switch.............................................................................................. 5-5 5-6 Fuel Flow and Quantity Indicators........................................................................... 5-6 TABLES Table Title Page 5-1 Approved Fuel Grades ............................................................................................. 5-7 5-2 Fuel Capacities ......................................................................................................... 5-8 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 5-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 5 FUEL SYSTEM INTRODUCTION This chapter presents information on the fuel system of the Cessna Caravan 208 G1000. A single integral fuel tank in each wing stores fuel. The fuel distribution system provides fuel to the engine from either or both tanks. Warnings and indications are provided for safety. GENERAL The aircraft fuel system includes two vented, integral fuel tanks with shutoff valves, a fuelselector-off warning system, a fuel reservoir, an ejector fuel pump, an electric auxiliary boost pump, a reservoir manifold assembly, a Revision 0 firewall shutoff valve, a fuel filter, an oil-tofuel heater, an engine-driven fuel pump, a fuel control unit, a flow divider, dual manifolds, and 14 fuel nozzle assemblies (Figure 5-1). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 5-1 5-2 FUEL MANIFOLD FLOW DIVIDER/ FUEL CAN DUMP VALVE AND DRAIN FUEL FLOW TRANSDUCER FUEL CONTROL UNIT FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY FUEL FILTER BYPASS INDICATOR ENGINE DRIVEN FUEL PUMP FUEL HEATER LEGEND FUEL FILTER CONTROL/BIAS PRESSURE VENT FIREWALL SHUTOFF VALVE MOTIVE FLOW PRESSURE BOOST PUMP PRESSURE FIREWALL VENT BYPASS/DRAIN FUEL GRAVITY/SUCTION RESERVOIR MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY FUEL INSIDE TANK P BOOST PUMP MAIN EJECTOR PUMP RESERVOIR LOW-FUEL SENSOR FUEL QUANTITY TRANSMITTERS FUEL QUANTITY TRANSMITTERS FUEL DRAIN RESERVOIR FUEL CAP FUEL CAP SHUTOFF VALVES RIGHT FUEL TANK LEFT FUEL TANK FUEL LOW SWITCH FUEL SWITCH VENT WITH FLOAT VALVE AND PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE FUEL DRAINS FUEL LOW SWITCH SHUTOFF VALVES Revision 1 Figure 5-1. Fuel System FUEL DRAINS VENT WITH FLOAT VALVE AND PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL VENT CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL WARNING Unusable fuel levels for this aircraft were determined according to federal aviation regulations. Failure to operate the aircraft in compliance with the “Fuel Limitations” specified in Section 2 of the Pilot’s Operating Handbook or Airplane Flight Manual (POH/AFM) can further reduce the amount of fuel available in flight. DESCRIPTION Fuel flows from the tanks through the two fuel tank shutoff valves at each tank. Fuel flows by gravity from the shutoff valves in each tank to the fuel reservoir. The reservoir is at the low point in the fuel system, which maintains a head of fuel around the ejector pump and boost pump in the reservoir. The head of fuel prevents pump cavitation in low fuel quantity situations, especially during in-flight maneuvering. Reservoir fuel is pumped by the ejector pump or by the electric auxiliary boost pump to the reservoir manifold. The ejector pump, which is driven by motive fuel flow from the fuel control unit, normally provides fuel flow during engine operation. If the ejector pump fails, then the electric pump starts automatically, thereby supplying fuel to the engine-driven pump. The boost pump supplies fuel flow during starting. Fuel in the reservoir manifold flows through a fuel shutoff valve on the aft side of the firewall. The shutoff valve allows the pilot to stop all fuel flow to the engine. After passing through the shutoff valve, fuel is routed through a fuel filter on the front side of the firewall. If the fuel filter becomes blocked with foreign material, the filter begins bypassing fuel, and a red filter bypass flag on the top of the filter extends upward (Figure 5-2). Fuel from the filter is routed through the oilto-fuel heater to the engine-driven fuel pump, Revision 1 Figure 5-2. Fuel Filter Bypass Flag where the pressurized fuel is delivered to the fuel control unit. The fuel control unit meters the fuel and directs it to the flow divider, which distributes the fuel to the dual manifolds and 14 fuel nozzles in the combustion chamber. Fuel rejected by the engine on shutdown drains into a fireproof fuel can on the front left side of the firewall. Vent lines with check valves from each fuel tank vent the fuel system. The vent lines protrude from the trailing edge of the wing at the wingtips. The fuel reservoir is vented to both wing tanks. The fuel vent system must be operational for flight. Complete blockage causes decreased fuel flow and eventual engine stoppage. COMPONENTS DRAIN VALVES Drain valves are on: • Lower surface of each wing at the inboard end of the fuel tank • Left side of the cargo pod for podequipped aircraft • Underside of the fuselage if the cargo pod is not installed FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 5-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL The drain valves for the wing tanks are externally flush-mounted, tool-operated poppet valves. FUEL PUMPS The fuel reservoir has an ejector pump and a boost pump. The ejector pump is driven by motive flow fuel and provides fuel flow during normal engine operation. The boost pump operates for engine starting and when fuel pressure drops below 4.75 psi. It is controlled by the FUEL BOOST switch. Each selector mechanically controls the position of two fuel tank shutoff valves at each wing tank. FUEL SHUTOFF PULL OFF KNOB The manual firewall fuel shutoff valve is controlled by a red FUEL SHUTOFF PULL OFF push-pull knob on the right side of the pedestal (Figure 5-4). The knob has a press-to-release button in the center that locks the knob in position when the button is released. FUEL FILTER Raw fuel flowing to the powerplant is filtered to remove contaminant particles, which can stop the engine. The fuel filter has a bypass mechanism that reroutes fuel around the filter if the filter becomes clogged. CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS FUEL TANK SELECTORS LEVER Left and right FUEL TANK SELECTORS are on the overhead panel; each has ON and OFF positions (Figure 5-3). Figure 5-4. FUEL SHUTOFF PULL OFF Knob FUEL BOOST SWITCH The FUEL BOOST switch is on the left sidewall switch panel (Figure 5-5). The switch has OFF, NORM, and ON positions. When the switch is positioned to OFF, the fuel boost pump is inoperative. Figure 5-3. FUEL TANK SELECTORS Levers 5-4 When the switch is positioned to NORM, the pump is armed and operates when fuel pressure in the fuel manifold assembly drops below 4.75 psi. The NORM position is used for all normal engine operations in which main fuel FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL AUDIO ALERTS A single chime sounds if either or both FUEL TANK SELECTOR controls are positioned to OFF. The aural alert system is powered through the START CONT circuit breaker and has its own nonpullable FUEL SEL WARN circuit breaker. FUEL FILTER BYPASS FLAG A red filter bypass flag is on top of the fuel filter. The extended red flag indicates that the fuel filter is clogged and that raw fuel is entering the powerplant. The flag remains up until reset by a maintenance technician. The flag must not be reset by the pilot. FUEL FLOW INDICATION A fuel flow indication beneath the fuel quantity gauges indicates fuel consumption in pounds per hour based on Jet A fuel (Figure 5-6). Fuel flow is measured downstream of the fuel control unit before the fuel is routed to the flow divider. The fuel flow indication receives power from a F FLOW NG and NP and PROP RPM circuit breaker on the CB panel. FUEL QUANTITY INDICATION Fuel quantity is measured by four fuel quantity transmitters (two in each tank) and indicated on the engine instrument system (EIS) on the multifunction display (MFD) (Figure 5-6). Figure 5-5. FUEL BOOST Switch is provided by the ejector pump and the boost pump is used as a standby. An amber FUEL BOOST ON crew alerting system (CAS) message indicates that the boost pump is cycling on and off when the switch is positioned to NORM. When the switch is positioned to ON, the boost pump operates continuously. The ON position is used for engine start. Revision 1 The fuel quantity indications display volume in pounds (based on the weight of Jet A fuel on a standard day) and gallons. A red line and the letter E indicate an empty tank. When the indicator shows an empty tank, approximately 2.5 gallons of unusable fuel remain in the tank. The fuel quantity indicators receive power from the LEFT FUEL QTY and RIGHT FUEL QTY circuit breakers on the left sidewall CB panel. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 5-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL WARNING The reservoir tank holds only enough fuel for 90 seconds of engine operation at maximum continuous power after the RSVR FUEL LOW CAS message appears. L and/or R FUEL LOW (amber) (one for each wing tank)—Appears on each PFD when the respective wing tank has 25 gallons or less of usable fuel. FUEL BOOST ON (amber)—Appears when the boost pump cycles on and off. FUEL PRESS LOW (amber)—Appears when fuel pressure in the reservoir fuel manifold assembly is below 4.75 psi. OPERATION Figure 5-6. Fuel Flow and Quantity Indicators PREFLIGHT Fuel Selectors WARNING The accuracy of the fuel quantity indicator is affected in flight by uncoordinated flight, or on the ground by a sloping ramp. To obtain an accurate reading on the ground, verify that the aircraft is parked in a laterally level condition. To do so in flight, verify that the aircraft is in a coordinated, stable condition. CAS MESSAGES RSVR FUEL LOW (red)—Appears when the reservoir fuel level drops to approximately one-half full. 5-6 Either the left or right fuel tanks or both tanks can be selected at the same time. Normal operation is with both tanks on. For starting, both tanks must be on. Positioning a selector to OFF stops fuel from the respective wing tank to the reservoir tank. Normal fuel management is with both fuel selectors ON. With the FUEL TANK SELECTOR switches both positioned to OFF, it is possible to start, taxi, or take off before the reservoir tank fuel is exhausted. Before refueling or when the aircraft is parked on a slope, move either or both fuel selectors positioned to OFF. If only one tank is turned off when parked on a slope, select the higher wing tank to the OFF position. Doing so prevents FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL crossfeeding between tanks and reduces fuel seepage from the wing tank vents. Fireproof Fuel Can Drain the fireproof fuel can once daily during preflight inspection, or at least after six engine shutdowns. A drain valve on the bottom left of the cowling enables draining of the fuel can contents into a suitable container. If the fuel is not drained regularly, the can overflows its contents overboard. Fuel Drains Before each flight and after each refueling, use a clear sampler and drain fuel from the inboard fuel tank sump quick-drain valves, fuel reservoir quick-drain valve, and fuel filter quick-drain valve. The sampler determines whether contaminants are present and if the aircraft is fueled with the proper fuel. The wing tank drain valves are opened and closed by pressing on the valve with a Phillips screwdriver. On pod-equipped aircraft the reservoir drain valve is controlled by a double-button, push-pull, drain control knob. Pulling the knob out drains the reservoir out of the rear fuel drain pipe next to the drain valve. On aircraft with no optional pod, the reservoir drain valve includes a flush-mounted poppet valve, which when pressed and then turned, locks the valve open, if required. The indicator indicates if the aircraft is parked with one wing low. Draining the outboard valve on the low wing is recommended. If contamination is detected, drain all fuel drain points again. Take repeated samples from all fuel drain points until all contamination has been removed. If, after repeating the sampling, evidence of contamination still exists, drain the fuel tanks completely and clean the fuel system. Do not fly the aircraft with contaminated or unapproved fuel. WARNING JP-4 and other naphtha-based fuels can cause severe skin and eye irritation. LIMITATIONS FUEL QUANTITY INDICATIONS Red line (minimum) ..... E (3.6 U.S. gallons; 2.8 gallons per tank) APPROVED FUEL GRADES (SPECIFICATIONS) Refer to Table 5-1 for approved fuel grades. Aviation Fuel All grades of military and commercial aviation gasoline are restricted to emergency use. Do not use such fuel for more than 150 hours in one overhaul period. A mixture of one part aviation gasoline and three parts of Jet A, Jet A-1, JP-1, or JP-5 can be used for emergency purposes for a maximum of 450 hours per overhaul period. Table 5-1. APPROVED FUEL GRADES SNs 208B0090 AND SUBSEQUENT MODIFIED WITH SK208-52 Revision 0 TOTAL FUEL 335.6 U.S. GALLONS (167.8 GALLONS PER TANK) USABLE FUEL 332.0 U.S. GALLONS (165.0 GALLONS PER TANK) UNUSABLE FUEL 3.6 U.S. GALLONS (2.8 GALLONS PER TANK) FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 5-7 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Approved Fuel Additives The aircraft requires that either ethylene glycol (EGME) or diethylene glycol monomethyl ether be incorporated or added to the fuel during refueling as an anti-icing additive. CAUTION JP-4 and JP-5 fuel per MIL-T-5624 and JP-8 fuel per MIL-T-83133A contain the correct premixed quantity of approved anti-icing fuel additive. Do not add additional anti-ice compounds. If additional anti-static protection is desired, the additive Dupont ® Stadis 450 is approved for use. If additional biocidal protection is desired, the additives Sohio Biobor JF or Kathon® FP1.5 additives are permitted for use in certain conditions. Refer to Section 8 of the POH/AFM for additional information. Fuel Capacity Refer to Table 5-2 for fuel capacities. NOTE To achieve full fuel tank capacity fill the tank to the top of the filler neck. Filling fuel tanks to the bottom of the fuel filler collar (level with flapper valve) allows space for thermal expansion, decreasing fuel capacity by 4 gallons per side (8 gallons total). Fuel Limitations With low fuel reserves, indicated by an amber L and/or R FUEL LOW CAS message, continuous uncoordinated flight with the slip-skid indicator more than one-quarter bar out of the center position is prohibited. Unusable fuel quantity increases when more severe sideslip is maintained. Because of possible fuel starvation, maximum full rudder sideslip duration time is 3 minutes.Maximum fuel imbalance in flight is 200 lbs. For additional limitations of this aircraft, refer to the POH/AFM. Table 5-2. FUEL CAPACITIES FUEL GRADE SPECIFICATIONS 5-8 MINIMUM FUEL TEMPERATURE FOR TAKEOFF JET A ASTM-D1655 –35° C JET A-1 ASTM-D1655 –40° C JET B ASTM-D1655 –45° C JP-1 MIL-L-5616 –35° C JP-4 MIL-T-5624 –54° C JP-5 MIL-T-5624 –40° C JP-8 MIL-T-83133A –40° C AVIATION GASOLINE (ALL GRADES) –54° C FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL EMERGENCY/ ABNORMAL position the IGNITION and the FUEL BOOST switches to ON. FUEL TANK SELECTION OFF DURING ENGINE START The fuel-selector-off warning system functions as follows with the battery on: • If both fuel tank shutoff valves are closed, then the red FUEL SELECT OFF CAS message appears and a warning horn is activated. • If either fuel tank shutoff valve closes during engine start (STARTER switch positioned to START or MOTOR), then the red FUEL SELECT OFF CAS message appears and both warning horns are activated. • If one fuel selector is positioned to OFF and fuel remaining in the tank being used is less than 25 gallons, then the red FUEL SELECT OFF CAS message appears and a warning horn is activated. If the RSVR FUEL LOW CAS message appears steady, and usable fuel in the wing tanks is indicated, then monitor engine indications and the amber FUEL PRESS LOW CAS message for signs of fuel starvation. Land as soon as possible, and then determine the cause of the RSVR FUEL LOW CAS message. WARNING If fuel starvation is indicated, prepare for a forced landing as described in the Emergency Landing Without E n g i n e P ow e r p r o c e d u r e i n t h e POH/AFM. For specific information on emergency/abnormal procedures, refer to the POH/AFM. If the FUEL SEL WARN circuit breaker trips or the START CONT circuit breaker is pulled, then the FUEL SELECT OFF CAS message appears but no warning horn is activated, even if both fuel selectors are positioned to ON. The warning indicates that the fuel selector warning system is deactivated. If either fuel tank selector is positioned to OFF during engine start, then position the selector to ON. FUEL SYSTEM FAILURE OR FUEL FLOW INTERRUPTION If the main ejector pump fails when the FUEL BOOST switch is positioned to NORM, then a pressure switch activates the amber FUEL PRESS LOW CAS message and the boost pump when fuel pressure drops below 4.75 psi. If the reservoir fuel level drops to one-half full, then the red RSVR FUEL LOW CAS message appears. Immediately position both FUEL TANK SELECTOR switches to ON, and then Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 5-9 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK 5-10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL QUESTIONS 1. Fuel flows from the wing tanks to the reservoir tank by: A. Fuel boost pump pressure B. Ejector pump pressure C. Gravity D. Fuel control unit pressure 2. Fuel is pumped from the reservoir tank primarily by the: A. Main ejector pump B. Boost pump C. Engine-driven fuel pump D. Fuel control unit 3. If the fuel filter becomes blocked: A. Fuel starvation occurs and the engine stops. B. A CAS message appears. C. The red fuel filter bypass flag appears. D. The fuel filter bypass horn sounds. 6. The fuel-selector-off warning system sounds when: A. Both left and right fuel tank shutoff valves are closed. B. Either the left or right fuel tank shutoff valves are closed during an engine start operation. C. One fuel selector is at OFF and fuel remaining in the tank being used is less than 25 gallons. D. All of the above. 7. The auxiliary fuel boost pump switch: A. Is positioned to NORM during all normal engine operations B. Is positioned to OFF except in emergency fuel situations C. Is positioned to ON at all times to prevent fuel starvation D. Is positioned to OFF during all normal engine operations 4. Fuel rejected during engine shutdown: A. Drains onto the ground from the manifold B. Drains into a fireproof fuel can on the firewall C. Drains into the reservoir tank D. Is pumped into the left wing tank 5. The two FUEL TANK SELECTOR knobs on the overhead panel: A. Are both normally ON in flight B. Are both normally OFF during refueling C. Are OFF during ground operations D. Both A and B Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 5-11 The information normally contained in this chapter is not applicable to this particular aircraft. CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 7 POWERPLANT CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 7-1 GENERAL............................................................................................................................... 7-1 MAJOR SECTIONS................................................................................................................ 7-2 Reduction Gear ................................................................................................................ 7-2 Exhaust............................................................................................................................. 7-2 Turbine ............................................................................................................................. 7-2 Combustion ...................................................................................................................... 7-2 Compressor ...................................................................................................................... 7-2 Air Intake ......................................................................................................................... 7-2 Accessory Drive ............................................................................................................... 7-2 ENGINE SYSTEMS ............................................................................................................... 7-2 Engine Lubrication System.............................................................................................. 7-2 Ignition System ................................................................................................................ 7-6 Air Induction System ....................................................................................................... 7-6 Engine Fuel System ......................................................................................................... 7-8 Starting System ................................................................................................................ 7-8 Engine Fire Detection System ....................................................................................... 7-11 COMPONENTS .................................................................................................................... 7-11 Chip Detectors ............................................................................................................... 7-11 Propeller......................................................................................................................... 7-11 Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS ...................................................................................... 7-13 CABIN HEAT FIREWALLSHUTOFF PULL OFF Knob............................................ 7-13 Engine Controls ............................................................................................................. 7-13 Engine Instrument System............................................................................................. 7-15 Engine Monitoring System............................................................................................ 7-18 OPERATION......................................................................................................................... 7-20 New Engine Break-in and Operation ............................................................................ 7-21 Engine Ignition .............................................................................................................. 7-21 Engine Shutdown........................................................................................................... 7-21 LIMITATIONS ...................................................................................................................... 7-21 Engine ............................................................................................................................ 7-21 Powerplant Instrument Markings .................................................................................. 7-22 Placards.......................................................................................................................... 7-22 Propeller......................................................................................................................... 7-22 EMERGENCY/ABNORMAL .............................................................................................. 7-23 Hot Starts ....................................................................................................................... 7-23 Engine Failure During Takeoff Roll .............................................................................. 7-24 Engine Failure Immediately After Takeoff.................................................................... 7-24 Engine Failure During Flight......................................................................................... 7-24 Engine Flameout During Flight..................................................................................... 7-25 Airstart Starter Assist..................................................................................................... 7-25 Airstart No Starter Assist............................................................................................... 7-26 QUESTIONS ......................................................................................................................... 7-29 7-ii FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 7-1 Major Sections.......................................................................................................... 7-3 7-2 Oil System Schematic .............................................................................................. 7-4 7-3 Oil Dipstick/Filler Cap............................................................................................. 7-5 7-4 Oil Dipstick Markings.............................................................................................. 7-5 7-5 IGNITION and STARTER Switches ....................................................................... 7-6 7-6 INERTIAL SEPARATOR Handle and Indications.................................................. 7-7 7-7 Oil-to-Fuel Heater .................................................................................................... 7-9 7-8 Engine Fuel System ............................................................................................... 7-10 7-9 TEST Switch .......................................................................................................... 7-11 7-10 Propeller System (Cruise) ...................................................................................... 7-12 7-11 Engine Controls...................................................................................................... 7-14 7-12 Engine and System Indications.............................................................................. 7-16 7-13 OVERSPEED GOVERNOR PUSH TO TEST Switch ......................................... 7-18 7-14 Engine Air Intake ................................................................................................... 7-20 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 7 POWERPLANT INTRODUCTION This chapter describes the powerplant on the Cessna Caravan 208 G1000. The following associated powerplant monitoring and operating systems are discussed: lubrication, ignition, air induction, fuel, starting, propeller, engine controls, and engine instruments. GENERAL The aircraft is powered by a Pratt and Whitney of Canada PT6A-114A powerplant. It is a free-turbine engine that uses two independent turbines: one driving a compressor in the gas generator section and one driving a reduction gear for the propeller. The turbines are rated at 675 hp. All engine-driven accessories, except for the propeller tachometer-generator and propeller governors, are on the accessory gearbox (AGB) at the rear of the engine. The engine acces- Revision 0 sories are driven by the compressor turbine with a coupling shaft that extends the drive through a conical tube in the oil tank center section. An internal tank contains the main portion of the engine oil supply. The tank, which forms part of the compressor inlet case, has a capacity of 9.5 U.S. quarts and includes a dipstick and drain plug. Total oil system capacity, including tank, engine sumps, lines, and filter, is 14 U.S. quarts. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL MAJOR SECTIONS For descriptive purposes, the engine is divided into seven major sections (Figure 7-1) from front to rear, as follows: • Reduction gear • Exhaust • Turbine • Combustion • Compressor • Air intake • Accessory drive COMBUSTION The combustion section includes a plenum and a reverse-flow combustion chamber. The combustion chamber has two igniter plugs and14 equally spaced fuel nozzles. COMPRESSOR The compressor section has three axial compressor wheels and one centrifugal wheel. All of the wheels are on the gas generator turbine rotor shaft extending aft to drive the accessory gear. REDUCTION GEAR The reduction gear is a two-stage planetary gear, enclosed in a case forming the front of the engine. The planetary gear reduces the high rpm/low torque of the power turbine to the low rpm/high torque required by the propeller. The planetary gear also drives the propeller tach generator, the propeller governor, and the propeller overspeed governor. A conventional torquemeter in the reduction gearcase provides cockpit indication of the power delivered to the propeller. EXHAUST The exhaust section (aft of the reduction gear) includes an annular exit plenum, a heat-resistant cone, and an exhaust port at the 4 o’clock position on the engine. AIR INTAKE The air intake section is circumferential and aft of the compressor. The intake plenum turns the air 180° forward toward the compressor. A circular screen surrounds the engine inlet area. Airflow is directed to the engine air intake by the ram-air inlet scoop on the nacelle. ACCESSORY DRIVE The accessory drive section forms the aft part of the engine and contains the reduction gear for the engine-driven accessories. ENGINE SYSTEMS ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM TURBINE The turbine section includes a single-stage power turbine (propeller turbine ) and a single-stage gas generator turbine (compressor turbine). The turbines are in the combustion and contribute to the short length of the PT6A-114A engine. The power turbine is on a shaft that extends forward to drive the reduction gear. 7-2 The gas generator turbine is on a shaft that extends aft to drive the compressor and the accessory gear. The lubrication system includes a pressure system, a scavenge system, and a breather system (Figure 7-2). The main components of the lubrication system include: • Integral oil tank at the back of the engine • Oil pressure pump at the bottom of the oil tank FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-3 Figure 7-1. Major Sections 7-4 LEGEND SUPPLY OIL OIL TANK BREATHER SCAVANGE OIL CHECK VALVE DEAERATOR FROM OIL COOLER FUEL HEATER CHECK VALVE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY PROP GOV OIL FILLER AND DIPSTICK OIL SUPPLY TO PROP TO OIL COOLER FILTER BYPASS VALVE CENTRIFUGAL BREATHER OIL FILTER AND CHECK VALVE ASSYMBLY RELIEF VALVE RETURN TO OIL TANK SCAVENGE OIL PUMPS PRESSURE TRANSMITTER ACCESSORY GEARBOX DRAIN TEMPERATURE BULB CHIP DETECTOR DRAIN SCAVENGE OIL FROM PROP AND REDUCTION GEARBOX TO TORQUE PRESS IND TO COCKPIT INSTRUMENTS OIL SUPPLY TO PROP AND REDUCTION GEARBOX Revision 0 Figure 7-2. Oil System Schematic RELIEF VALVE OIL PRESS PUMP OIL TANK DRAIN CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL TORQUE OIL CONTROL VALVE CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL • I n t e r n a l d o u b l e - e l e m e n t s c ave n g e pump in the accessory gear box (AGB) • External double-element scavenge pump on the back of the accessory case OIL TANK FILLER CAP • Intern oil filter on the right side of the oil tank • Oil cooler on the right side of the nose cowl DIPSTICK MAX. COLD° An oil dipstick/filler cap is at the left rear of the engine and is accessible when the left side of the upper cowling is raised (Figure 7-3). The oil tank capacity is 9.5 U.S. quarts. Total system capacity is 14 U.S. quarts. The top 5 quarts are measured by the dipstick (Figure 7-4). Maintain the oil level to within 1.5 quarts of MAX HOT or MAX COLD as appropriate. MAX. HOT • Oil-to-fuel heater on the top rear of the accessory case IMPERIAL LITERS 0.833 1 0.95 1.66 2 To obtain an accurate oil reading, check the oil either within 10 minutes after engine shutdown while the oil is hot (MAX HOT mark) or before the first flight of the day while the oil is cold (MAX COLD mark). If engine oil still is warm 10 minutes after engine shutdown, perform an engine dry motoring run before checking the oil level. 1.90 2.49 3 NOTE 2.85 5 US QUARTS 4 QUARTS 3.80 3.32 4.15 4.75 Figure 7-4. Oil Dipstick Markings Figure 7-3. Oil Dipstick/Filler Cap Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL IGNITION SYSTEM Two igniters in the engine combustion chamber provide engine ignition. The igniters are energized by the ignition exciter on the right side of the engine compartment. Electrical energy from the ignition exciter is transmitted through two high-tension leads to the igniters. The ignition system normally is energized only during engine start. Ignition is controlled by an IGNITION and STARTER switches on the left sidewall switch panel (Figure 7-5). The IGNITION switch has an ON and NORM position. The NORM position arms the ignition system for initiation when the STARTER switch is positioned to START. A white IGNITION ON CAS message appears when electrical power is applied to the igniters. The ignition system is protected by an IGN circuit breaker on the CB panel. AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM The engine air inlet is at the front of the engine nacelle left of the propeller spinner. Ram air entering the inlet flows through ducts into an inertial separator system and then through a circulator plenum chamber into the engine. In the plenum chamber, guide vanes direct the airflow into the compressor inlet, which has a screen to prevent entry of large particles into the compressor. Inertial Separator System An inertial separator system in the engine air inlet duct prevents moisture from entering the compressor air inlet plenum when in bypass mode. The inertial separator includes two movable vanes and a fixed airfoil, which during normal operation route the inlet air through a gentle turn into the compressor air inlet plenum (Figure 7-6). Figure 7-5. IGNITION and STARTER Switches Use the NORM position during all ground starts and during airstarts with starter assist. The ON position provides continuous ignition regardless of the STARTER switch position. The ON position is used for: • Airstarts without starter assist • Operation on water-covered runways • Flight during heavy precipitation • Inadvertent icing encounters until the inertial separator has been in bypass for 5 minutes • Operations using the emergency power lever • Near fuel exhaustion, indicated by a RSVR FUEL LOW crew alerting system (CAS) message 7-6 When separation of moisture particles is desired, the vanes are positioned so the inlet air is forced into a sharp turn in order to enter the inlet plenum. The sharp turn separates moisture particles from the inlet air and discharges the moisture overboard through the inertial separator outlet in the left side of the cowling. Inertial separator operation is controlled by the INERTIAL SEPARATOR handle on the lower instrument panel. Engaging the handle results in a slight drop in torque and in movement of the torque bug. Use the BYPASS–PULL position when flying through visible moisture such as clouds, rain, snow, and ice crystals with an outside air temperature (OAT) of (41°F or 5°C) or lower. Use the BYPASS–PULL position for ground operation or takeoff from dusty or sandy conditions to minimize intake of foreign particles into the compressor. Use the NORMAL–PUSH position for all other operations. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 Revision 0 15 FT–LB X100 10 0 LOCK 20 1666 ITT 600 °C 0 900 700 INERTIAL SEPARATOR BYPASS–PULL NORMAL–PUSH 7-7 Figure 7-6. INERTIAL SEPARATOR Handle and Indications CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY TRQ CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL To lock the handle in the NORMAL–PUSH position rotate the handle clockwise one quarter turn to its vertical position. To unlock the handle, push it forward slightly, rotate the handle 90° counterclockwise, and then pull the handle into the BYPASS–PULL position.When in this position the airload on the movable vanes maintains the vane position. an inlet screen and an outlet filter, which allow fuel bypass if a blockage occurs. NOTE The fuel control unit determines the fuel schedule, which provides the power required as established by the power lever input. The fuel scheduling is accomplished by controlling the compressor turbine speed. When moving the INERTIAL SEPARATOR handle from BYPASS– PULL to NORMAL–PUSH during flight, reduce engine power to reduce the control forces. Maintain a firm grip on the handle when operating to prevent the separator vanes from slamming from one position to another under airload force. ENGINE FUEL SYSTEM The engine fuel system includes: • Oil-to-fuel heater The fuel control unit includes: • Fuel metering section • Temperature-compensating section • Gas generator pneumatic governor When the fuel cutoff valve in the fuel control unit closes during engine shutdown, both primary and secondary manifolds are connected to a dump valve port. Residual fuel in the manifolds drains into the fuel can on the firewall, where it is drained daily or after no more than six engine shutdowns. STARTING SYSTEM The starting system includes a starter-genera t o r, a S TA RT E R s w i t c h , a n d a n a m b e r STARTER ON CAS message. • Engine-driven fuel pump • Fuel control unit • Flow divider and dump valve • Dual fuel manifold with 14 simplex nozzles (10 primary and four secondary) The starter-generator functions as a motor for engine starting and motors the gas generator section until 46% N g is reached, at which time the start cycle terminates. • Two fuel drain lines The system provides fuel flow to satisfy engine speed and power demands. Fuel from the aircraft reservoir is delivered to the oil-tofuel heater (Figure 7-7), which uses heat from the engine lubricating oil system to preheat the fuel in the fuel system (Figure 7-8). A fuel temperature-sensing oil bypass valve regulates fuel temperature by allowing oil either to flow through the heater circuit or to bypass it to the engine oil tank. Fuel from the oil-to-fuel heater then enters the engine-driven fuel pump chamber. The pump is on the AGB at the 2 o’clock position and has 7-8 The starter-generator is controlled by a threeposition STARTER switch on the left sidewall switch panel (see Figure 7-5). The switch has OFF, START, and MOTOR positions. The OFF position deenergizes the ignition and starter circuits and is in the normal position at all times except during engine start. The START position energizes the startergenerator, which rotates the gas generator portion of the engine for starting. The START position also energizes the ignition system when the IGNITION switch is in the NORM position. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 Revision 0 FUEL INLET THERMAL ELEMENT OIL INLET OIL OUTLET PUSHROD OPEN SLEEVE VALVE FUEL OUTLET LEGEND WARMED FUEL ENGINE OIL COLD FUEL OIL INLET OIL OUTLET OPEN 7-9 Figure 7-7. Oil-to-Fuel Heater CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY FUEL OUTLET 7-10 ENGINE FUEL SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM FLOW DIVIDER & DUMP VALVE TO FLOW DIVIDER FUEL FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY PX A IR P Y A IR Ng GOVERNOR FUEL SHUTOFF VALVE FUEL FUEL METERING VALVE ENGINE-DRIVEN FUEL PUMP TO Nf GOV. FUEL P 3 A IR FUEL MOTIVE FLOW HEATER RETURN TO RESERVOIR TANK LEGEND HIGH PRESSURE FUEL METERED FUEL MOTIVE FLOW RETURN FUEL PX AIR PY AIR MOTIVE FLOW RETURN TO RESERVOIR TANK GOV. BELLOWS ACCEL. BELLOWS (EVACUATED) TO EMERGENCY POWER LEVER Px CONSTANT REFERENCE AIR Py POWER LEVER SETTING FROM Ng GOVERNOR P3 Revision 1 Figure 7-8. Engine Fuel System FUEL SUPPLY (FROM FUEL PUMP) CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL FUEL CONTROL UNIT CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL When the engine has started, the starter switch must be manually positioned to OFF to deenergize the ignition system and to activate the generator system. COMPONENTS The MOTOR position motors the engine without having the ignition circuit energized and is used for motoring the engine when an engine start is not desired. Engine motoring is used for clearing fuel from the engine, washing the engine compressor, etc. The MOTOR position is spring-loaded to the OFF position. Two chip detectors are on the engine: one on the underside of the reduction gearbox case and one on the underside of the AGB case. The chip detectors drive an amber CHIP DETECT CAS message, which appears when metal chips are detected in either gearbox. This message indicates a need for an engine inspection for abnormal wear. An interlock between the MOTOR position of the STARTER switch and the IGNITION switch prevents the starter from motoring unless the IGNITION switch is in the NORM position. This prevents unintentional engine motoring with the ignition on. Starter contactor operation is indicated by an amber STARTER ON CAS message. ENGINE FIRE DETECTION SYSTEM The engine fire detection system includes a heat sensor in the engine compartment, a red ENGINE FIRE CAS message, and a warning horn above the pilot. A TEST switch is on the left side of the pilot primary flight display (PFD) (Figure 7-9). When the switch is toggled to the FIRE DETECT–UP (up) position, the red ENGINE FIRE CAS message appears and the warning horn sounds, indicating that the fire warning circuitry is operational. The system is protected by a FIRE DET circuit breaker on the CB panel. CHIP DETECTORS PROPELLER The aircraft has an all metal, three-bladed, constant-speed, full-feathering, reversible, singleacting, governor-regulated propeller. A setting introduced into the governor with the propeller control lever establishes the propeller speed (Figure 7-10). The PROP RPM level is on the center control pedestal. To feather the propeller blades, position the control lever to FEATHER. Counterweights and spring tension twist the propeller blades through high pitch and into the streamlined or feathered position. To unfeather the propeller blades, position the PROP RPM lever forward of the FEATHER gate. The unfeathering system uses engine oil pressure to force the propeller out of feather. Reversed propeller pitch decreases landing ground roll. To accomplish reverse pitch, the POWER lever is retarded beyond IDLE and well into the BETA range. Maximum reverse p ow e r i s a c c o m p l i s h e d b y r e t a r d i n g t h e POWER lever to the MAX REVERSE position, which increases power output from the gas generator and positions the propeller blades at full reverse pitch. CAUTION Figure 7-9. TEST Switch Revision 1 To prevent damaging the propeller reversing linkage do not move the POWER lever aft of the IDLE position when the propeller is feathered or when the engine is not running. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-11 7-12 REVERSING CAM FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY FUEL CONTROL UNIT Py AIR AIR BLEED LINK BETA VALVE PILOT VALVE PROPELLER OVERSPEED GOVERNOR TO SUMP FROM SUMP TEST SOLENOID VALVE TO SUMP LEGEND PUMP PRESSURE BYPASS OIL SUMP/STORAGE OIL Revision 0 INLET AIR Figure 7-10. Propeller System (Cruise) CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NORMAL GOVERNOR CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Propeller Governor The propeller governor includes a mechanical governor, a beta control valve, and a pneumatic N f governor. The propeller governor operates in five modes: • • • • • CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS Underspeed Onspeed Overspeed Feathering Beta range CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF PULL OFF KNOB Underspeed With the PROP RPM lever at the desired rpm, an underspeed condition occurs when the propeller rpm falls below the preselected setting or has not reached the selected speed. Onspeed In an onspeed condition in forward thrust, the forces on the engine, propeller, and propeller governor are in balance. With the PROP RPM lever at the desired rpm, the propeller blades are at the correct pitch angle to absorb the power being developed by the engine. The CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF PULL OFF knob is a push-pull knob on the lower right side of the pedestal. When pulled the knob actuates two firewall shutoff valves to the off position. One firewall shutoff valve is in the bleed-air supply line to the cabin heating system and one is in the cabin return line. The knob normally is pushed in unless a fire is indicated in the engine compartment. ENGINE CONTROLS The engine is operated by four separate controls (Figure 7-11): Overspeed With the PROP RPM lever at the desired rpm, an overspeed condition occurs when the propeller rpm is driven above the preselected speed. Overspeed conditions occur during flight altitude changes or sudden power lever changes, or rapid changes in atmospheric condition. Feathering The propeller governor pilot valve is raised mechanically to decrease the oil pressure at the propeller. Under the influence of the return springs and counterweights, the blades are rotated to the feathered position. BETA Operation The BETA operation is nongoverning. Oil pressure to and from the governor is metered Revision 0 by the beta control valve through a mechanical lever and a feedback ring. If the aircraft is equipped, the red BETA CAS message appears when BETA range is selected in flight. • POWER lever • EMERGENCY POWER lever • PROP RPM lever • FUEL CONDITION lever The POWER and FUEL CONDITION levers are used to control the engine and the PROP RPM lever controls propeller speed and feathering. POWER Lever The POWER lever is connected through linkage to a cam in front of the fuel control unit at the rear of the engine. The POWER lever controls engine power, via pneumatic control of the metering valve, from maximum takeoff power back through idle to full reverse. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-13 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL POWER LEVER PROPELLER CONTROLLER ARM FUEL CONDITION LEVER QUADRANT FRICTION LOCK EMERGENCY POWER LEVER Figure 7-11. Engine Controls The lever also selects propeller pitch when in the BETA range. The POWER lever has MAX, IDLE, BETA, and MAX REVERSE range positions. The range from the MAX position through IDLE allows selection of the desired engine power. The BETA range enables the pilot to control propeller blade pitch from idle thrust back through a zero or no-thrust condition to maximum reverse thrust. CAUTION To prevent damaging the propeller reversing linkage do not move the POWER lever aft of the IDLE position when the propeller is feathered or when the engine is not running. EMERGENCY POWER Lever engine if a pneumatic malfunction occurs in the fuel control unit. During engine operation, failure of any pneumatic signal to the fuel control unit decreases fuel flow to minimum idle (approximately 48% Ng). The EMERGENCY POWER lever restores power if such a failure occurs. The EMERGENCY POWER lever has NORMAL, IDLE, and MAX positions. When the fuel control unit is operating normally, the lever is kept in the NORMAL position (full aft) and engine power is selected by the POWER lever. The range from the IDLE to MAX governs engine power and is used when a pneumatic malfunction occurs in the fuel control unit and the POWER lever is ineffective. A mechanical stop in the lever slot requires the EMERGENCY POWER lever be moved to the left to clear the stop before it can be moved from NORMAL (full aft) to IDLE. The EMERGENCY POWER lever is linked to the mechanical override lever on the fuel control unit. This lever governs fuel supply to the 7-14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NOTE If the EMERGENCY POWER lever is not stowed in the NORMAL position, then the red EMERG PWR LVR CAS message appears. This precaution is intended to prevent engine starts if the EMERGENCY POWER lever is not positioned to NORMAL, which can cause a hot start or overtemperature condition. CAUTION The EMERGENCY POWER lever and its associated manual override system is an emergency system and is used only when a fuel control unit malfunctions. Inappropriate use of the EMERGENCY POWER lever can adversely affect engine operation and durability. Using the EMERG E N C Y P OW E R l e v e r d u r i n g n o r m a l operation of the POWER lever can cause engine surges or exceedance of interstage turbine temperature (ITT), N g, and torque limits. PROP RPM Lever The PROP RPM lever is linked to the propeller governor on the top front section of the engine. The lever controls propeller governor settings from the MAX rpm position to the full FEATHER position. The PROP RPM lever has MAX, MIN, and FEATHER positions. The MAX position, which is used when high rpm is desired, governs the propeller speed at 1,900 rpm. The PROP RPM lever settings from the MAX position to the MIN position permit selection of the desired engine propeller rpm for cruise. The FEATHER position is used during normal engine shutdown to stop rotation of the power turbine and front engine section. Since lubrication is unavailable after the gas generator section of the engine shuts down, rotation of the forward engine section is undesirable. Revision 1 Feathering the propeller during engine shut down minimizes propeller windmilling under windy conditions. A mechanical stop in the lever slot requires the PROP RPM lever be moved to the left to clear the stop before it can be positioned into or out of FEATHER. FUEL CONDITION Lever The FUEL CONDITION lever is linked to a combined lever and stop mechanism on the fuel control unit. The lever and stop also function as an idle stop for the fuel control unit and for the fuel control unit rod. The FUEL CONDITION lever controls the minimum rpm of the gas generator turbine (N g) when the POWER lever is positioned to IDLE. The FUEL CONDITION lever has the following positions: • CUTOFF—Shuts off all fuel to the engine fuel nozzles. • LOW IDLE—Positions the control rod stop to provide an rpm of 52% N g. • HIGH IDLE—Positions the control rod stop to provide an rpm of 65% N g. Quadrant Friction Lock A quadrant friction lock on the right side of the pedestal minimizes creeping of engine controls once they are set. The friction lock is a knurled knob that increases friction on the engine controls when rotated clockwise. ENGINE INSTRUMENT SYSTEM The engine instrument system (EIS) provides graphical indications and numeric values for engine, fuel, and electrical system parameters (Figure 7-12). The EIS is displayed in a vertical strip on the left side of the PFD during engine starts and on the multifunction display (MFD) during normal operation. If either the MFD or PFD fails during flight, the EIS is shown on the remaining display. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-15 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL • Oil pressure • Oil temperature • Fuel quantity • Fuel flow • Battery amps • Bus voltage • Anti-ice fluid remaining • Propeller amps When the ENGINE softkey is pressed, the SYSTEM softkey appears next to the ENGINE softkey. The SYSTEM page displays numerical values for parameters on the ENGINE page that are shown as indications only. Torque, ITT, N g% and N g RPM are displayed identically on the SYSTEM page. The SYSTEM page also provides numerical indication for fuel quantity, fuel totalizer (pounds remaining and pounds used), generator amps, standby alternator amps, battery amps, bus voltage, anti-ice remaining (gallons of fluid and hours remaining), and propeller amps. The engine and airframe unit provides data to the EIS, which displays the data for the ENGINE page (Figure 7-12). Engine operation is monitored by: torque, ITT, N g%, propeller RPM, oil pressure, oil temperature, and fuel flow. Torque Figure 7-12. Engine and System Indications The EIS consists of two pages that are selected using the ENGINE softkey. The ENGINE page displays indications for: • Engine torque • Engine ITT • Gas generator rpm% • Propeller rpm 7-16 Torque (TRQ) indication is displayed at the top of both the ENGINE and SYSTEM pages. The torque is indicated within a round gauge with a white pointer (Figure 7-12). The transmitter senses the difference between the engine torque pressure and the pressure in the engine case and transmits this data to the avionics system. Normal operating range is indicated by a green arc that extends from 0 to redline. The red line indication varies from 1,865 to 1,970 ft-lbs depending on prop rpm. For normal cruise flight when prop rpm is between 1,600-1,900, the arc includes a blue torque bug. The bug indicates maximum allowed cruise FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL torque per the cruise torque tables in Section 5, Limitations, of the Pilot’s Operating Handbook and the Aircraft Flight Manual (AFM/POH). PROP RPM The PROP RPM is indicated numerically below the gas generator RPM (see Figure 7-12). The digits are white with rpm between 0–1,599 rpm, green between 1,600–1,900 rpm, and white with a red background when rpm is greater than 1,901. The instrument is electrically operated from the propeller tachometergenerator on the right, front side of the case. Interstage Turbine Temperature Interstage turbine temperature (ITT) is indicated below the TRQ indication in a round dial gauge with a white pointer (see Figure 7-12). The gauge displays gas temperature between the compressor and power turbines. With the engine off or starting, the ITT indication displays a green band from 212°–1,364°F (100°–740°C), an amber caution band from 1,410°–1,481°F (766°–805°C), and a red line at 2,003°F (1,095°C). The gauge is graduated at 100° increments from 1,410°–1,481°F (600°–1,100°C). When the engine is running, a green arc indicates normal a operating range from 212°–1,364°F (100°–740°C), an amber caution range from 1,409°–1,481°F (765°–805°C), and a red line at 1,481°F (805°C). The gauge is graduated at 50° increments from 1,112°–1,652°F (600°–900°C). The digital readout flashes red when an overtemperature situation occurs. Gas Generator RPM Gas generator RPM (N g) is displayed below ITT on a round dial gauge with a white pointer (see Figure 7-12). The RPM is displayed as a percentage of maximum gas generator rpm. The instrument is electrically operated from the gas generator tachometer-generator on the lower right portion of the accessory case. The gauge has tick marks at 0%, 12%, 50%, and 105%, with a redline at 101.6%. Revision 0 Fuel Flow Refer to the “Fuel System” section of this chapter for details on fuel flow indications. Oil Pressure Oil pressure (OIL PSI) is displayed as a varied color tape and 3-digit display on the ENGINE page (see Figure 7-12). A transducer senses oil pressure from the accessory case and transmits the information to the EIS. Normal operation is indicated from 85–105 psi. Caution is indicated by an amber bar from 40–85 psi. Warning is indicated by red lines and red flashing digits at less than 40 psi and greater than 105 psi. The red OIL PRESS LOW CAS message also appears when low oil pressure is detected. Oil Temperature Oil temperature (OIL°C) is displayed as a varied color tape and 2-digit display on the ENGINE page. The oil temperature indication is operated by an electrical-resistance temperature sensor. Normal operation is indicated between 50°–213°F (10°–99°C). Caution is indicated by an amber region from –40°F to less than 50°F (10°C) and from 212°–219°F (100°–104°C). Red lines are included at 106° and 221°F (41° and 105°C). Digits vary in color between green, amber, or red in correlation with the pointer and tape (see Figure 7-12). OVERSPEED GOVERNOR PUSH TO TEST Switch The OVERSPEED GOVERNOR PUSH TO TEST switch on the left side of the instrument panel is used for testing the propeller overspeed governor during engine runup (Figure 7-13). Pressing the switch actuates a solenoid on the overspeed governor that resets the governor at 1,750 rpm. To check for proper operation of the overspeed governor during engine runup, press the OVERSPEED GOVERNOR PUSH TO TEST switch, and then advance the POWER FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-17 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL website. After analysis, reports are generated from the log data and may be viewed as text or graphs. Configuration files are created, edi t e d , a n d m a n a g e d t h r o u g h t h e Tu r b i n e Tracker ™ website. The processor memory holds more than 30,000 engine runs and/or events. When events are recorded, a time history is stored. The history is configured to record all parameters up to two minutes before the event and after the event. Figure 7-13. OVERSPEED GOVERNOR PUSH TO TEST Switch lever until propeller rpm stabilizes. Propeller rpm is not to exceed 1,750 ± 60 rpm. ENGINE MONITORING SYSTEM The ALTAIR avionics ADAS d system monitors engine operation, including engine parameters, indicated airspeed, pressure altitude, outside air temperature, and particle separator position. The system also monitors battery voltage as well as the position of the emergency power lever and the bleed air cabin heat control valve. The system interface displays alerts for exceedance of engine operating limits and processor faults. The ALTAIR system acquires, retrieves, and delivers engine operating data. Data acquisition is a function of the ADAS d monitor customized through a configuration file uploaded to the processor. Data retrieval is handled by monitor link program (MLP) software in a laptop computer or a personal digital assistant (PDA). The MLP allows uploading of configuration files and downloading and viewing of stored data. Data delivery is through the Turbine Tracker ™ website. The website provides links to databases of information for each engine and is accessible any time from a computer with Internet access. Log data is uploaded to this 7-18 The data is collected automatically by the system and stored for retrieval by maintenance personnel using a laptop computer or PDA. The data can be transferred to the Cessna Designated Analysis Center (DAC) for evaluation. The data i s analyzed and compared to a Pratt & Whitney Canada (P&WC) mathematical engine model. The ADAS d and DAC analysis improve operational safety by identifying conditions that could shorten engine life. Using the engine condition trend monitoring (ECTM), replaces the required fixed hourly interval for hot section inspection with an oncondition inspection. The data can be used by P&WC to grant time between overhaul (TBO) extensions. (P&WC requires ADAS d for engine specific TBO extension.) Additionally, ADAS d can identify the occurrence of engine operating parameter events. The ADAS d data allows maintenance personnel to evaluate and correct the condition before severe engine damage occurs. Components The main components of the ADAS d are a processor and a communication port. Two circuit breakers on the left side of the main power junction box power the system. The system monitors the outputs for engine interstage turbine temperature (ITT), fuel flow transmitter (FFLOW PPH), propeller rpm tach generator (PROP RPM), gas generator rpm, tach generator (N g), engine torque, and oil pressure. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Since bleed-air extraction, INERTIAL SEPARATOR, and EMERGENCY POWER lever positions affect engine performance, the ADAS d monitors these parameters as well. All data is collected and monitored from the avionics system through a digital data bus. When avionics 1 boots, the ETM processor runs its normal boot procedure. A white ETM FAULT message indicates either a processor or system fault or that the log file is between 85–100% full. Download the log and troubleshoot the system as necessary. Processor If ETM CAPTURE and PREV EXCEED display together indefinitely, then the processor did not finish booting. Ensure that the processor has power from both circuit breakers and that the battery is connected (the battery switch does not have to be on). If the ADAS d processor boots after avionics 1 boots, then the ETM EXCEED and ETM FAULT appear momentarily while the processor boots. ADAS d does not boot from avionics 2. The processor is under the right side panel in the cabin. The processor collects and stores data from the sensors and engine systems. It also interfaces with the avionics system to display appropriate messages if an engine parameter exceedance occurs. Two sources of electrical power ensure no loss of data when the BATTERY switch is positioned to OFF. A 1 amp ETM POWER circuit breaker provides power from the main bus when the BATTERY switch is ON. The ETM CONTINUOUS POWER 1 amp circuit breaker provides power directly from the aircraft battery. A communication port in the copilot side panel is used for uploading the configuration file to the processor and downloading data from the processor. A special cable connects the communication port to a laptop computer or a PDA. An ALTAIR Monitor Link Program (MLP) software must be installed on the laptop computer or PDA in order to upload or download. Controls and Indications The ADAS d processor controls five messages that display on each PFD. The five messages are: • ETM EXCEED (amber) • ETM EXCEED (white) • PREV EXCEED (white) • ETM CAPTURE (white) • ETM FAULT (white) The ETM FAULT message is displayed in the advisory window. All other messages are displayed in the CAS message area. Revision 0 If a serious event is recorded in a previous flight, then the white PREV EXCEED CAS message appears. Pressing the TRND/ACK softkey extinguishes the message until the next shutdown. If the message is not acknowledged and the engine is started, then the message changes to a white ETM EXCEED message and remains displayed after the engine starts. The ETM EXCEED (amber or white) and PREV EXCEED messages can be acknowledged at any time by pressing the TRND/ ACK softkey. The CAS message disappears until a new condition occurs. The PREV EXCEED message appears only when maintenance or inspection is required. PREV EXCEED messages continue appearing at each start sequence until the log is downloaded and reset. Two modes of operation determine when the CAS messages appear: engine not running mode and engine running mode. The engine not running mode is operational when the ITT is less than 250°C. During this mode, PREV EXCEED, ETM FAULT, and ETM CAPTURE CAS messages appear as needed. Pressing the ETM (TREND) indication extinguishes the CAS message or initiates a loopback test to check the functionality of the ETM (TREND) light. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-19 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL The engine running mode is operational when the ITT is greater than (842°F or 450°C) and the N g is greater than 50%. During this mode, the amber and white ETM EXCEED CAS messages appear during flight. Pressing the TREND/ACT softkey initiates a manual trend capture or acknowledges an ETM EXCEED CAS message. ETM CAPTURE also may appear if the CAPTURE softkey is pressed. ADASd Operation For ADAS d operation, an account must be established with ALTAIR Avionics in order to use the service. The account is established through Cessna Aircraft Company upon delivery of the aircraft. The account allows access to the ALTAIR avionics website. Once the account is established, the MLP software is downloaded to the computer operator. The MLP software communicates with the processor for downloading information to the laptop or PDA. All necessary documents and instructions are available through this site. The data retrieved from the processor can then be uploaded to a laptop or PDA for viewing and analysis. If the analysis indicates a serious condition, the operator can be contacted. OPERATION Air is introduced through the engine air intake from the nacelle inlet scoop through the inertial separator, and turned 180° to enter the axial compressor (Figure 7-14). Air pressure is increased by a diffusion process and directed to the centrifugal compressor to inc r e a s e a i r ve l o c i t y. T h e ve l o c i t y o f t h e compressor outlet air is converted to pressure by a diffuser and directed to the combustor, where airflow changes 180°. Compressed air enters the combustion chamber, where fuel is added by 14 fuel nozzles. The igniter plugs provide initial combustion during start. The expanding combustion gases flow aft and turn 180° to enter the turbine section. LEGEND AMBIENT INLET AIR COMPRESSOR AIR COMBUSTION AIR COMPRESSOR EXHAUST AIR COMPRESSOR TURBINE POWER TURBINE ACCESSORY GEARBOX Figure 7-14. Engine Air Intake 7-20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL The gas generator (compressor) turbine extracts most of the gas energy , which drives the compressor and the accessory drive gear. The gases continue to expand through the propeller turbine, which extracts almost all remaining energy to drive the propeller through the reduction gear. The spent gases enter the exhaust section, where they are turned 180° and are discharged through the exhaust pipe into the atmosphere. NEW ENGINE BREAK-IN AND OPERATION The Pratt and Whitney of Canada PT6A-114A turboprop engine requires no specific breakin procedures. The engine may be operated safely throughout the normal ranges authorized by the manufacturer upon delivery of the aircraft. ENGINE SHUTDOWN The standby alternator receives field current from the hourmeter/AC circuit breaker. In an emergency condition, the standby alternator can be brought online without positioning the BATTERY switch to ON. For normal engine shutdown procedures position the STBY ALT PWR switch to OFF before shutting down the engine and positioning the BATTERY switch to OFF. If the STBY ALT PWR switch is left in the ON position, a single indication forward of the STBY ALT PWR switch illuminates after the BATTERY switch is positioned to OFF. The indication is a reminder to position the STBY ALT PWR switch to OFF to prevent draining the battery. LIMITATIONS ENGINE IGNITION For most operations, leave the IGNITION switch in the NORM position. When the switch is at NORM, the ignition is on only when the STARTER switch is in the START position. Position the IGNITION switch to ON to prevent engine flameout caused by ambient conditions or brief interruption of fuel flow. The ON position provides continuous ignition under the following conditions: ENGINE Number of engines ................................... One Manufacturer ....................... Pratt & Whitney of Canada, Ltd. Model number ............................. PT6A-114A • Emergency engine starts without starter assist Engine control operating limits—Flight operation with the power lever retarded below the IDLE position is prohibited. • Operation on water-covered or slushcovered runways Engine Starting Cycle Limits • Flight in heavy precipitation • During inadvertent icing encounters until the inertial separator has been in bypass for 5 minutes • When near fuel exhaustion as indicated by illumination of the RSVR FUEL LOW CAS message Revision 1 Using the aircraft battery, the starting cycle is limited to the following intervals and sequence: • • • • 30 seconds on, 60 seconds off 30 seconds on, 60 seconds off 30 seconds on, 30 minutes off Repeat the above cycle as required FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-21 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Using external power, the starting cycle is limited to the following intervals and sequence: • 20 seconds on, 120 seconds off • 20 seconds on, 120 seconds off • 20 seconds on, 60 minutes off ° Repeat the above cycle as required Propeller type: • Constant speed • Full-feathering • Reversible•Hydraulically actuated • Aluminum blades with feathered bladeangle of 88° • Low pitch blade angle of 15.6° POWERPLANT INSTRUMENT MARKINGS Figure 7-12 illustrates the torque, ITT, and gas generator % RPM indications. PLACARDS • Maximum reverse blade angle of –14°(30 inch station) Propeller RPM and Anti-Ice Indications Figure 7-12 illustrates the propeller RPM and anti-ice indications. CAUTION When below power level, use BETA and MAX REVERSE positions only with engine running and propeller out of the FEATHER position. PROPELLER Oil Oil Grade Specification Use only oil that conforms to Pratt & Whitney engine Service Bulletin No. 1001 and all revisions of supplements thereto. Refer to the POH/AFM for a list of approved oils. Total Oil Capacity Total oil capacity for the Caravan 208 is 14 U.S. quarts (including oil in filter, cooler, and hoses). Drain and Refill Quantity Drain and refill quantity is approximately 9.5 U.S. quarts. McCauley™ Propeller manufacturer............. McCauley™ Accessory Division Propeller mode ....... 3GFR34C703/106GA-0 Number of blades .................................. Three Oil Quantity Operating Range Fill to within 1.5 quarts of MAX HOT or MAX COLD (as appropriate) on the dipstick. Quart markings indicate U.S. quarts low if oil is hot. For example, a dipstick reading of 3 indicates the system is within 2 quarts of MAX if the oil is cold and within 3 quarts of MAX if the oil is hot. Propeller diameter: •Maximum ............................... 106 inches •Minimum ................................ 104 inches 7-22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NOTE To obtain an accurate oil level reading, check the oil either within 10 minutes after engine shutdown while the oil is hot (MAX HOT mark) or before the first flight of the day while the oil is cold (MAX COLD mark). If more than 10 minutes have elapsed since engine shutdown and the engine oil is still warm, perform an engine dry motoring run before checking the oil level. Oil Pressure and Temperature Indication Figure 7-12 illustrates the oil pressure and temperature indications. Placards The placard displayed next to the oil dipstick/filler cap on the inertial separator duct reads as follows: NOTE Engine total capacity14 U.S. Quarts. Drain 7 fill 9.5 U.S. quarts. See the POH/AFM for approved oils. Do not mix brands or types of oils. The placard displayed on the side of the inertial separator duct reads as follows: WARNING Pressurized oil tank. Ensure oil dipstick is secure. EMERGENCY/ ABNORMAL HOT STARTS A hot start is caused by excessive fuel flow at normal rpm or normal fuel flow with insufficient rpm. The latter condition usually is the Revision 1 problem, which is caused by attempting a start with a discharged or weak battery. A minimum battery voltage of 24 volts does not always indicate that the battery is fully charged or in good condition. • If gas generator acceleration in the initial part of the start is less than normally observed, return the FUEL CONDITION lever to CUTOFF, and discontinue the start. Recharge the battery or connect an APU before attempting another start. • If no ITT rise is observed within 10 seconds after moving the FUEL CONDITION lever to the LOW IDLE position, or ITT rapidly approaches 1,090°C (1,994°F), move the FUEL CONDITION lever to CUTOFF, and then perform the engine clearing procedure. • With a cold engine or after making a battery start, which causes a high initial generator load because of battery recharging, it may be necessary to advance the power lever slightly ahead of the IDLE detent to maintain a minimum idle of 52% N g. • Since the generator contactor closes when the STARTER switch is positioned to OFF, anticipate the increased engine load by advancing the power lever to obtain approximately 55% N g before positioning the STARTER switch to OFF. Doing so prevents the initial generator load from decreasing idle rpm below the minimum of 52%. • If during the start, the starter accelerates the gas generator rapidly above 20% N g, suspect gear train decouple. Do not continue the start. Rapid acceleration through 35% N g suggests a start on the secondary nozzles. Anticipate a hot start. • After an aborted start, it is essential before the next start attempt to allow adequate time to drain unburned fuel. Failure to drain all residual fuel from the engine could lead to a hot start, a hot streak leading to hot section damage, or torching of burning fuel from the engine exhaust on the next successful ignition. A dry motoring, within starter limitations after confirming that all fuel drainage has stopped, ensures that no fuel is trapped before the next start. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-23 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL • If the amber STARTER ON CAS message does not extinguish after engine start, the generator will not function because the start contactor may be stuck closed. Position the BATTERY switch to OFF, and then shut down the engine if such an indication is observed. 3. If the aircraft cannot be stopped on the remaining runway, perform the following steps: • Engine starts may be made with the aircraft battery power or with an APU. It is recommended that an APU be used when the ambient air temperature is lower than 0°F (-18°C). Under these conditions, observe other cold weather operating procedures in accordance with the POH/AFM. • Position the FUEL TANK SELECTORS to OFF to sound the warning horn. • If the GPU/EPU drops offline during engine start, power to the starter is lost, which can cause a hot start. If auxiliary power is lost, immediately position the FUEL CONDITION lever to CUTOFF, monitor ITT, and ensure that the engine is shutting down. If high ITT persists, position the EXTERNAL POWER switch to OFF , position the STARTER switch to MOTOR, and use battery power for engine rotation to aid in reducing ITT. • When a GPU/EPU is used, ensure that the unit is negatively grounded and regulated to 28 VDC with a capability of providing a minimum of 800 amps during the starting cycle. Do not use the GPU or EPU with output exceeding 1,700 amps. During takeoff, an engine fire or failure requires immediate pilot response. Refer to the POH/AFM for procedures. ENGINE FAILURE DURING TAKEOFF ROLL If the engine fails during takeoff roll, perform the following procedure: 1. Position the POWER lever to BETA range. 2. Apply the brakes, and then retract the wing flap. 7-24 • Position the FUEL CONDITION lever to CUTOFF, and then pull out the FUEL SHUTOFF (OFF position). • Position the BATTERY switch to OFF. ENGINE FAILURE IMMEDIATELY AFTER TAKEOFF If the engine fails immediately after takeoff, perform the following procedure: 1. Adjust the airspeed to 85 KIAS. 2. Position the PROP RPM to FEATHER or MAX RPM at pilot discretion. 3. Position the FUEL CONDITION lever to CUTOFF and pull out the FUEL SHUTOFF (OFF position). 4. Position the FUEL TANK SELECTORS and the BATTERY switch to OFF. ENGINE FAILURE DURING FLIGHT If the engine fails during flight, perform the following procedure: 1. Adjust the airspeed to 95 KIAS. 2. Position the POWER lever to IDLE. 3. P o s i t i o n t h e P RO P R P M l e v e r t o FEATHER. 4. Position the FUEL CONDITION lever to CUTOFF. 5. Position the wing flaps to UP. 6. Position the FUEL BOOST switch to OFF. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 7. Pull out the FUEL SHUTOFF (OFF position). 16. Pull the RADAR/RT circuit breaker (AVN BUS 1, second row, sixth circuit breaker from the left side). 8. Position the IGNITION switch to NORM. 9. Position the STBY ALT PWR to OFF. 17. Land the aircraft as described in the “Emergency Landing Without Engine Power” procedure in the POH/AFM. 10. Position the PROP HEAT switches (if installed) to OFF. WARNING NOTE The AVIONICS No. 1 switch must remain ON in order to maintain battery power to the AVIONICS bus No. 1. 11. Pull the BUS 2 PWR circuit breaker. 12. Position the AVIONICS No. 2 switch to OFF. 13. Reduce the electrical load by positioning the following controls to OFF: • NO SMOKE switch Do not load shed BUS 2 using the circuit breakers if any backup system is in use. After shedding BUS 2 the stall warning horn, portions of the anti-ice protection systems, most external lighting, left fuel quantity, and air conditioning will be inoperative. Review BUS 2 equipment lists for additional information. ENGINE FLAMEOUT DURING FLIGHT If the engine flames out during flight, perform the following procedure: 1. If the gas generator speed (N g) is above 50%, position the POWER lever to IDLE. • SEAT BELT switch • CABIN switch • STROBE lights 2. Position the IGNITION switch to ON. • LDG and TAXI/RECOG lights 3. After satisfactory relight, as indicated by a normal ITT and N g , adjust the POWER lever as desired. NOTE Keep the L–LDG lights OFF until required for approach and landing. Prior to landing, position the L–LDG light to ON only to keep electrical load below limit. 14. Position the vent air fans and the air conditioning controls (if installed) to OFF. 15. Pull the GEN CONT and GEN FIELD circuit breakers (top row, last two circuit breakers on the forward end). Revision 1 4. Position the IGNITION switch to NORM after the cause of the flameout is corrected. AIRSTART STARTER ASSIST If an airstart-starter assist is necessary, perform the following procedure: 1. Reduce the electrical load by positioning the STBY ALT PWR switch to OFF, the AVIONICS bus 2 switch to OFF, and the IGNITION switch to NORM. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-25 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 2. Position the following controls to OFF: • Left LIGHTS panel switches BOOST switch to NORM unless it cycles on and off, in which case leave the switch ON. • VENT AIR FANS • Air conditioning controls • Bleed air heat switch 3. Position the EMERGENCY POWER lever to NORMAL and the POWER lever to IDLE. 4. Position the PROP control lever to the MIN rpm detent and the FUEL CONDITION lever to CUTOFF. 5. Push in the FUEL SHUTOFF knob to the ON position and position the FUEL TANK SELECTORS to ON. 6. P o s i t i o n t h e BAT T E RY a n d F U E L BOOST switches to ON. 7. Verify that the amber FUEL ON CAS message appears, and that the amber F U E L P R E S S L OW C A S m e s s a g e extinguishes. 8. Maintain an altitude below 20,000 feet maximum. 9. P o s i t i o n t h e S TA RT E R s w i t c h t o START, and then verify that the white IGNITION ON CAS message appears and the Oil pressure gauge indicates engine oil pressure. 10. Ensure that N g is 12% minimum, and then position the FUEL CONDITION lever to LOW IDLE. 11. Monitor the ITT for 1,090°C maximum. 12. Position N g to 52% minimum, and then position the STARTER switch to OFF. WARNING In heavy precipitation or nearly empty fuel tank conditions, position the IGNITION switch to ON and the FUEL 7-26 AIRSTART NO STARTER ASSIST If an airtstart-no starter assist is required, perform the following procedure: 1. Tr i p a n d r e l e a s e t h e G E N E R ATO R switch, and then position the STBY ALT PWR switch and the AVIONICS switches to OFF. 2. Position the AIR CONDITIONING and BLEED AIR HEAT switches to OFF. 3. Position the EMERGENCY POWER lever to NORMAL and the POWER lever to IDLE. 4. Position the PROP lever to the MIN rpm detent, and position the FUEL CONDITION lever to CUTOFF. 5. Push in the FUEL SHUTOFF knob to the ON position, and then position the FUEL TANK SELECTORS to LEFT ON and RIGHT ON. 6. Position the BATTERY switch and the FUEL BOOST switch to ON. 7. Verify that the amber FUEL BOOST ON CAS message appears and that the amber FUEL PRESS LOW CAS message disappears. 8. Position the IGNITION switch to ON, and then verify that the white IGNITION ON CAS message appears. 9. Maintain an airspeed of 100 KIAS minimum (140 KIAS if the propeller is feathered) and an altitude of 20,000 feet maximum (15,000 feet if the propeller is feathered). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CAUTION Do not attempt a restart without a starter assist if the N g tachometer indicates zero rpm. 10. Check for a stable N g indication. 11. Place the FUEL CONDITION lever in the LOW IDLE detent, and then monitor the ITT to verify a 1,090°C (1,994°F) maximum reading and monitor the N g to verify a 52% minimum. 12. Position the IGNITION switch to NORM if the N g is 52% or above, unless conditions warrant leaving the switch in the ON position. WARNING In heavy precipitation or nearly empty fuel tank conditions, position the IGNITION switch to ON and the FUEL BOOST switch to NORM unless it cycles on and off, in which case leave the switch ON.Position the FUEL CONDITION lever to HIGH IDLE and the PROP control lever as desired. Set the POWER lever as desired, position the GENERATOR switch to RESET, and then release it. Tu r n o n e l e c t r i c a l a n d av i o n i c s equipment as desired. Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-27 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK 7-28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL QUESTIONS 1. The PT6A-114A engine is defined as a: A. Fixed-shaft, constant-speed engine B. Free-turbine, turboprop engine C. Single-spool, variable-speed engine D. None of the above 2. The torque indication indicates the power: A. Developed by the gas generator B. Delivered by the propeller C. Of the combined gas generator and power turbine D. Delivered to the propeller 3. The power turbine is on a shaft that: A. Drives the gas generator B. Drives the accessory section C. Drives the reduction gear D. Drives the propeller directly 4. Air induced into the engine: A. Enters at the rear and is exhausted at the front B. Enters at the front and is exhausted at the rear C. Passes from the power turbine to the compressor wheels D. Must be cooled by the compressor section 5. During operations using the emergency power lever: A. Extreme caution should be used when reversing thrust. B. The EMERG PWR LVR CAS message appears when the lever is not stowed in the NORMAL position. C. Only partial engine power is available. D. Engine response may be slower than when using the power lever. Revision 0 6. With the propeller control lever positioned to MAX: A. The propeller speed is governed at 1,900 rpm. B. The engine delivers maximum torque. C. The propeller governor is bypassed. D. The gas generator rpm is at maximum. 7. Engine oil level should be: A. Maintained full at all times B. Checked only before the first flight of the day C. Lower for cold weather operations D. Maintained to within 1 to 1.5 quarts of MAX HOT or MAX COLD as appropriate 8. The IGNITION switch should be positioned to ON: A. For airstarts without starter assist B. F o r o p e r a t i o n o n w a t e r- c o v e r e d runways C. During flight in heavy precipitation D. All of the above 9. The inertial separator should be positioned to the bypass position: A. To increase engine rpm B. When flying through visible moisture at low temperatures C. For all takeoffs D. During all operations above 5,000 feet 10. Loss of any pneumatic signal to the fuel control unit causes: A. The engine to shut down B. The engine to drop to idle rpm C. The engine rpm to increase rapidly D. A complete stoppage of fuel flow FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 7-29 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 11. When the STARTER switch is positioned to START: A. The IGNITION switch must be positioned to ON B. The ignition system is energized if the IGNITION switch is positioned to NORM C. The starter-generator functions as a generator D. The ignition system is deenergized 12. During the overspeed governor test, the propeller rpm should not exceed: A. 1,900 ± 60 rpm B. 1,250 ± 60 rpm C. 1,750 ± 60 rpm D. 2,000 ± 60 rpm 7-30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 8 FIRE PROTECTION CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 8-1 GENERAL............................................................................................................................... 8-1 DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................... 8-2 COMPONENTS ...................................................................................................................... 8-2 Heat Sensor ...................................................................................................................... 8-2 Portable Fire Extinguisher ............................................................................................... 8-2 CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS ........................................................................................ 8-2 Engine Fire CAS Message............................................................................................... 8-2 Cabin Heat Firewall Shutoff Valve .................................................................................. 8-2 OPERATION ........................................................................................................................... 8-2 TEST Switch.................................................................................................................... 8-2 Portable Fire Extinguisher ............................................................................................... 8-3 LIMITATIONS ........................................................................................................................ 8-3 EMERGENCY/ABNORMAL PROCEDURES ..................................................................... 8-3 Engine Fire During Start on Ground ............................................................................... 8-3 Cabin Fire During Ground Operations ............................................................................ 8-4 Engine Fire In-Flight ....................................................................................................... 8-4 Electrical Fire In-Flight ................................................................................................... 8-5 Cabin Fire......................................................................................................................... 8-5 Wing Fire ......................................................................................................................... 8-6 QUESTIONS ........................................................................................................................... 8-7 Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 8-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Page 8-1 CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF PULL OFF Knob ..................................... 8-2 8-2 TEST Switch ............................................................................................................ 8-3 8-3 Center Pedestal and Left Sidewall Panel ................................................................. 8-4 8-4 LIGHTS and ANTI-ICE Panels ............................................................................... 8-6 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 8-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 8 FIRE PROTECTION INTRODUCTION The Cessna Caravan 208 G1000 is equipped with an engine fire-detection system as standard equipment. The detection system includes a heat sensor in the engine compartment, a crew alert system (CAS) warning message, and a warning chime. GENERAL The fire-detection system in the engine compartment is a closed loop system that operates on DC power. Signals are sent to the CAS message system and an engine fire warning ap- Revision 1 pears on the primary flight display (PFD). The aircraft has no engine fire-extinguishing system. A handheld fire extinguisher is available on the pilot-side door. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 8-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL DESCRIPTION CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF VALVE The engine fire-detection system includes a heat sensor in the engine compartment, an ENGINE FIRE CAS message, and a warning chime above the pilot. The fire-detection system initiates a fire warning when engine compartment temperatures become excessive. COMPONENTS The CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF PULL OFF knob is a push-pull knob on the lower right side of the center pedestal (Figure 8-1). When pulled, the knob actuates two firewall shutoff valves: one in the bleed air supply line to the cabin heating system and one in the cabin return line. The knob normally is pushed in unless a fire is suspected in the engine compartment. HEAT SENSOR The heat sensor consists of one flexible closed loop. When the engine compartment temperature becomes excessively high, the heat changes the resistance of the closed loop. The change in resistance is sensed by a control box on the aft side of the firewall. Fire warning is initiated when temperatures in the engine compartment exceed: • 425°F (218°C) on the firewall (first section) • 625°F (329°C) around the exhaust (second section) • 450°F (232°C) on the rear engine compartment (third section) Figure 8-1. CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF PULL OFF Knob PORTABLE FIRE EXTINGUISHER The portable fire extinguisher is an ABC type, and normally is in the pilot-side door. TEST SWITCH CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS ENGINE FIRE CAS MESSAGE When the closed loop system senses temperature exceedance, the ENGINE FIRE CAS message appears and a repeating warning chime sounds. 8-2 OPERATION The TEST switch is left of the avionics CB panel (Figure 8-2). When the switch is toggled to the FIRE DETECT–UP position, the ENGINE FIRE CAS message appears and the warning chime sounds, indicating that the fire warning system is operational. The system is protected by the FIRE DET circuit breaker on the left sidewall CB panel. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL EMERGENCY/ ABNORMAL PROCEDURES ENGINE FIRE DURING START ON GROUND If an engine fire occurs while the aircraft is starting on the ground, perform the following procedure using the FUEL CONDITION lever on the center pedestal (Figure 8-3) and the FUEL BOOST, BATTERY, and STARTER switches on the left sidewall switch panel: Figure 8-2. TEST Switch PORTABLE FIRE EXTINGUISHER 1. Position the FUEL CONDITION lever to CUTOFF, the FUEL BOOST switch to O F F, a n d t h e S TA RT E R s w i t c h t o MOTOR. WARNING CAUTION If smoke or fire is present, immediately don oxygen masks and smoke goggles, and set oxygen to 100%. Ensure that passengers have supplemental oxygen. To operate the portable fire extinguisher, remove the extinguisher from its bracket on the pilot-side door, hold it upright, and then aim it at the base of the fire. Using the attached ring, pull the pin from the extinguisher. Squeeze the extinguisher handles together to release the extinguishing agent. Spray the extinguishing agent using a side-to-side motion while aiming at the base of the fire. Anytime the extinguisher is used, even partially, maintenance is required before further dispatch. It is possible to have an engine fire w i t h o u t a n a c c o m p a ny i n g C A S message. CAUTION Do not exceed the starting cycle limitations. Refer to the POH/AFM. If the fire persists as indicated by sustained interstage turbine temperature (ITT), immediately close the FUEL SHUTOFF and continue motoring. 2. Position the STARTER switch to OFF, and then pull out the FUEL SHUTOFF switch to the OFF position. 3. Position the BATTERY switch to OFF. 4. Evacuate the aircraft, and then extinguish the fire. LIMITATIONS For specific information on limitations, refer to the Pilot’s Operating Handbook and the FA A - a p p r ove d A i r p l a n e F l i g h t M a n u a l (POH/AFM). Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 8-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CABIN FIRE DURING GROUND OPERATIONS If a cabin fire occurs during ground operation, perform the following procedure using the POWER, PROP RPM, and FUEL CONDITION levers on the center pedestal and the BATTERY switch on the left sidewall switch panel (Figure 8-3): 1. Pull the POWER lever to IDLE, and then apply the brakes as required. 2. P o s i t i o n t h e P RO P R P M l e v e r t o FEATHER, and then position the FUEL CONDITION lever to CUTOFF. 3. Position the BATTERY switch to OFF, and then evacuate the aircraft and extinguish the fire. 8-4 ENGINE FIRE IN-FLIGHT If an engine fire in-flight is indicated by a red ENGINE FIRE CAS message and a warning chime, perform the following procedure: 1. Position the POWER lever to idle and the PROP RPM lever to FEATHER. 2. Position the FUEL CONDITION lever to CUTOFF. 3. Pull out the FUEL SHUTOFF switch and the CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF PULL OFF knob to the OFF positions. 4. Close all forward side vents, open the overhead vents, and then position all VENT AIR fans (if installed) to ON. 5. Set wing flaps to FULL (30°), and then set airspeed to 80 KIAS. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 6. Accomplish a forced landing as described in the “Emergency Landing Without Engine Power” procedure in the POH/AFM. ELECTRICAL FIRE IN-FLIGHT If an electrical fire in-flight occurs, perform the following procedure using the BATTERY, GENERATOR, STBY ALT PWR, and AVIONICS switches on the left sidewall switch panel (see Figure 8-3), and the BLEED AIR HEAT ON switch on the CABIN HEAT control panel: 1. Position the BATTERY switch to OFF. 2. Push the GENERATOR switch to TRIP, and then release it. 3. Position the STBY ALT PWR switch to OFF. WARNING Without electrical power, all electrical engine instruments, as well as the fuel boost pump CAS messages, wing flaps, and all avionics are inoperative. The vacuum-driven standby attitude indicator remains operational. 4. Close all vents to prevent drafts, and then position the BLEED AIR HEAT ON switch to OFF. Activate the fire extinguisher (if available). WARNING 7. If the fire appears to be extinguished and electrical power is necessary for continuance of the flight, position the BATTERY switch to ON, and then push the GENERATOR switch to RESET and release. 8. Position the STBY ALT PWR switch to ON. 9. Check all circuit breakers for faulty circuits. Do not reset circuit breakers with faults. 10. Position the AVIONICS No. 1 switch to ON, and then position all electrical switches to ON, positioning each switch one at a time with a delay after each until the short circuit is localized. 11. After the fire is completely extinguished, open all vents, and then position the BLEED AIR HEAT ON switch to ON. CABIN FIRE If a cabin fire occurs, perform the following procedure: 1. Position the BATTERY switch to OFF. 2. Push the GENERATOR switch to TRIP, and then release it. 3. Position the STBY ALT PWR switch to OFF. Occupants are to wear oxygen masks (if installed) until the smoke clears. After discharging an extinguisher within a closed cabin, ventilate the cabin. 5. Position the AVIONICS switches to OFF. WARNING With the AVIONICS No. 1 and No. 2 switches positioned to OFF, use standby flight instruments. Revision 1 6. Position all other electrical switches to OFF. WARNING Without electrical power, all electrical engine instruments, as well as the fuel boost pump CAS messages, wing flaps, and all avionics are inoperative. The vacuum-driven standby attitude indicator remains operational. 4. Close all vents to prevent drafts, and then position the BLEED AIR HEAT ON switch to OFF. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 8-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 5. Activate the fire extinguisher (if available), and then land the aircraft as soon as possible. N208FS WARNING LEFT LDG Occupants are to wear oxygen masks (if installed) until the smoke clears. After discharging an extinguisher within a closed cabin, ventilate the cabin. POWER OUTLET ALL WING FIRE OFF If a wing fire occurs, perform the following procedure using the PITOT/STATIC HEAT and STALL HEAT switches on the ANTI-ICE panel (Figure 8-4) and the STROBE, NAV, L–R LDG, and TAXI/RECOG switches on the LIGHTS panel. 1. Position the following switches to OFF: • PITOT/STATIC HEAT STROBE NAV ON NO SMOKE SEAT BELT ON C R E W PROP HEAT AUTO LIGHTS TAXI/ RECOG ON RIGHT LDG BCN CABIN O F F MANUAL PITOT/STATIC HEAT STALL HEAT ON • STALL HEAT WING LIGHT ANTI-ICE PRIMARY HIGH OFF FLUID CONTROL MAX FLOW AIRFRAME N O R M WINDSHIELD BACKUP ON OFF • STROBE • NAV Figure 8-4. LIGHTS and ANTI-ICE Panels • L–R LDG • TAXI/RECOG 2. Pull the RADAR R/T circuit breaker (if installed). The circuit breaker is on the AVN BUS 1, second row, sixth breaker from the left side. 3. Position all ventilation fans to OFF. WARNING Perform a sideslip as required to keep flames away from the fuel tank and cabin. Land the aircraft as soon as possible. For more detailed information and procedures on fire protection, refer to the POH/AFM. 8-6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL QUESTIONS 1. The fire-detection test function assures: A. Firewall is intact B. Fire detection loop has proper integrity C. No fire exists in the engine compartment D. Fire detection system cannot give false warnings 2. The fire-detection system only warns of a fire in the engine compartment. A. True B. False 3. The temperature at which the fire warning initiates is: A. 218°C–329°C B. 100°C–200°C C. 510°F–900°F D. 220°F–330°F 4. The CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF PULL OFF knob: A. Activates an engine fire extinguisher B. Secures the firewall if an engine fire occurs C. Turns off the bleed-air heat if the passengers are too hot D. Deactivates the engine fire extinguisher 5. According to the “Engine Fire in Flight” checklist, a red ENGINE FIRE CAS message and warning chime: A. Requires activation of the FIRE DETECT switch B. Requires declaration of an emergency C. Requires accomplishing the five memory items associated with the “Engine Fire in Flight” checklist D. R e q u i r e s a c t i v a t i o n o f t h e f i r e extinguisher Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 8-7 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 9 PNEUMATICS CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 9-1 GENERAL............................................................................................................................... 9-1 DESCRIPTION ....................................................................................................................... 9-3 CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS ........................................................................................ 9-3 BLEED AIR HEAT ON Switch....................................................................................... 9-3 TEMP HOT Knob............................................................................................................ 9-3 MIXING AIR Knob ......................................................................................................... 9-4 CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF PULL OFF Knob............................................. 9-4 VACUUM LOW Flag ...................................................................................................... 9-4 LIMITATIONS ........................................................................................................................ 9-4 EMERGENCY/ABNORMAL ................................................................................................ 9-4 QUESTIONS ........................................................................................................................... 9-5 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 9-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 9-1 Pneumatic System Schematic .................................................................................. 9-2 9-2 CABIN HEAT Control Panel ................................................................................... 9-3 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 9-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 9 PNEUMATICS INTRODUCTION This chapter describes the pneumatic system on the Cessna Caravan 208 G1000. The pneumatic system routes air for heating the aircraft and operating the standby attitude indicator. GENERAL The pneumatic system uses engine compressor bleed air for the heating system in the aircraft (Figure 9-1). Control knobs and switches Revision 0 are in the cockpit. The engine bleed air provides air for all required system functions. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 9-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL LEGEND COMPRESSOR BLEED VALVE HIGH PRESSURE BLEED AIR LOW PRESSURE BLEED AIR P3 HOT AIR REGULATED BLEED AIR P2.5 WARM AIR SUCTION/VACUUM CABIN AIR BLEED-AIR HEAT SWITCH PRESSURE REGULATING VALVE TO VACUUM SYSTEM FLOW CONTROL VALVE MIXING AIR VALVE MIXER/ MUFFLER FIREWALL SHUTOFF VALVES TEMPERATURE CONTROL KNOB Figure 9-1. Pneumatic System Schematic 9-2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL DESCRIPTION The temperature and volume of airflow to the cabin is regulated by the cabin heating, ventilating, and defrosting system. Hot air from the compressor outlet is routed from the engine through a flow control valve, and then through a mixer/muffler where it mixes with cabin return air or warm air from the compressor bleed valve based on the setting of the mixing air valve. Once the correct air temperature is attained, the air is routed to the cabin air distribution system. Controls are provided to direct the heated air to the forward and/or aft portions of the cabin for heating and to the windshield for defrosting. Ventilating air is obtained from an inlet on each side at the forward fuselage and through two ram-air inlets, one on each wing at the upper end of the wing struts. The wing inlet ventilating air is routed through the wing into a plenum chamber in the center of the cabin ceiling. The plenum distributes the ventilating air to individual overhead outlets near each seat. Two electric blowers in the overhead ventilating system blow the air into the cabin. The vacuum system provides suction for the standby attitude indicator. Vacuum is obtained by passing regulated compressor outlet bleed air through a vacuum ejector. Bleed air flowing through an orifice in the ejector creates the suction necessary to operate the instruments. The vacuum system consists of the standby attitude indicator, a bleed-air pressure regulator, a vacuum ejector on the forward left side of the firewall, a vacuum relief valve and vacuum system air filter on the aft side of the firewall. CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS TEMP HOT KNOB A rotary TEMP HOT selector knob is on the CABIN HEAT control panel (Figure 9-2). The selector modulates the opening and closing of the flow control valve, which controls the volume of air flow into the cabin. Clockwise rotation increases the mass flow and temperature of the air. BLEED AIR HEAT ON SWITCH A two-position BLEED AIR HEAT ON switch is on the CABIN HEAT control panel (Figure 9-2). The switch controls the operation of the bleed-air flow control valve. Figure 9-2. CABIN HEAT Control Panel Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 9-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL MIXING AIR KNOB The MIXING AIR GND–PULL FLT–PUSH control is on the CABIN HEAT panel (Figure 9-2). The control determines if warm compressor bleed valve air is mixed with hot compressor outlet air, or if cabin air is mixed with compressor bleed air and recirculated. EMERGENCY/ ABNORMAL For specific information on emergency/abnormal procedures, refer to the Pilot’s Operation Handbook or the FAA-approved Airplane Flight Manual (POH/AFM). In the GND–PULL position (pulled out), warm compressor bleed valve air is mixed with hot compressor outlet air in the mixer/muffler. Use this mode during ground operation with N g below 92%. In the FLT position, the cabin air is mixed with compressor bleed air and recirculated. CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF PULL OFF KNOB The CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF PULL OFF knob is a push-pull knob on the lower right side of the pedestal. The knob is normally pushed in unless a fire is suspected in the engine compartment. When pulled out, the knob actuates two firewall shutoff valves, one in the bleed-air supply line to the cabin heating system and one in the cabin return line, to the off position. The knob is normally pushed in unless a fire is suspected in the engine compartment. VACUUM LOW FLAG A red flag appears on the standby attitude indicator when a possible low vacuum condition exists in the vacuum system. LIMITATIONS No limitations are indicated for the pneumatic system on this aircraft. 9-4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL QUESTIONS 1. Cabin ventilating air enters the aircraft through: A. The forward engine air intakes B. Air inlets on each side of the forward fuselage C. Air inlets on each wing at the upper ends of the wing struts D. Both B and C 2. If more cabin heating is needed during ground operations: A. Move the fuel condition lever to HIGH IDLE B. Move the MIXING AIR control to FLT C. Open the instrument panel vents D. Pull the defroster knob 3. Windshield defrosting can be accomplished by: A. Pulling out the defrost/forward cabin control and pushing in the aft/forward cabin control B. Opening the vents at the base of the windshield C. Directing the upper instrument panel vents at the windshield D. Both A and B 4. The CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF control should be pulled out: A. To routinely shutoff cabin heat B. If a fire is suspected in the engine compartment C. During ground operations D. During engine starts Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 9-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 10 ICE AND RAIN PROTECTION CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................. 10-1 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................ 10-1 COMPONENTS .................................................................................................................... 10-5 Protection Panels ........................................................................................................... 10-5 Fluid Tank ...................................................................................................................... 10-5 Equipment Pack ............................................................................................................. 10-5 Propeller Slinger Ring ................................................................................................... 10-5 Windshield Spray Bar.................................................................................................... 10-5 Pitot-Static and Stall Heat System................................................................................. 10-5 Engine Inertial Separator System .................................................................................. 10-6 Wing Inspection Light ................................................................................................... 10-6 Windshield Ice Detector Light....................................................................................... 10-6 Low Airspeed Awareness System .................................................................................. 10-6 CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS ...................................................................................... 10-7 PRIMARY HIGH–NORM–OFF Switch....................................................................... 10-7 MAX FLOW AIRFRAME–WINDSHIELD Switch ..................................................... 10-7 BACKUP ON Switch .................................................................................................... 10-8 PITOT/STATIC HEAT Switch ...................................................................................... 10-8 STALL HEAT ON Switch ............................................................................................. 10-8 Inertial Separator Control Handle ................................................................................. 10-8 Anti-Ice Fluid Quantity Indicator .................................................................................. 10-8 Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 10-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Fluid Tank Sight Glass................................................................................................... 10-9 CAS Messages ............................................................................................................... 10-9 OPERATION....................................................................................................................... 10-10 PRIMARY HIGH Switch ............................................................................................ 10-10 MAX FLOW AIRFRAME Switch.............................................................................. 10-11 BACKUP ON Switch .................................................................................................. 10-11 LIMITATIONS .................................................................................................................... 10-12 Ice Protection Fluid ..................................................................................................... 10-12 Solvent Usage .............................................................................................................. 10-12 Ice Accumulation......................................................................................................... 10-12 EMERGENCY/ABNORMAL ............................................................................................ 10-13 QUESTIONS....................................................................................................................... 10-15 10-ii FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 10-1 Ice Protection Airframe Components .................................................................... 10-2 10-2 Anti-Ice Protection System .................................................................................... 10-3 10-3 Wing Inspection Light ........................................................................................... 10-6 10-4 Windshield Ice Detector Light............................................................................... 10-6 10-5 Left Sidewall Switch Panel .................................................................................... 10-7 10-6 Anti-Ice Instrument Panel ...................................................................................... 10-7 10-7 View of Fluid Sight Glass Through Cargo Pod Opening ...................................... 10-9 10-8 A-ICE GAL Fluid Quantity Indication.................................................................. 10-9 10-9 CAS Message Indications.................................................................................... 10-10 Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 10-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 10 ICE AND RAIN PROTECTION INTRODUCTION The ice and rain protection system on the Caravan 208 G1000 provides fluid-based (TKS fluid) anti-ice protection to the wing panels, wing struts, horizontal and vertical stabilizers, and propeller. The fluid-based system replaces the pneumatic deice boots and electrothermal deice components common to earlier aircraft. GENERAL The fluid-based ice and rain protection system exudes a filmy ice protection fluid (TKS fluid) from porous panels on the leading edges of the aircraft (Figure 10-1). The fluid minimizes ice formation on all lifting surfaces, propeller Revision 0 blades, wings, wing struts, and horizontal and vertical stabilizers. When the system is activated in-flight, the ice protection fluid flows backwards over the upper and lower surfaces. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 10-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL LASER DRILLED TITANIUM POROUS PANELS SLINGER RING FOR PROPELLER WINDSHIELD SPRAY BAR FLUID TANK AND EQUIPMENT PACK–PUMPS, FILTERS, TIMERS Figure 10-1. Ice Protection Airframe Components A fluid slinger on the propeller provides ice protection for the propeller and generates further ice protection for the fuselage and cargo pod forward surfaces. Two, positive displacement, constant volume metering pumps supply fluid to the panels and propeller. Single and combined pump operation and timed pumping provide a range of flow rates for different icing conditions. An ondemand gear pump supplies fluid to the windshield spray bar for clear vision through the windshield (Figure 10-2). The aircraft is approved for flight into known icing conditions, as defined by 14 CFR, Part 23, and for use in continuous maximum and maximum intermittent icing envelopes, as defined by 14 CFR, Part 25, Appendix C, Pilot’s Operating Handbook and Airplane Flight Manual (POH/AFM). The aircraft is approved for flight into such conditions only if the fol- 10-2 lowing Cessna and FAA-approved equipment is installed and fully operational: • Ice protection system, including porous panels on the leading edges of the wing, horizontal and vertical stabilizers, wing struts, propeller fluid slinger ring, and windshield spray bar • Alternate static source • Left and right heated pitot-static tubes • Wing inspection light • Engine-driven generator • • • • Engine inertial separator Heater and defroster Standby electrical system Windshield ice detector light • Heated lift detector (stall warning system) • Vortex generators FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY WINDSHIELD SPRAYBAR DEICE FLUID LEGEND WING LIGHT PROPORTIONING UNIT P P P OFF PRIMARY HIGH 5 BACKUP ANTI– ICE 5 PRI ANTI– ICE FLUID CONTROL MAX FLOW AIRFRAME N O R M WINDSHIELD HIGH PRESSURE SWITCH ANTI-ICE CRACKING VALVES (CHECK VALVES) LOW PRESSURE SWITCHES WINDSHIELD PUMP LOW LEVEL SWITCH METERING PUMPS VENT FLUID LEVEL SENDER SOLENOID VALVE VENT Figure 10-2. Anti-Ice Protection System PROPELLER PROPORTIONING UNIT TO WING STRUT PROPORTIONING UNIT ASM FILTERS STALL HEAT ON EQUIPMENT PACK ASSEMBLY (IN THE CARGO POD) PITOT/STATIC HEAT 2 W/S ANTI–ICE 5 TORQUE OFF BACKUP ON CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 10-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NOTE WARNING It is essential in cold weather to remove even the smallest accumulations of frost, ice, snow, or slush from the wing and control surfaces. To assure complete removal of contamination, conduct a visual and tactile inspection up to 2 feet behind the protected surfaces at one location along the wing span as a minimum. Also, make sure the control surfaces contain no internal accumulations of ice or debris. If these requirements are not performed, aircraft performance will be degraded to a point where a safe takeoff and climb out may not be possible. WARNING Prior to flight in known or forecast icing conditions, check that PITOT/STATIC tube(s) and STALL warning heaters are warm to touch after positioning the PITOT/STATIC and STALL HEAT switches to ON for 30 seconds, and then OFF. Ensure that the pitot covers are removed prior to positioning the PITOT/STATIC HEAT switch to ON. The known anti-ice protection system provides adequate in-flight protection during normally encountered icing conditions produced by moisture-laden clouds. The system does not prov i d e c o m p l e t e p r o t e c t i o n u n d e r s ev e r e conditions, such as those that exist in areas of freezing rain. Nor does it provide complete protection for continuous operation in widespread areas of icing conditions. During operation under any conditions, exercise good judgment and be prepared to alter the flight if conditions exceed the capacity of the ice protection equipment or if any component of this equipment fails. 10-4 Upon encountering any icing condition, exit the condition immediately before aircraft performance degrades. Ice accretion can cause degraded performance and can make a climb unachievable. WARNING The in-flight ice protection equipment does not remove ice, snow, or frost accumulation from a parked aircraft. Use other deice methods, such as a heated hangar or approved deicing solutions, to remove all frost, ice, snow, or slush accumulation from the wings, struts, tail, propeller, windshield, fuel vents, main landing gear, and cargo pod. WARNING Ice accretion outside of a cloud is not defined by CFR 25, Appendix C, in the POH/AFM. Flight in such conditions requires immediate exit. Before takeoff, ensure that no internal ice or debris accumulation exists on the control surfaces, engine intakes, pitot-static system ports, and fuel vents. Ice accumulation on the airframe can reduce the rate of climb and the service ceiling. Depending on the ice accretions, climbing in order to exit the icing condition can be impossible. Although unusual ice accretions can result in lower performance than published in the POH/AFM, the published performance is based on flight test data. Observe the applicable notes in the Performance section of the POH/AFM for performance losses associated with the INERTIAL SEPARATOR handle positioned to BYPASS and the BLEED AIR HEAT switch positioned to ON. For more information, refer to the POH/AFM. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL COMPONENTS The aircraft ice protection components include the ice protection system, a pitot-static and stall warning system, and an engine inertial separator system. The ice protection system includes the following components. PROTECTION PANELS The outer skin of the ice protection panels are 0.0353 inches (0.9 mm) titanium, which provides strength, durability, lighter weight, and corrosion resistance. The panel skin is perforated with laser-drilled holes (0.0025 inches or 0.0636 mm) in diameter, 800 per square inch). The porous panels provide even fluid coverage from best rate-ofclimb speed to V MO . The metering pumps propel fluid as needed through nylon tubes from the tank through microfilters to the leading edge surfaces and propeller. The microfilters remove contaminants from the fluid and prevent blockage of the porous panels. Four proportioning units distribute the fluid to each porous panel and the propeller slinger ring. As such, the left wing and strut, the right wing and strut, the vertical and horizontal stabilizers, and the propeller slinger ring each have a dedicated proportioning unit. PROPELLER SLINGER RING A fluid slinger ring and feed nozzle on the propeller delivers ice protection to the propeller. The propeller ice protection fluid runs back toward the fuselage during flight, providing further ice protection to the fuselage, cargo pod forward surfaces, and gear strut. FLUID TANK A 20 gallon (75.8 liter) tank and an equipment pack on the cargo pod are used to apply fluid to the leading edges, propeller, and windshield. A service port for the tank is on the left side of the cargo pod, near the left main landing gear. The equipment pack consists of: • Tw o m e t e r i n g p u m p s — p u m p N o . 1 and pump No. 2 • Fluid system filters • Fluid level sender • Low fluid switch • High pressure switch • Cracking (check) valves • Solenoid A windshield spray bar on the pilot forward line of sight windshield cleans ice obstructions from the windshield. Fluid is provided on demand by a dedicated gear pump. PITOT-STATIC AND STALL HEAT SYSTEM EQUIPMENT PACK • On-demand gear pumps WINDSHIELD SPRAY BAR A pitot-static heat system assures proper airspeed indications and prevents ice formation if ice conditions conducive to icing (visible moisture at +41°F or +5°C). The system consists of heating elements in the left and right pitot-static tubes. A heating element in the stall warning vane and sensor on the leading edge of the left wing provides additional ice protection. The stall warning sensor are monitored for failure; if failure occurs an amber STALL HEAT crew alerting system (CAS) message appears. • Wire harness • Timers (see Figure 10-2) Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 10-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ENGINE INERTIAL SEPARATOR SYSTEM The inertial separator system in the engine air inlet duct prevents ice buildup on the compressor inlet screen. WING INSPECTION LIGHT A wing inspection light is flush-mounted in the left wing leading edge-to-fuselage fairing. The light allows visual detection of ice accumulation on the wing and is required for flight into known icing conditions (Figure 10-3). Figure 10-4. Windshield Ice Detector Light LOW AIRSPEED AWARENESS SYSTEM In TKS equipped aircraft, the low airspeed awareness (LAA) system is designed to warn the pilot when airspeed falls below 97.5 ± 2 knots while operating in icing conditions. Figure 10-3. Wing Inspection Light The light is controlled with the two-position WING LIGHT switch on the ANTI-ICE switch panel. The switch is spring-loaded to the off position and must be held in the on position to illuminate the wing inspection light. The light is protected by the WING ICE DET LIGHT circuit breaker on the CB panel. When the PITOT/STATIC HEAT switch is turned ON prior to takeoff, the BELOW ICING MIN SPD switchlight illuminates white indicating that the airspeed is below the threshold of 97.5 ± 2 knots. Once the airspeed exceeds the threshold, the switchlight extinguishes. If the airspeed falls back below the threshold, the switchlight alternates between amber and white and the stall warning horn sounds intermittently until the airspeed is increased above the threshold. WINDSHIELD ICE DETECTOR LIGHT Pressing the flashing switchlight silences the stall warning horn and causes the switchlight to stop flashing. The switchlight remains illuminated solid white as long as the airspeed is below 97.5 ± 2 knots. A red windshield ice detector light is on the lower inboard portion of the pilot windshield (Figure 10-4). If the windshield is clear of ice, a distinct red circle is present above the light. If the windshield is contaminated, the red circle becomes more diffused and the area of red light increases. Aircraft equipped with a Garmin GFC-700 autopilot, the autopilot automatically disengages when the flashing amber and white switchlight is activated. In non-equipped aircraft, The autopilot must be turned off manually at the first sign of LLA activation until airspeed is under control. 10-6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS PRIMARY HIGH–NORM–OFF SWITCH The ice and rain protection system is powered by 28 VDC from Bus 1 and Bus 2 of the electrical system (Figure 10-5). Three switches on the ANTI-ICE control panel are used to control the system (Figure 10-6). The HIGH position arms the low pressure, high pressure, and low level sensors for active operation, and runs pump No. 1 continuously. The NORM position also arms the low pressure, high pressure, and low level sensors for active operation, but cycles both pumps on for 20 seconds, and then off for 100 seconds. The NORM position represents the lowest fluid flow rate of the system. The OFF position terminates the selected operation. MAX FLOW AIRFRAME– WINDSHIELD SWITCH T h e M A X F L OW A I R F R A M E – W I N D SHIELD switch is used in heavy or severe icing conditions. When the switch is positioned to MAX FLOW AIRFRAME (up), the spring-loaded switch activates the MAX FLOW AIRFRAME operation, and then returns immediately to the center position. Figure 10-5. Left Sidewall Switch Panel The NORM or HIGH position must be selected on the PRIMARY HIGH switch in order to select MAX FLOW AIRFRAME operation. Figure 10-6. Anti-Ice Instrument Panel Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 10-7 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL The MAX FLOW AIRFRAME position runs both metering pumps for 2 minutes, and then returns the pumps to NORM or HIGH as selected on the PRIMARY HIGH switch. The MAX FLOW AIRFRAME operation cycles until the operation times out after 2 minutes or until the PRIMARY HIGH switch is positioned to OFF. The spring-loaded WINDSHIELD position is for intermittent clearing of the pilot forward windshield as needed. The WINDSHIELD position activates an independent gear pump, which supplies fluid to the pilot windshield. The pump runs for 4 seconds upon release of the switch. BACKUP ON SWITCH The BACKUP ON switch provides redundancy if the other operations are inoperable. The BACKUP ON switch activates an independent electrical system (circuit breakers, wire bundle, and switch), which runs metering pump No. 2 continuously. When the switch is positioned to ON, the low pressure sensor is armed. The windshield pump operates independently of the PRIMARY HIGH and BACKUP ON switch positions. PITOT/STATIC HEAT SWITCH The two-position PITOT/STATIC HEAT switch, when positioned to ON provides electrical heat to the pitot-static tubes for proper operation or the aircraft during icing conditions. The LEFT PITOT HEAT and RIGHT PITOT HEAT circuit breakers on the CB panel protect the pitot-static heat system. STALL HEAT ON SWITCH The STALL HEAT ON switch controls the heating element in the stall warning vane and sensor. The switch is protected by the STALL WARN circuit breaker on the CB panel. 10-8 INERTIAL SEPARATOR CONTROL HANDLE The INERTIAL SEPARATOR control handle on the lower instrument panel has two positions: • B Y PA S S – P U L L — U s e w h e n f l y i n g through visible moisture such as clouds, rain, snow, and ice-crystals with an outside air temperature (OAT) of 41°F (5°C) or lower. Use also for ground operations or takeoff from dusty or sandy field conditions to minimize ingestion of foreign particles into the compressor. • NORMAL–PUSH—Use for all other operations. Refer to the POH/AFM for performance changes associated with the INERTIAL SEPARATOR handle operations. ANTI-ICE FLUID QUANTITY INDICATOR The fluid level sensor in the fluid tank monitors fluid quantity (Figure 10-7). The fluid level sender transmits an electrical signal to the avionics system, based on the fluid level. The system converts the signal to a digital readout on the multifunction display (MFD) (Figure 10-8). The MFD can operate either in engine display or system display. Engine display operation displays only the gallons of fluid remaining. The system display operation displays gallons and time remaining until fluid is depleted, and is valid only when NORM or HIGH are selected. When the BACKUP ON switch is position to ON, the time remaining is invalid. Time remaining is based on fluid quantity and the selected operation (when anti-ice is off, time remaining is based on normal operation). A green readout indicates at least 20 minutes of fluid remains in the NORM position or at least 8 minutes of fluid remains in the HIGH position. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL FILLER ASSEMBLY An amber background on the readout indicates 20 minutes or less fluid remaining in NORM position. A red readout indicates 4 minutes or less of fluid remaining in the NORM position, and 1 minute or less in the HIGH position. The minimum fluid level for dispatch is 11.7 gallons and is indicated on the fluid tank sight glass. FLUID TANK SIGHT GLASS A fluid tank sight glass is near the filler assembly inside the cargo pod access door, forward of the left wing strut (Figure 10-7). The witness mark on the sight glass is used to determine the proper fluid quantity for dispatch into known icing conditions. The sight glass is viewed through the cargo pod door. FLUID LEVEL BALL MINIMUM DISPATCH QUANTITY LINE (11.7 GALLONS) Figure 10-7. View of Fluid Sight Glass Through Cargo Pod Opening To ensure minimum dispatch quantity, perform the following steps: 1. Ensure that the aircraft wings are in a level attitude. If the aircraft rests on a slope, the nose must be aligned up or down with the slope. 2. Ensure that the bottom of the fluid ball inside the sight gauge is above the minimum dispatch line. CAUTION Minimum dispatch quantity in the fluid tank is 11.7 gallons. Use the sight gauge to verify that the fluid tank contains at least this quantity prior to takeoff or flight into icing conditions. CAS MESSAGES The ice protection system CAS messages appear in the primary flight display (PFD) (Figure 10-9). FLUID QUANTITY READOUT Figure 10-8. A-ICE GAL Fluid Quantity Indication Revision 1 A-ICE PRESS LOW (red)—Indicates low fluid pressure to the tail (lack of fluid to the tail, empty tank, or ruptured line). Activated by two low pressure switches downstream of the FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 10-9 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL A-ICE LOW FLUID A-ICE NORM ETM PREV EXCEED ETM CAPTURE CAS MESSAGES Figure 10-9. CAS Message Indications tail proportioning units. If a low pressure condition exists, the CAS message cycles on and off every 2 minutes. A-ICE PRESS HI (amber)—Indicates system fluid pressure exceeds 150 psi, and system filtering is restricted. Activated by a high pressure switch between the metering pumps and filters. OPERATION The fluid control system has the following operations: • PRIMARY HIGH switch ° HIGH ° NORM ° OFF A-ICE FLUID LO (amber)—Indicates fluid level remaining is 20 minutes, or approximately 2 gallons remaining in the NORM position. Activated by a fluid low level switch in the tank. • MAX FLOW AIRFRAME switch A-ICE NORM or A-ICE HIGH (white)— Indicates that the PRIMARY HIGH switch is positioned to NORM or HIGH and the system is in normal or high operation respectively. • BACKUP ON switch NOTE Except for the disappearance of the white A-ICE NORM CAS message, the system provides no other indication if the anti-ice protection system fails. 10-10 ° AIRFRAME ° WINDSHIELD ° ON ° OFF PRIMARY HIGH SWITCH HIGH Position The HIGH position (up) arms the low pressure, high pressure, and low level sensors for FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL a c t iv e o p e r a t i o n , a n d r u n s p u m p N o . 1 continuously. To use the high operation, position the PRIMARY HIGH switch to HIGH (up). To terminate pump operation, position the PRIMARY HIGH switch to OFF. • BACKUP ON switch ° ON—1 hour, 20 minutes If low pressure is indicated, position the PRIMARY HIGH switch to OFF, and then position the BACKUP switch to ON. WINDSHIELD Position NORM Position The NORM position arms the low pressure, high pressure, and low level sensors for active operation, and cycles both pumps on for 20 seconds, and then off for 100 seconds. To use normal operation, position the PRIMARY HIGH switch to NORM (center). To terminate pump operation, position the PRIMARY HIGH switch to OFF. MAX FLOW AIRFRAME SWITCH Use the WINDSHIELD position for intermittent operation of the windshield spray bar to clear the pilot forward vision windshield as needed. To use the windshield spray bar, position and hold the MAX FLOW AIRFRAME switch to the WINDSHIELD position. Holding the spring-loaded switch at the WINDSHIELD position releases windshield fluid continuously. Releasing the switch returns it to OFF (center) and terminates windshield pump operation 4 seconds later. The timer interval applies an optimum burst of fluid to the windshield at the selected interval. AIRFRAME Position CAUTION The max flow airframe operation is used in heavy or severe icing conditions. To activate the max flow airframe operation, position the PRIMARY HIGH switch to NORM or HIGH, and then position the MAX FLOW AIRFRAME switch to AIRFRAME (up). The spring-loaded switch activates the operation, and then returns immediately to the center position. To terminate the operation, position the PRIMARY HIGH switch to OFF. Fluid Consumption The MAX FLOW AIRFRAME switch operations have the following maximum endurance levels with a full tank of fluid: • PRIMARY HIGH switch ° NORM—3 hours, 25 minutes ° HIGH—1 hour, 20 minutes • MAX FLOW AIRFRAME—40 minutes ° AIRFRAME—40 minutes Revision 1 Do not run the windshield pump continuously for more than 10 seconds, and allow at least 10 seconds between operations. The windshield takes approximately 30 seconds to clear after the MAX FLOW AIRFRAME switch is released. BACKUP ON SWITCH BACKUP Position Use the BACKUP ON switch if the PRIMARY HIGH or MAX FLOW AIRFRAME switches are not functioning. The BACKUP ON switch activates an independent electrical system (circuit breaker, wire bundle, and switch), which runs metering pump No. 2 continuously in the HIGH position. To use the backup operation, position the BACKUP ON switch to ON (up). Note that the windshield pump operates independently of the PRIMARY HIGH and BACKUP ON switches. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 10-11 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL LIMITATIONS Post-Operation Precautions ICE PROTECTION FLUID After system operation, ice protection fluid continues to weep from the panels as the pressure bleeds down and the panel reservoirs empty. Fluid Requirements The ice protection fluids used in the aircraft must meet DTD-406B specifications. Approved ice protection fluids are 80 to 85%, TKS fluid, 5% isopropyl alcohol, and 10 to 20% deionized water. Fluid density is approximately 9.2 lbs/gal. For health and environmental information, refer to the applicable material safety data sheets (MSDS). DTD-406B fluids can be purchased under the following brand names: • AVL-TKS (Aviation Laboratories) • TKS-Fluid (DW Davies) • AeroShell ® Compound 07 (AeroShell ®) The fluid is not limited to these suppliers as long as the fluid meets specification DTD-406B. Fluids conforming to this specification can be mixed in the aircraft tank in any proportion. WARNING Use caution around areas with ice protection fluid on the floor. The fluid, especially on a painted floor, creates a very slick surface. To prevent slipping accidents, remove the fluid from the floor immediately. SOLVENT USAGE Certain solvents can damage the plastic membrane in the porous panels, particularly methyl ethyl ketone (MEK), acetone, lacquer thinner, and other types of solvents. Mask the panels when painting the aircraft or when using these solvents on components near the panels. Wash the panels with soap or mild detergent and water, using a brush or lint-free cloth. Only the following solvents are permitted for use on the panels: • Water (with soaps or detergents) Do not use automobile anti-freeze fluid in the ice protection system. Anti-freeze fluid can contain additives that can damage the porous panels or other system components. Do not, under any circumstance, add any form of thickened deice fluid intended for runway or parked aircraft to the ice protection system. Minimum Dispatch Quantity The fluid tank has a capacity of 20 gallons. The minimum fluid quantity required for dispatch is 11.7 gallons. Fluid quantity must be verified using the fluid tank sight gauge. 10-12 CAUTION • Aviation gasoline • Isopropyl alcohol • Industrial methylated spirit • Approved ice protection fluids • Aviation turbine fuel • Ethyl alcohol ICE ACCUMULATION Ice accumulation on the airframe can result in a 20 KIAS increase in stall speed. Treat buffet or an aural stall warning as an imminent stall. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL WARNING The aural stall warning may not function properly in all icing conditions. Do not rely only upon the aural stall warning to provide adequate warning in icing conditions. For additional information on limitations of the anti-ice protection system, refer to the Pilot’s Operating Handbook and Aircraft Flight Manual (POH/AFM). EMERGENCY/ ABNORMAL For specific emergency/abnormal procedures, refer to the POH/AFM. Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 10-13 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK 10-14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL QUESTIONS 1. The in-flight ice protection equipment provides: A. Unlimited ability to operate in icing conditions B. Ice protection through use of bleed air C. Adequate ice protection during normal icing conditions D. The ability to de-ice the aircraft on the ramp 2. The anti-ice fluid tank has a capacity of: A. 15 gallons B. 20 gallons C. 11.7 gallons D. 9.3 gallons 3. The standby electrical power system is required to be installed and functional for: A. IMC conditions B. Night operations C. Commercial operations D. Icing conditions 4. The minimum de-ice fluid level for dispatch into forecast icing conditions is: A. 20 gallons B. 15 gallons C. 11.7 gallons D. 9.3 gallons 5. When operating with the anti-ice fluid control switch in NORMAL, a green readout on the MFD indicates that at least: A. 20 minutes of fluid remain B. 15 minutes of fluid remain C. 10 minutes of fluid remain D. 5 minutes of fluid remain Revision 1 6. When the anti-ice fluid control switch operates in HIGH, a red readout on the MFD indicates: A. 10 minutes or less of fluid remain B. 5 minutes or less of fluid remain C. 2.5 minutes or less of fluid remain D. 1 minute or less of fluid remains 7. The maximum endurance level with a fully serviced anti-ice fluid tank in NORMAL is: A. 5 hours B. 3 hours C. 2 hours D. 1.5 hours 8. The maximum endurance level with a fully serviced anti-ice fluid tank in MAX FLOW AIRFRAME is: A. 1 hour B. 40 minutes C. 30 minutes D. 15 minutes 9. The ice detector light is used: A. Momentarily to detect ice accumulations at night B. At all times during flight in icing conditions C. Only when visible moisture is present D. Also as a courtesy light on the ground FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 10-15 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 11 AIR CONDITIONING CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................. 11-1 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................ 11-1 AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM ......................................................................................... 11-2 Description..................................................................................................................... 11-2 Components ................................................................................................................... 11-2 Controls and Indications................................................................................................ 11-2 Operation ....................................................................................................................... 11-3 Limitations ..................................................................................................................... 11-4 CABIN HEATING, VENTILATING, AND DEFROSTING SYSTEM............................... 11-4 Description..................................................................................................................... 11-4 Components ................................................................................................................... 11-4 Controls and Indications................................................................................................ 11-4 Limitations ..................................................................................................................... 11-8 Emergency/Abnormal .................................................................................................... 11-8 QUESTIONS ......................................................................................................................... 11-9 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 11-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 11-1 COOL–OFF–VENTILATE and AC FANS Switches ............................................ 11-2 11-2 Cabin Heating, Ventilating, and Defrosting System .............................................. 11-5 11-3 CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF PULL OFF Knob................................... 11-7 11-4 VENT AIR Control Knobs .................................................................................... 11-8 11-5 VENT PULL ON Knobs........................................................................................ 11-8 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 11-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 11 AIR CONDITIONING INTRODUCTION The Cessna Caravan 208 G1000 has an air conditioning system, heating system, and ventilation system that provide comfortable cabin temperatures during hot and cold weather operation on the ground and in-flight. A windshield defrost system is provided. Controls for the system are in the cockpit. GENERAL The aircraft has a vapor cycle air conditioning system. Evaporator units direct cooled air to a series of overhead outlets in the cabin headliner. Controls for the air conditioning system vary the temperature and flow of the cooled air. The system is protected by circuit breakers on the left sidewall CB panel. Revision 0 The cabin airflow temperature and volume is regulated by the heating, ventilating, and defrosting system. The heating system routes hot compressor bleed air from the engine and mixes the air with cabin return air to achieve the correct air temperature before routing the air to the cabin air distribution system. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 11-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Ventilating air is obtained from an inlet on each side at the forward fuselage and through a ramair inlet on each wing. A plenum chamber in the center of the cabin ceiling distributes ventilating air to individual overhead outlets. Evaporator Defrosting air is obtained from heated air directed to the forward cabin through outlets behind the instrument panel and/or the two windshield defroster outlets. Condenser The evaporator works like a heat exchanger, and takes heat from the closed system and adds it to the air. Gas leaving the compressor flows to the condenser. The condenser also acts like a heat exchanger, but it draws heat from the air and adds it to the closed system. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS DESCRIPTION Controls for the air conditioning system are on the AIR CONDITIONING control panel on the bottom of the instrument panel directly above the control pedestal (Figure 11-1). Cooled air is supplied to the cabin through 16 overhead adjustable outlets (one above the pilot and front passenger, 11 directly above the rear-seat passengers, and three on the aft bulkhead). The pilot and passenger overhead outlets swivel, and have a rotating nozzle that controls airflow volume. The air conditioning system includes: • Belt-operated compressor in the engine accessory compartment COOL–OFF–VENTILATE Switch Positioning the COOL–OFF–VENTILATE switch to COOL starts the compressor and evaporator fans (Figure 11-1). Positioning the switch to VENTILATE activates only the evaporator fans, which provide hot ventilating air to the cabin. The OFF position turns off the compressor and evaporator fans. • Two evaporator units with integral blowers in the left and right wing root areas and one in the tail cone behind the aft bulkhead • System condenser in the engine compartment • Refrigerant lines under the floorboards that interconnect the compressor, evaporator, and the condenser Figure 11-1. COOL–OFF–VENTILATE and AC FANS Switches COMPONENTS Compressor AC FANS Switches The refrigeration cycle begins with the compressor. It compresses the refrigerant gas which is comparatively cold and at a low pressure as it leaves the evaporator. The gas leaving the compressor is at a high temperature and high pressure. The AC FANS switches include three, twoposition switches that provide separate HIGH and LOW speed control to the LEFT, AFT, and RIGHT evaporator fans (Figure 11-1). 11-2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL System electrical protection is provided by four 15-amp circuit breakers on the left sidewall CB panel: • LEFT VENT BLWR If the temperature of the air coming from the outlets does not start to cool within a minute or two the system can be malfunctioning and must be turned off. • RIGHT VENT BLWR • AFT VENT BLWR In-Flight Operation • AIR COND CONT Initially, it can be desirable to operate the system with the AC FANS switch on HIGH for fast cool down. Later in the flight, operating the fans on LOW and opening the overhead vent air controls can provide a more comfortable environment. OPERATION Ground Operation After preflight inspection and engine start, close the cabin doors and windows. Push in all instrument panel vent controls and close all overhead vent air outlets. Open all overhead air outlets and advance the FUEL CONDITION lever as required for minimum N g of 54%. Position all AC FANS switches to HIGH and the COOL–OFF–VENTILATE switch to COOL. CAUTION Under extremely hot outside air temperature (OAT) and/or high ground elevation conditions, the idle interstage turbine temperature (ITT) can exceed the maximum idle ITT limitation of (685°C) (1,265°F). Advance the FUEL CONDITION lever toward HIGH IDLE to increase the idle N g as required to maintain a satisfactory ITT (1,265°F or lower/685°C or lower). NOTE For increased cooling during ground static conditions, increase N g to 60–65% for a higher air conditioning compressor rpm. Ground operation of the air conditioner with the propeller in beta range for prolonged periods causes the air conditioning compressor pressure safety switch to disengage the compressor clutch. Prevent this situation. Revision 0 During extended flight when temperature and humidity are extremely high, the evaporator coils can accumulate frost. If frost forms, as evidenced by reduced airflow, position the COOL–OFF–VENTILATE switch to VENTILATE and position the AC FANS switches to HIGH. Doing so increases the evaporator discharge temperature sufficiently to clear the frost. NOTE A high-pressure safety switch in the air conditioning system disengages the compressor clutch and stops system operation if the system becomes overloaded. The system cycles on again when the pressure drops. If the system does not restore within a reasonable period, it can be malfunctioning and must be turned off. Use the blower portion of the air conditioner system at any time outside air cabin air circulation are desired. Position the COOL–OFF–VENTILATE switch to VENTILATE and then position the AC FANS switches to LOW or HIGH as desired. The switch settings can be retained before and after landing. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 11-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL LIMITATIONS Air distribution for the passenger versions of the CE-208 and CE-208B is shown in Figure 11-2. When the takeoff torque setting per the Engine Torque For Takeoff chart in the Pilot’s Operating Handbook and FAA Approved Aircraft Flight Manual (POH/AM), Section 5, is less than 1,865 ft-lbs, then the air conditioner must be turned off for any takeoff or landing under those conditions. In the heating system, hot compressor outlet P 3 air is routed from the engine through a flow control valve and then through a mixer/muffler. There it is mixed with cabin return air or warm air from the compressor bleed valve to obtain the correct air temperature before the air is routed to the cabin air-distribution system. WARNING Operation of the air conditioner can cause compass deviation of more than 10°. The aircraft has a 10-fpm reduction in climb performance, 1 to 2 knots true airspeed decrease in cruise performance, and approximately 1% increase in fuel required for a given trip as a result of air conditioner installation. When climbing at altitude above the critical altitude for 675 shaft horsepower (SHP) (ITT at maximum climb, ITT limit and torque below 1,865 ft-lbs), there is a 25 fpm loss in maximum rate of climb. When cruising at altitude where the maximum allowable cruise power is below the torque limit, as noted in the cruise performance tables in Section 5 of the POH/AFM, reduce this setting by 40 ft-lbs when the air conditioner is operating. This results in an approximate 2 KTAS decrease in maximum cruise performance and a slight increase (1%) in fuel required for a given trip. CABIN HEATING, VENTILATING, AND DEFROSTING SYSTEM DESCRIPTION The temperature and volume of airflow to the cabin are regulated by the cabin heating, ventilating, and defrosting system (Figure 11-2). 11-4 Ventilating air is obtained from an inlet on each side at the forward fuselage and through two ram air inlets, one on each wing at the upper end of the wing struts. The wing inlet ventilating air is routed through the wing into a plenum chamber in the center of the cabin top. The plenum distributes ventilating air to individual overhead outlets at the two seat positions and to passenger outlets in the passenger version. COMPONENTS Ventilating Outlets Two adjustable ventilating outlets, one above each seat, permit individual ventilation to the pilot and the front passenger. Eight adjustable overhead ventilation outlets provide ventilation to passengers. The swivel outlets can be adjusted for optimum ventilation. Airflow volume is controlled by rotating the outlet nozzle, which controls an internal valve. CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS The cabin heating, ventilating, and defrosting system controls are on the CABIN HEAT control panel. BLEED AIR HEAT Switch A two-position BLEED AIR HEAT switch controls the bleed air control valve (Figure 11-2). The ON position opens the flow control valve, allowing hot bleed air to flow to the cabin heating system. The OFF position closes the valve, shutting off hot bleed air to the heating system. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL FLOW CONTROL VALVE COMPRESSOR OUTLET BLEED AIR COMPRESSOR BLEED VALVE AIR MIXING AIR VALVE TO FLOW CONTROL VALVE TO MIXING AIR VALVE TO CABIN TO DEFROST AIR/FORWARD HEAT SELECTOR CABIN AIR SELECTOR VALVE VALVE MIXER/MUFFLER FIREWALL SHUTOFF VALVES (2) VENTILATING AIR DOOR (ONE SIDE EACH) CABIN HEAT SELECTOR VALVE INSTRUMENT PANEL VENTILATING OUTLETS AND CONTROLS (2) DEFROST OUTLETS (2) DEFROST AIR/FORWARD CABIN AIR SELECTOR VALVE ADJUSTABLE PILOT AND FRONT PASSENGER OVERHEAD VENTILATING OUTLETS (2) VENTILATING AIR INLET (IN UPPER WING STRUT FAIRING) VENTILATING AIR INLET (IN UPPER WING STRUT FAIRING) VENT AIR CONTROL (ON OVERHEAD CONSOLE) VENT AIR CONTROL (ON OVERHEAD CONSOLE) SHUT VALVE (ONE EACH WING) HEATER OUTLETS (ON EACH CABIN SIDEWALL AT FLOOR LEVEL) ADJUSTABLE REAR PASSENGER OVERHEAD VENTILATING OUTLETS (11) MIXING AIR VALVE OPERATING MODES: BELOW 92%, USED ON THE GROUND AT COLD TEMPERATURES LEGEND ENGINE BLEED AIR RAM AIR FLOW VENTILATION AIR BELOW 92%, USED ON THE GROUND IN MILD TEMPERATURES HEATING AND DEFROSTING AIR BLEED-AIR DISCHARGE BELOW 92%, USED DURING IN-FLIGHT OPERATIONS. IN THIS MODE BLEED AIR THROUGH THE FLOW CONTROL VALVE ONLY IS UTILIZED. CABIN RETURN AIR ELECTRICAL CONNECTION MECHANICAL CONNECTION Figure 11-2. Cabin Heating, Ventilating, and Defrosting System Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 11-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL TEMP HOT Selector Knob A rotary TEMP HOT knob modulates the opening and closing of the flow control valve, which controls the volume and temperature of cabin airflow. Clockwise rotation of the knob increases the airflow volume and temperature. air is used to augment the hot compressor outlet bleed air supply (P3) in cold ambient temperatures. MIXING AIR–FLT–PUSH Switch The MIXING AIR-FLT-PUSH push-pull control mixes cabin return air with hot compressor outlet air. NOTE If more cabin heat is needed while on the ground, position the FUEL CONDITION lever to HIGH IDLE. Some delay (hysteresis) can occur when adjusting bleed air temperature. The resulting volume of bleed air can be different when approaching a particular temperature selector knob position from a clockwise direction versus a counterclockwise direction. For best results rotate the temperature selector knob fully clockwise and then slowly rotate it counterclockwise to decrease bleed air flow to the desired volume. A temperature sensor in the outlet duct from the mixer/muffler operates in conjunction with the TEMP HOT knob. A high temperature (overheat) conditions in the outlet duct energizes the temperature sensor, which closes the flow control valve and shuts off the source of hot bleed air from the engine. MIXING AIR–GND-PULL Switch The MIXING AIR–GND-PULL push-pull control is used to mix compressor bleed air with hot compressor outlet air. When the control is positioned to GND (pulled out), warm compressor bleed valve air (P 2.5 ) mixes with hot compressor outlet air (P 3 ) in the mixer/muffler. Use the GND position during ground operation when warm compressor bleed valve air (P2.5) is available below 89% Ng (PT6A-114) or 92% Ng (for PT6A-114A engines) and when the bleed 11-6 When the control is positioned to FLT (pushed in), cabin return air mixes with the hot compressor outlet air (P 3 ) in the mixer/muffler. Recirculation of cabin return air enables the heating system to maintain the desired temperature for proper cabin heating. Use the FLT position on the ground when ambient temperatures are mild and maximum heating is not required. When the switch is positioned to FLT, the excess warm compressor bleed valve air (P 2.5 ) , available at power settings below 92% N g for PT6A-114A engines, exhausts overboard from the mixing air valve. NOTE The MIXING AIR control must always be positioned to FLT (pushed in) when the aircraft is in flight. Cabin return air must be allowed to flow through the mixing valve and blend with hot compressor outlet air during high engine power operation in order to maintain proper temperature in the cabin heat distribution system. If the FLT position is not used during flight, the system can overheat and cause an automatic shutdown. AFT CABIN–PULL Position The AFT CABIN-PULL position directs heated air to the aft cabin.When the control is positioned to AFT CABIN (pulled out), heated air is directed to the aft cabin heater outlets on the cabin sidewalls at floor level. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL FWD CABIN–PUSH Position The FWD CABIN-PUSH position directs heated air to the forward cabin. When the control is positioned to FWD CABIN (pushed in), heated air is directed to the forward cabin through four heater outlets behind the instrument panel and/or the two windshield defroster outlets. Position the control to any intermediate setting for the desired distribution of heated air to the forward and aft cabins. DEFROST–PULL Switch The DEFROST-PULL push-pull control directs forward cabin air to the windshield defroster. When the control is positioned to DEFROST (pulled out), forward cabin air is directed to two defroster outlets at the base of the windshield. Note that the AFT CABINPULL/FWD CABIN-PUSH control must be pushed in for forward cabin air defrosting. FWD CABIN–PUSH Switch The FWD CABIN-PUSH push-pull switch directs heated air to the heater outlets behind the instrument panel. When the control is positioned to FWD CABIN (pushed in), heated air is directed to the four heater outlets behind the instrument panel. Figure 11-3. CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF PULL OFF Knob CAUTION Do not position the CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF PULL OFF knob to OFF when the MIXING AIR control is positioned to GND. Doing so causes a compressor stall at low power settings when the compressor bleed valve is open. The engine must be shut down to relieve back pressure on the valves prior to opening the valves. CABIN HEAT FIREWALL SHUTOFF Knob VENT AIR Control Knobs A C A B I N H E AT F I R E WA L L S H U TO F F PULL OFF knob is on the lower right side of the center pedestal (Figure 11-3). Two rotary VENT AIR control knobs are on the overhead console (Figure 11-4). The knobs control operation of the shutoff valves in each wing, which control the airflow to the cabin. When pulled out, the knob actuates two firewall shutoff valves to the off position: one in the bleed-air supply line to the cabin heating system and one in the cabin return air line. The knob is to be pushed in, unless a fire is suspected in the engine compartment. Revision 0 The right knob controls the right wing shutoff valve and the left knob controls the left wing shutoff valve. When the VENT AIR control knobs are positioned to CLOSE, the wing shutoff valves are closed. Rotating the knobs to the FAN/OPEN position progressively opens the wing shutoff FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 11-7 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Figure 11-5. VENT PULL ON Knobs EMERGENCY/ABNORMAL PROCEDURES For specific emergency/abnormal procedures, refer to the POH/AFM. Figure 11-4. VENT AIR Control Knobs valves. If the aircraft has cabin ventilation fans but no air conditioning, then rotating the knobs to the full FAN/OPEN position also activates the ventilation fans. VENT–PULL ON Knobs Two VENT–PULL ON control knobs are on each side of the instrument panel. Each knob is used to control ventilation from an outlet next to each knob. Pulling each knob opens a small air door on the fuselage exterior, which admits ram air for distribution through the ventilating outlet (Figure 11-5). LIMITATIONS For specific limitations procedures, refer to the POH/AFM. 11-8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL QUESTIONS 1. The minimum N g when operating the air conditioning on the ground is: A. 70% B. 65% C. 56% D. 54% 2. What must be accomplished when operating the air conditioning on the ground if ITT threatens to exceed 1,265°F or 685°C: A. Advance the condition lever B. Open outside air vents C. Position AC FANS to HIGH D. P o s i t i o n t h e B L E E D A I R H E AT switch to ON 3. Operation of the air conditioner can cause compass deviation of more than: A. 10° B. 15° C. 18° D. 20° 4. The air conditioning system is: A. Powered by the propeller reduction system B. Electrically operated C. Belt operated by the engine accessory section D. Extracts energy from exhaust gases as its power source Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 11-9 The information normally contained in this chapter is not applicable to this particular aircraft. The information normally contained in this chapter can be found in Chapter 14—“Landing Gear and Brakes.” CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 14 LANDING GEAR AND BRAKES CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................. 14-1 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................ 14-1 LANDING GEAR SYSTEM ................................................................................................ 14-2 Description..................................................................................................................... 14-2 Components ................................................................................................................... 14-2 Operation ....................................................................................................................... 14-2 Limitations ..................................................................................................................... 14-2 Emergency/Abnormal .................................................................................................... 14-3 BRAKE SYSTEM................................................................................................................. 14-3 Description..................................................................................................................... 14-3 Components ................................................................................................................... 14-3 Operation ....................................................................................................................... 14-4 Limitations ..................................................................................................................... 14-4 Emergency/Abnormal .................................................................................................... 14-4 QUESTIONS ......................................................................................................................... 14-5 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 14-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 14-1 Landing Gear System............................................................................................. 14-2 14-2 Nose Gear Frangible Stop...................................................................................... 14-3 14-3 Brake Side .............................................................................................................. 14-3 14-4 Brake Fluid Reservoir ............................................................................................ 14-4 14-5 Parking Brake......................................................................................................... 14-4 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 14-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 14 LANDING GEAR AND BRAKES INTRODUCTION This chapter describes the landing gear and brake system on the Cessna Caravan 208 G1000. Information is provided on the main and nose gear, shock absorption, and brakes. GENERAL The tricycle type landing gear on the Cessna Caravan 208 G1000 consists of a steerable nosewheel and two main wheels. Shock absorption is provided by tubular, spring-steel main landing gear struts, and a nose gear oil-filled shock strut. Revision 0 The aircraft has a single disc brake on the main landing gear wheels. The nosewheel has no brake. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 14-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL LANDING GEAR SYSTEM OPERATION DESCRIPTION The landing gear is a fixed-gear tricycle type gear with a steerable nosewheel and two main wheels (Figure 14-1). COMPONENTS Shock Absorption Effective ground control while taxiing is accomplished through nosewheel steering using the rudder pedals to steer the nosewheel in the respective direction. When the rudder pedal is pressed, a spring-loaded steering bungee, which is connected to the nose gear and rudder bars, turns the nosewheel through an arc of approximately 15° each side of center. By applying differential braking the degree of turn can be increased up to 51.5° each side of center. LIMITATIONS Main gear shock absorption is provided by a tubular, main gear spring with a center main gear tube connecting the two outer main gear legs at the gear attach trunnions. The nose gear has an oil snubber shock strut and a tubular spring-type drag link. The nose gear must not be turned more than 51.5° either side of center during towing. The towing limits are indicated by red stripes on each side of the nose gear faring. Exceeding this limit can damage the gear. The nose gear has a frangible stop, which breaks off if the limits are exceeded during RIGHT MAIN GEAR SPRING RIGHT MAIN WHEEL RIGHT MAIN ATTACH TRUNNION CENTER MAIN GEAR SPRING AXLE FITTING SHIMMY DAMPENER RIGHT BRAKE LEFT MAIN ATTACH TRUNNION SHOCK STRUT TRUNNION AFT SUPPORT LEFT MAIN GEAR SPRING FORWARD SUPPORT DRAG LINK SPRING LEFT MAIN WHEEL NOSEWHEEL Figure 14-1. Landing Gear System 14-2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL towing (Figure 14-2). The stop is attached by a small cable, which retains the stop as an indication of possible nose gear damage. Landing with a Flat Nose Tire Move passengers and baggage aft if practical. Remain within approved center-of-gravity envelope. Approach the airport using full flaps. Upon touchdown, keep the nose wheel off the pavement for as long as possible during the landing roll. Use the minimum amount of braking necessary. BRAKE SYSTEM DESCRIPTION The aircraft has a single-disc, hydraulically actuated brake on each main landing gear wheel. Each brake is connected by a hydraulic line, to a master cylinder attached to each of the pilot rudder pedals (Figure 14-3). Figure 14-2. Nose Gear Frangible Stop For additional information on limitations for this aircraft, refer to the Pilot’s Operating Handbook and FAA-approved Airplane Flight Manual (POH/AFM). EMERGENCY/ABNORMAL Landing with a Flat Main Tire Fly the aircraft as desired to lighten the fuel load. Position the FUEL SELECT switch to the OFF position on the opposite side of the flat tire. This lightens the load on the side of the flat tire. CAUTION Maximum fuel imbalance is 200 pounds. Approach the airport with flaps at the FULL (normal) position. Touchdown on the inflated tire first. Hold the aircraft off the flat tire as long as possible with aileron control. Maintain directional control using the brake on the wheel with the inflated tire as required. Revision 0 Figure 14-3. Brake Side COMPONENTS A brake fluid reservoir just forward of the firewall on the left side of the engine compartment provides additional brake fluid for the brake master cylinders (Figure 14-4). Check the fluid in the reservoir for proper level prior to each flight. Refill the reservoir with MILH-5606 hydraulic fluid. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 14-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Figure 14-4. Brake Fluid Reservoir Figure 14-5. Parking Brake OPERATION EMERGENCY/ABNORMAL The brakes are operated by applying pressure to the top of either the left (pilot) or right (front passenger) set of rudder pedals, which are interconnected. Check the aircraft for the following signs of impending brake failure, which include: When the aircraft is parked, both main wheel brakes can be set using the parking brake, which is operated by a handle on the lower left side of the instrument panel (Figure 14-5). To apply the parking brake, set the brakes with the rudder pedals and pull the handle aft. To release the parking brake, push the handle fully in. For maximum brake life, keep the brake system properly maintained. For aircraft with metallic brakes, which is most of the 208 and 208B aircraft, hard brake application is beneficial in that the resulting higher brake temperatures help to maintain proper brake glazing and expected brake life. Conversely, the habitual use of light and conservative brake application is detrimental to metallic brakes. • Gradual decrease in braking action after brake application • Noise or dragging brakes • Soft or spongy pedals • Excessive travel and weak braking action If potential brake failure is indicated, then the brake system requires immediate attention. If, during taxi or landing, braking action decreases, let up on the pedals and then reapply the brakes with heavy pressure. If the brakes become spongy or pedal travel increases, pumping the pedals can build braking pressure. If one brake becomes weak or fails, use the other brake sparingly while using the opposite rudder, as required to offset the good brake. LIMITATIONS For information on limitations for this aircraft, refer to the POH/AFM. 14-4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL QUESTIONS 1. If the nose gear is turned past the maximum placarded travel limit: A. The frangible stop will be sheared off. B. The entire nose gear must be replaced. C. No damage has been done. D. The aircraft must not be moved. 2. The rudder pedals can be used to steer the nose gear approximately: A. 50° either side of center B. 26° either side of center C. 15° either side of center D. 10° either side of center 3. The parking brake is applied by: A. Pumping the parking brake handle until the brakes are set B. Setting the brakes with the rudder pedals and pulling the parking brake handle aft C. Pressing the toe brakes and pulling the parking brake handle aft D. None of the above Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 14-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 15 FLIGHT CONTROLS CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................. 15-1 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................ 15-1 PRIMARY FLIGHT CONTROLS........................................................................................ 15-2 Description..................................................................................................................... 15-2 Components ................................................................................................................... 15-2 Controls and Indications................................................................................................ 15-2 SECONDARY FLIGHT CONTROLS.................................................................................. 15-2 Wing Spoiler .................................................................................................................. 15-2 Trim Systems ................................................................................................................. 15-2 Operation ....................................................................................................................... 15-3 Emergency/Abnormal .................................................................................................... 15-4 Control Locks ................................................................................................................ 15-4 Stall Warning System..................................................................................................... 15-5 Wing Flap System.......................................................................................................... 15-5 Standby Flap System ..................................................................................................... 15-6 QUESTIONS ......................................................................................................................... 15-9 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 15-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 15-1 Wing Spoiler .......................................................................................................... 15-2 15-2 Aileron Servo Tab .................................................................................................. 15-3 15-3 Aileron Trim Tab.................................................................................................... 15-3 15-4 AILERON TRIM Knob ......................................................................................... 15-3 15-5 ELEVATOR TRIM Wheel ..................................................................................... 15-3 15-6 Control Wheel Lock............................................................................................... 15-4 15-7 Rudder Lock........................................................................................................... 15-4 15-8 Stall Warning Vane................................................................................................. 15-5 15-9 Wing Flap............................................................................................................... 15-5 15-10 Wing Flaps Selector Lever and Position Indicator ................................................ 15-6 15-11 Overhead Panel ...................................................................................................... 15-7 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 15-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 15 FLIGHT CONTROLS INTRODUCTION This chapter describes the flight controls on the Cessna Caravan 208 G1000. The aircraft is equipped with fixed and movable surfaces that provide stability and control during flight. The primary flight controls are ailerons, rudder, and elevators. Secondary flight controls include spoilers, trim devices, and flaps. Information on the stall warning system and control locks is also provided. GENERAL The flight control system on the aircraft includes conventional aileron, elevator, and rudder control surfaces, and a pair of spoilers above the outboard ends of the flaps. The Revision 0 control surfaces are manually operated through mechanical linkages using a control wheel for the ailerons, spoilers, and elevator, and rudder/brake pedals for the rudder. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 15-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL PRIMARY FLIGHT CONTROLS SECONDARY FLIGHT CONTROLS DESCRIPTION The secondary flight controls include the wing spoilers, the trim systems, and control locks. The primary flight controls include the ailerons, rudder, and elevator. These flight controls are controlled using the control yoke and column and the rudder pedals. WING SPOILER COMPONENTS The wing spoilers improve lateral control of the aircraft at low speeds by disrupting lift over the appropriate flap (Figure 15-1). Ailerons Ailerons on the outboard trailing edge of both wings provide lateral (roll) control about the longitudinal axis. Rudder The rudder, hinged to the trailing edge of the vertical stabilizer, provides directional control about the vertical axis (yaw). Figure 15-1. Wing Spoiler Elevator The elevators on the trailing edge of the horizontal stabilizer provide longitudinal control about the lateral axis (pitch). CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS Control Yoke and Column The pilot and copilot (front passenger) have conventional control yokes and columns. Control inputs are transmitted to the ailerons and elevators through cables and bellcranks. Rudder Pedals Rudder pedals are provided for the pilot and copilot (front passenger). Control inputs transmit to the rudder through cables. Depressing the top of the nonadjustable rudder pedals activates the brakes. 15-2 The spoilers are interconnected with the aileron system through a pushrod, to an arm of the aileron bellcrank. While the movement of the spoilers begins simultaneously with the upward travel of the aileron, movement of the spoilers for the first 5° of aileron travel is negligible. Once the aileron is deflected upward past 5°, the spoiler deflection rate is proportional to the aileron until they reach the full-up position. When the aileron is deflected downward, the spoiler is completely retracted. Aileron servo tabs provide reduced maneuvering control wheel forces (Figure 15-2). TRIM SYSTEMS Manually operated aileron, elevator, and rudder trim systems are provided. Aileron trimming is achieved by a trimmable servo tab FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Elevator trimming is accomplished through two cable operated trim tabs using the ELEVATOR TRIM wheel on the top left side of the control pedestal (Figure 15-5). Figure 15-2. Aileron Servo Tab Figure 15-4. AILERON TRIM Knob Figure 15-3. Aileron Trim Tab attached to the right aileron (Figure 15-3). The trim tab is connected mechanically to the AILERON TRIM knob on the control pedestal (Figure 15-4). OPERATION Rotating the AILERON TRIM knob to the right (clockwise) trims the right wing down; rotating the knob to the left (counterclockwise) trims the left wing down. Figure 15-5. ELEVATOR TRIM Wheel Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 15-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Rudder trimming is accomplished through the RUDDER TRIM wheel on the control pedestal, which is attached to the forward rudder torque tube and nose gear steering pushrod by rotating the RUDDER TRIM wheel either left or right to the desired trim position. Rotating the RUDDER TRIM wheel to the right trims nose right; conversely, rotating it to the left trims nose left. EMERGENCY/ABNORMAL The ability to trim the rudder depends upon the nose gear extending fully and locking into the center position. If the nose gear is not locked in the center position, moving the RUDDER TRIM wheel only moves the nosewheel left or right and does not affect the rudder. If several attempts to trim the rudder have no apparent effect on control forces, center the rudder trim control for the remainder of the flight and notify maintenance upon landing. CONTROL LOCKS A control lock is provided to lock the aileron and elevator control surfaces. Locking the control surfaces prevents wind buffeting damage to these systems while the aircraft is parked. Figure 15-6. Control Wheel Lock The aircraft is equipped with a rudder gust lock operated by an external handle on the left side of the tail cone (Figure 15-7) The rudder gust lock has a fail-safe connection to the elevator control system to ensure it is disengaged before the aircraft becomes airborne. The connection automatically disengages the lock when the elevator is deflected upward from neutral. CAUTION Remove or unlock the control lock and other types of locking devices prior to starting or towing the aircraft. The lock includes a shaped steel rod and flag. The flag identifies it as a control lock and cautions about its removal before starting the engine (Figure 15-6). Operation To install the control lock, align the hole in the right side of the pilot control wheel shaft with the hole in the right side of the shaft collar on the instrument panel, and insert the rod into the aligned holes Installing the lock secures the ailerons in a neutral position and the elevators in a slightly trailing-edge down position. Proper installation of the lock places the flag over the left sidewall switch panel. 15-4 Figure 15-7. Rudder Lock FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL STALL WARNING SYSTEM The vane-type stall warning unit is in the leading edge of the left wing (Figure 15-8). It is electrically connected to a stall warning horn in the pilot overhead panel. WARNING The circuit breaker must be pushed in for landing. The following applies to later SNs and earlier aircraft modified with the applicable service kit. To preclude or disable nuisance stall warnings during ground operations, push the control yoke forward to the stop. This engages the ground stall warning disable switch. WING FLAP SYSTEM The wing flaps are large-span, single-slot, and are driven by an electric motor (Figure 159). The system is protected by the FLAP MOTOR circuit breaker on the CB panel. Figure 15-8. Stall Warning Vane The vane and sensor unit in the wing leading edge is equipped with a heating element. The heated part of the system is operated by the STALL HEAT switch on the ANTI-ICE switch panel and is protected by the STALL WARN circuit breaker on the CB panel. Controls and Indications The vane in the wing senses the change in airflow over the wing and operates the warning horn at airspeeds of between 5 and 10 knots above the stall in all configurations. Figure 15-9. Wing Flap Operation Operation Check the stall warning system during the preflight inspection by momentarily turning the BATTERY switch ON and actuating the vane in the wing. The system is operational if the warning horn sounds as the vane is pushed upward. The wing flaps are extended or retracted by positioning the wing flaps selector lever on the control pedestal to the desired flap deflection position (Figure 15-10). The selector lever is moved up or down in a slotted panel that provides mechanical stops at the 10° and 20° positions. A white-tipped pointer on the left side of the lever indicates flap position. Emergency/Abnormal The stall warning system is protected by a STALL WARN circuit breaker, which can be pulled to shut off the warning horn in the event the vane sticks in the ON position. Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 15-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL the POH /AFM for increase in approach speed and landing distances). SELECTOR LEVER If both flaps cannot be retracted to a symmetrical setting, land as soon as practical while maintaining a minimum airspeed of 90 KIAS on the approach. Avoid a nose-high flare on landing. Flaps Fail to Extend or Retract If flaps fail to extend or retract, check that the FLAP MOTOR and STBY FLAP MOTOR circuit breakers are pushed in. If flaps still fail to extend or retract: • Move the guarded and safety-tied STBY FLAP MOTOR switch (overhead) by breaking the safety wire and position the switch to STBY. POSITION INDICATOR Figure 15-10. Wing Flaps Selector Lever and Position Indicator STANDBY FLAP SYSTEM Limitations Approved for: • Takeoff range.......................... 0° to 20° • Landing range ........................ 0° to 30° Refer to the Pilot’s Operating Handbook and the FAA Approved Airplane Flight Manual (POH/AFM) for detailed information about takeoff and landing performance. Emergency/Abnormal Asymmetric Flap Extension or Retraction If the aircraft experiences asymmetric (uneven) flap extension or an uncommanded flap retraction, apply the ailerons and rudder to stop the roll. Place the wing flaps selector to the UP position, and reduce airspeed to 100 KIAS or less. If both flaps retract to a symmetrical setting, plan a flaps up landing (refer to 15-6 • Move the guard on the STBY FLAP MOTOR switch; this breaks the safety wire. Position the switch to the UP or DOWN position. Hold the switch until the flaps reach the desired position. Release the switch before the flaps reach their full up or full down travel. A standby system can operate the flaps if the primary system malfunctions. The standby system includes (Figure 15-11): • Standby motor • Guarded and safety-tied (with breakable copper wire) STBY FLAP MOTOR switches ° NORMAL–STBY positions ° UP–DOWN positions Controls and Indications The guarded STBY FLAP MOTOR switch has NORM and STBY positions. The guarded NORM position permits operation of the flap using the selector on the control pedestal. The STBY position disables the primary flap motor. The other STBY FLAP MOTOR switch has UP, OFF, and DOWN positions. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Figure 15-11. Overhead Panel Operation To operate the flaps with the standby system, lift the guard and place the STBY FLAP MOTOR switch in the STBY position. Lift the guard and actuate the STBY FLAP MOTOR UP–DOWN switch momentarily to UP or DOWN as needed. Observe the flap position indicator while operating the standby system. Since the standby flap system does not have limit switches or dynamic breaking, actuation of the STBY FLAP MOTOR–UP –DOWN switch must be stopped before the flaps reach full up or down travel to prevent damage to the flap motor mounts. NOTE Do not use the standby flap system with the autopilot engaged. Doing so runs the trim in the opposite direction. Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 15-7 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK 15-8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL QUESTIONS 1. The wing spoilers on the Caravan 208 G1000: A. Are used as speed reduction devices B. Improve lateral control of the aircraft at low speeds C. Increase the effectiveness of the flaps. D. Balance control forces in the aileron system 2. The rudder lock: A. Must be pulled out during engine start B. Must be pushed in to lock the rudder C. Must be released before towing the aircraft D. Is on the center pedestal 3. The rudder trim system: A. Operates a trim tab on the rudder B. Is operated electrically C. Moves only the rudder D. Is controlled by a knob on the instrument panel 4. The standby flap system is operated: A. Until the flaps reach their stops B. U n t i l t h e f l a p p o s i t i o n i n d i c a t o r reaches the desired setting C. By using the crank on the overhead panel D. Hydraulically Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 15-9 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 16 AVIONICS CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................. 16-1 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................ 16-1 OPERATION......................................................................................................................... 16-4 PFD/MFD Controls ....................................................................................................... 16-4 Automatic Flight Control System Controls................................................................... 16-5 Audio Panel Controls..................................................................................................... 16-8 Power Up ....................................................................................................................... 16-8 PFD Display ................................................................................................................ 16-10 MFD Display ............................................................................................................... 16-22 AUTOMATIC FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM.................................................................. 16-37 Flight Director ............................................................................................................. 16-40 Autopilot and Yaw Damper Operation ........................................................................ 16-42 HAZARD AVOIDANCE .................................................................................................... 16-45 XM Satellite Weather® ................................................................................................ 16-46 Maximum Permissible Exposure Level....................................................................... 16-47 Terrain Awareness and Warning System ..................................................................... 16-47 Traffic Advisory System.............................................................................................. 16-48 LIMITATIONS .................................................................................................................... 16-51 EMERGENCY/ABNORMAL ............................................................................................ 16-51 Stuck Microphone ....................................................................................................... 16-51 COM Tuning Failure ................................................................................................... 16-51 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL PFD Failure ................................................................................................................. 16-51 Audio Panel Failure..................................................................................................... 16-52 Reversionary Mode...................................................................................................... 16-52 Failure Mode Effects for G1000® LRU Failures ........................................................ 16-52 QUESTIONS....................................................................................................................... 16-57 16-ii FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 16-1 Integrated Avionics System.................................................................................... 16-2 16-2 Garmin G1000® Integrated Avionics Architecture................................................ 16-3 16-3 PFD/MFD Controls................................................................................................ 16-4 16-4 Mode Controller (GMC 710)................................................................................. 16-6 16-5 Audio Panel Controls (GMA 1347)....................................................................... 16-8 16-6 PFD Initialization................................................................................................. 16-10 16-7 MFD Power Up Page........................................................................................... 16-10 16-8 Primary Flight Display (Default)......................................................................... 16-11 16-9 Additional PFD Information................................................................................ 16-12 16-10 Airspeed Indicator and Pointer at VMO ............................................................... 16-13 16-11 Attitude Indicator................................................................................................. 16-14 16-12 Slip/Skid Indicator ............................................................................................... 16-14 16-13 Altimeter .............................................................................................................. 16-14 16-14 Vertical Speed and Deviation Indicators (VSI and VDI) .................................... 16-15 16-15 Glide Slope Indicator........................................................................................... 16-15 16-16 Glidepath Indicator .............................................................................................. 16-16 16-17 Horizontal Situation Indicator (HSI) ................................................................... 16-16 16-18 Course Deviation Indicator.................................................................................. 16-16 16-19 Navigation Sources .............................................................................................. 16-17 16-20 Omni-Bearing Selector (OBS) Mode .................................................................. 16-18 16-21 Suspending Automatic Waypoint Sequencing..................................................... 16-18 16-22 Turn Rate Indicator and Trend Vector ................................................................. 16-18 16-23 HSI with Bearing and DME Information ............................................................ 16-19 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 16-24 Wind Data ............................................................................................................ 16-20 16-25 Marker Beacon Annunciations ............................................................................ 16-20 16-26 G1000® Alerting System ..................................................................................... 16-20 16-27 Traffic and TAWS Indications (Example) ........................................................... 16-21 16-28 Terrain Colors ...................................................................................................... 16-21 16-29 Current Radar Height........................................................................................... 16-22 16-30 ALT Setting (Timer/Refences/Window).............................................................. 16-22 16-31 RA as Altitude Source for MDA/DH .................................................................. 16-22 16-32 Altimeter Displaying the Ground Line (RAD ALT) ........................................... 16-22 16-33 Radar Altimeter Invalid Data ............................................................................... 16-22 16-34 MFD Normal Operations..................................................................................... 16-23 16-35 MFD Reversionary Mode .................................................................................... 16-23 16-36 Engine Indications ............................................................................................... 16-24 16-37 ITT Gauge Status Annunciations......................................................................... 16-25 16-38 Anti-Ice System Indications ................................................................................ 16-25 16-39 System Display .................................................................................................... 16-26 16-40 Anti-Ice System Indications (Optional)............................................................... 16-26 16-41 Page Menu Examples .......................................................................................... 16-27 16-42 Map Pages............................................................................................................ 16-28 16-43 Waypoint Pages.................................................................................................... 16-29 16-44 Auxiliary Pages.................................................................................................... 16-30 16-45 Nearest Page ........................................................................................................ 16-31 16-46 Flight Plan Pages ................................................................................................. 16-32 16-47 Procedure Pages ................................................................................................... 16-33 16-48 Selecting a COM Radio for Transmit.................................................................. 16-34 16-49 Switching COM Tuning Boxes............................................................................ 16-35 16-iv FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 16-50 Tuning 121.500 MHz........................................................................................... 16-35 16-51 NAV Frequency Tuning ....................................................................................... 16-35 16-52 Selecting a NAV Radio for Navigation ............................................................... 16-36 16-53 Selecting a NAV Radio Receiver......................................................................... 16-36 16-54 Intercom Controls ................................................................................................ 16-36 16-55 Volume/Squelch Control...................................................................................... 16-38 16-56 Clearance Recorder Play Function ...................................................................... 16-37 16-57 GFC 700 Mode Control Unit.............................................................................. 16-38 16-58 Additional AFCS Controls................................................................................... 16-39 16-59 PFD AFCS Display.............................................................................................. 16-41 16-60 Flight Director Selection Indications................................................................... 16-42 16-61 Autopilot and Yaw Damper Engaged .................................................................. 16-44 16-62 CWS Annunciation .............................................................................................. 16-45 16-63 Manual Autopilot Disengagement ....................................................................... 16-45 16-64 Yaw Damper Disengagement .............................................................................. 16-45 16-65 Automatic Autopilot and Yaw Damper Disengagement...................................... 16-45 16-66 Weather Data Link Page ...................................................................................... 16-46 16-67 MPEL Boundary .................................................................................................. 16-47 16-68 Terrain Altitude/Color Correlation for TAWS ..................................................... 16-48 16-69 Traffic Map Page ................................................................................................. 16-50 16-70 Stuck Microphone Alert....................................................................................... 16-51 16-71 COM Tuning Failure............................................................................................ 16-51 16-72 Frequency Section of PFD2 Display After PFD1 Failure ................................... 16-51 16-73 PDF1 Display After PFD2 Failure....................................................................... 16-52 16-74 Display Backup Button........................................................................................ 16-52 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-v CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL TABLES Table Title Page 16-1 PFD/MFD Controls................................................................................................ 16-5 16-2 Mode Controls........................................................................................................ 16-7 16-3 Audio Panel Controls ............................................................................................. 16-9 16-4 Automatic GPS CDI Scaling ............................................................................... 16-17 16-5 Radar Altimeter Sensitivity.................................................................................. 16-22 16-6 Indications and Description ................................................................................. 16-25 16-7 System Gauge Indications and Description......................................................... 16-27 16-8 Approach Types ................................................................................................... 16-34 16-9 ICS Isolation Modes ............................................................................................ 16-37 16-10 Flight Director Activation .................................................................................... 16-40 16-11 AFCS Status Alerts .............................................................................................. 16-42 16-12 Flight Director Vertical Modes ............................................................................ 16-43 16-13 Flight Director Lateral Modes ............................................................................. 16-44 16-14 Precipitation Intensity Levels .............................................................................. 16-47 16-15 TAWS Obstacle Colors and Symbology.............................................................. 16-48 16-16 TAWS Alerts Summary........................................................................................ 16-49 16-17 TAS Symbol Descriptions ................................................................................... 16-50 16-18 Failure Mode Effects for G1000® LRU Failures ................................................ 16-53 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-vii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 16 AVIONICS INTRODUCTION This chapter is an overview of the integrated avionics systems on the Cessna Caravan 208 G1000 ® . GENERAL The integrated avionics system presents flight instrumentation, position, navigation, communication, hazard, and identification information to the pilot through large format displays (Figure 16-1). The system includes a weather radar, terrain avoidance and warning system (TAWS) information, flight information, and traffic advisory system (TAS). Revision 0 The system uses G1000 ® line replaceable units (LRUs) for the major subsystems and supporting equipment. The system is regulated and coordinated by central processing computers in the two Garmin ® integrated avionics units (GIAs), which contain essential navigation and communications avionics equipment (Figure 16-2). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-1 Figure 16-1. Integrated Avionics System CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 16-2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 Revision 0 HIGH-SPEED DATA BUS (ETHERNET) GDL 69A XM SATELLITE RADIO RECEIVER REAL-TIME WEATHER DIGITAL AUDIO ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM INTEGRATION PROCESSORS I/O PROCESSORS VHF COM VHF NAV/LOC GPS GLIDE SLOPE AFCS MODE LOGIC FLIGHT DIRECTOR CALCULATIONS SERVO MANAGEMENT GPS OUTPUT GDC 74A #2 AIR DATA COMPUTER OAT AIRSPEED ALTITUDE VERTICAL SPEED GRS 77 #1 AHRS ATTITUDE RATE OF TURN SLIP/SLID GRS 77 #2 AHRS ATTITUDE RATE OF TURN SLIP/SLID NO. 2 GIA 63W INTEGRATED AVIONICS UNIT SYSTEM INTEGRATION PROCESSORS I/O PROCESSORS VHF COM VHF NAV/LOC GPS GLIDE SLOPE AFCS MODE LOGIC FLIGHT DIRECTOR CALCULATIONS SERVO MANAGEMENT GPS OUTPUT GEA 71 ENGINE/AIRFRAME UNIT GTX 33 TRANSPONDER GMU 44 #1 MAGNETOMETER HEADING GSA 81 PITCH TRIM GMU 44 #2 MAGNETOMETER HEADING GSA 81 PITCH GSA 80 ROLL GTX 33 TRANSPONDER GSA 80 YAW 16-3 Figure 16-2. Garmin G1000® Integrated Avionics Architecture CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY NO. 1 GIA 63W INTEGRATED AVIONICS UNIT GDC 74A #1 AIR DATA COMPUTER OAT AIRSPEED ALTITUDE VERTICAL SPEED GWX 68 ONBOARD RADAR CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL OPERATION PFD/MFD CONTROLS The avionics system controls are on the primary flight display (PFD) and multifunction display (MFD) bezels, the mode controller, and the audio panel. NAV VOL/ID KNOB NAV FREQUENCY TRANSFER KEY The PFD/MFD controls are illustrated in Figure 16-3 and described in Table 16-1. The bottom of each display includes softkeys. Which softkeys are displayed depends on the selected softkey level or the page being displayed. COM FREQUENCY TRANSFER KEY DUAL COM KNOB DUAL NAV KNOB COM VOL/SQ KNOB BARO KNOB JOYSTICK DIRECT-TO KEY ( ) MENU KEY FPL KEY PROC KEY CLR KEY ENT KEY A DUAL FMS KNOB DETAIL A Figure 16-3. PFD/MFD Controls 16-4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 16-1. PFD/MFD CONTROLS CONTROL NAV VOL/ID knob FUNCTION Controls NAV audio volume level. Press to toggle the Morse code identifier audio ON and OFF. Volume level is shown in the NAV frequency field as a percentage. NAV frequency transfer key Toggles the standby and active NAV frequencies transfer key Dual NAV knob Tunes the standby frequencies for the NAV receiver (large knob for MHz; small knob for kHz). Press to switch the tuning box (cyan box) between NAV1 and NAV2. Joystick Changes the map range when rotated. Activates the map pointer when pressed. BARO knob Sets the altimeter barometric pressure. Press to enter standard pressure (29.92). Dual COM knob Tunes the standby frequencies for the COM transceiver (large knob for MHz; small knob for kHz). Press to switch the tuning box (cyan box) between COM1 and COM2. COM frequency transfer key Toggles the standby and active COM frequencies. Press and hold this key for 2 seconds to tune the emergency frequency (121.5 MHz) automatically into the active frequency field. COM VOL/SQ knob Controls COM audio volume level. Volume level is shown in the COM frequency field as a percentage. Press to turn the COM automatic squelch ON and OFF. Direct-to key ( ) Allows the user to enter a destination waypoint and establish a direct course to the selected destination (the destination is either specified by the identifier, chosen from the active route, or taken from the map pointer position). FPL key Displays the active flightplan page for creating and editing the active flightplan. CLR key Erases information, cancels entries, or removes page menus. Dual FMS knob Flight management system (FMS) knob. Press the FMS knob to turn the selection cursor ON and OFF. When the cursor is ON, data can be entered in the applicable window by rotating the small and large knobs. The large knob moves the cursor on the page, while the small knob selects individual characters for the highlighted cursor location. MENU key Displays a context-sensitive list of options. This list allows the user to access additional features or make setting changes that relate to particular pages. PROC key Gives access to IFR departure procedures (DPs), arrival procedures (STARs), and approach procedures (IAPs) for a flightplan. If a flightplan is used, available procedures for the departure and/or arrival airport are automatically suggested. These procedures can then be loaded into the active flightplan. If a flightplan is not used, both the desired airport and the desired procedure can be selected. ENT key Validates or confirms a menu selection or data entry. AUTOMATIC FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM CONTROLS The automatic flight control system (AFCS) is controlled through the GMC 710 mode controller are illustrated in Figure 16-4 and described in Table 16-2. Revision 1 Additional AFCS Controls The AP DISC (autopilot disconnect) switch, CWS (control wheel steering) button, GO AROUND switch, and MEPT (manual electric pitch trim) switch are additional AFCS controls in the cockpit and are separate from the mode controller. These controls are discussed in detail in the AFCS section. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-5 16-6 HDG KNOB BC KEY NAV KEY CRS1 KNOB FD KEY XFR KEY BANK KEY AP KEY YD KEY ALT KEY VS KEY ALT SEL VNV KEY KNOB Revision 1 Figure 16-4. Mode Controller (GMC 710) FLC KEY NOSE UP/DN WHEEL SPD KEY CRS2 KNOB CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY HDG KEY APR KEY Revision 0 Table 16-2. MODE CONTROLS HDG key Selects/deselects heading select mode. APR key Selects/deselects approach mode. NAV key Selects/deselects navigation mode. FD key Activates/deactivates the FD in the default pitch and roll modes. If the autopilot is engaged, the FD key is disabled. Switches the autopilot between the pilot and the copilot FDs. This selection also selects which air data computer (ADC) is communicating with the active transponder and which PFD triggers the altitude alert. Upon power-up, the pilot-side FD is selected. ALT key Selects/deselects altitude hold mode. VS key Selects/deselects vertical speed mode. FLC key Selects/deselects flight level change mode. CRS2 knob Sets the copilot-selected course on the horizontal situation indicator (HSI) of PFD2 when the VOR1, VOR2, or OBS/SUSP mode is selected. Pressing this knob centers the course deviation indicator (CDI) on the currently selected VOR. The copilot-selected course provides course reference to the copilot FD when operating in navigation and approach modes. SPD key Disabled on Caravan. If pressed, “SPD NOT AVAIL” is annunciated on the PFD. NOSE UP/DN wheel Controls the active mode reference for the pitch, vertical speed, and flight level change modes. VNV key ALT SEL knob Selects/deselects vertical navigation mode. Sets the selected altitude in the selected altitude box. In addition to providing the standard G1000 altitude alerter function, selected altitude provides an altitude setting for the altitude capture/hold mode of the AFCS. YD key Engages/disengages the YD. AP key Engages/disengages the AP. BANK key Selects/deselects low bank mode. CRS1 knob Sets the pilot-selected course on the HSI of PFD1 when the VOR1, VOR2, or OBS/SUSP mode is selected. Pressing this knob centers the CDI on the currently selected VOR. The pilot-selected course provides course reference to the pilot-side FD when operating in navigation and approach modes. BC key HDG knob Selects/deselects backcourse mode. 16-7 Sets the selected heading on the HSI. When operating in heading select mode, this knob provides the heading reference to the FD. CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY XFR key CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL AUDIO PANEL CONTROLS POWER UP The audio panel controls are illustrated in Figure 16-5 and described in Table 16-3. During system initialization, test annunciations are displayed (Figure 16-6). All system annunciations disappear typically within 1 minute of power-up. COM1 MIC COM1 COM2 MIC COM2 COM3 MIC COM3 COM 1/2 PA MKR/MUTE TEL SPKR HI SENS DME NAV1 ADF NAV2 AUX MAN SQ PILOT PILOT KNOB PLAY COPLT PASS KNOB REVERSIONARY MODE (DISPLAY BACKUP) BUTTON Figure 16-5. Audio Panel Controls (GMA 1347) 16-8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 16-3. AUDIO PANEL CONTROLS COM1 MIC COM1 COM2 MIC COM2 COM3 MIC COM3 COM 1/2 Selects the No. 1 transmitter for transmitting. COM1 is simultaneously selected when this key is pressed allowing received audio from the No. 1 COM receiver to be heard. COM2 receiver audio can be added by pressing the COM2 key. When selected, audio from the No. 1 COM receiver can be heard. Selects the No. 2 transmitter for transmitting. COM2 is simultaneously selected when this key is pressed allowing received audio from the No. 2 COM receiver to be heard. COM2 can be deselected by pressing the COM2 key, or COM1 can be added by pressing the COM1 Key. When selected, audio from the No. 2 COM receiver can be heard. Not used on Cessna Caravan aircraft. Used for optional HF radio. Split COM is disabled on Cessna Caravan aircraft. TEL Pressing this key selects and deselects the airborne telephone. PA Selects the passenger address system. The selected COM transmitter is deselected when the PA key is pressed. SPKR Pressing this key selects and deselects the corresponding cockpit speaker. COM and NAV receiver audio can be heard on the speaker. MKR/MUTE HI SENS Mutes the currently received marker beacon receiver audio. Unmutes when new marker beacon audio is received. Also, stops play of the clearance recorder. Press to increase marker beacon receiver sensitivity. Press again to return to normal. DME Pressing turns distance measuring equipment (DME) audio on or off. NAV1 When selected, audio from the No. 1 NAV receiver can be heard. ADF Pressing turns on or off the audio from the automatic direction finder (ADF) receiver. NAV2 When selected, audio from the No. 2 NAV receiver can be heard. AUX Not used on Cessna Caravan aircraft. MAN SQ Press to enable manual squelch for the intercom. When active, press the PILOT knob to illuminate SQ. Turn the PILOT/PASS knobs to adjust squelch. PLAY Press once to play the last recorded audio. Pressing the PLAY key during play begins playing the previously recorded memory block. Each subsequent press of the PLAY key begins playing the next previously recorded block. Press the MKR/MUTE key to stop play. PILOT Pressing selects the pilot intercom isolation. Press again to deselect pilot isolation. COPLT Pressing selects the copilot intercom isolation. Press again to deselect copilot isolation. PILOT knob Press to switch between volume and squelch control as indicated by the VOL or SQ being illuminated. Turn to adjust intercom volume or squelch. The MAN SQ key must be selected to allow squelch adjustment. PASS knob Turn to adjust copilot/passenger intercom volume or squelch. The MAN SQ key must be selected to allow squelch adjustment. Reversionary Pressing manually selects reversionary mode. mode (display backup) button Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-9 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Figure 16-6. PFD Initialization Figure 16-7. MFD Power Up Page Upon power-up, key annunciators illuminate momentarily on the audio panels, the mode controller, and the display bezels. Pressing the ENT key acknowledges this information and displays the navigation map page (MAP). When the AHRS begins initializing, the annunication AHRS ALIGN: KEEP WINGS LEVEL is displayed on the PFD. The AHRS typically displays valid attitude and heading fields within one minute of power-up. The AHRS can align itself both while taxiing and during level flight. In normal mode, the PFD presents graphical flight instrumentation (attitude, heading, airspeed, altitude, and vertical speed), thereby replacing the traditional flight instrument cluster. The PFD also offers control for COM and NAV frequency selection. When the MFD powers up the MFD power-up page displays the following information (Figure 16-7): • System version • Copyright • Land database name and version • Obstacle database name and version • Terrain database name and version • Aviation database name, version, and effective date • ChartView ™ database information • SafeTaxi ™ database information Current database information includes the valid operating dates, cycle number, and database type. When this information has been reviewed for currency (to ensure that no databases have expired), the pilot is prompted to continue. 16-10 In normal mode, the right portion of the MFD displays a full-color moving map with navigation information, while the left portion of the MFD is dedicated to the engine instrument system (EIS). PFD DISPLAY Increased situational awareness replaces the traditional instruments on the panel with two easy to scan PDFs that feature (Figure 16-8): • Large horizons • • • • • Airspeed Attitude Altitude Vertical speed Course deviation information FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 Revision 1 AFCS STATUS BOX GPS STATUS BOX COM FREQUENCY BOX NAV FREQUENCY BOX FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY SELECTED ALTITUDE ALTIMETER AIRSPEED INDICATOR SELECTED ALTITUDE BUG VERTICAL SPEED INDICATOR (VSI) CURRENT HEADING TURN RATE INDICATOR TRUE AIRSPEED BAROMETRIC ALTIMETER SETTING CURRENT TRACK BUG SELECTED HEADING BUG COURSE DEVIATION INDICATOR (CDI) TRANSPONDER STATUS BOX HORIZONTAL SITUATION INDICATOR (HSI) SYSTEM TIME OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE (OAT) SOFTKEYS 16-11 Figure 16-8. Primary Flight Display (Default) CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ATTITUDE INDICATOR SLIP/SKID INDICATOR CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Each PFD also displays navigation, communication, terrain, traffic, and weather information (Figure 16-9). Airspeed Indicator displayed in knots below the airspeed indicator. The moving tape is marked with numeric labels and major tick marks at10-knot intervals, with minor tick marks at 5-knot intervals. Speed indication starts at 20 knots, with 60 knots of airspeed viewable at any time. The airspeed indicator displays airspeed on a rolling number gauge using a moving tape (Figure 16-10). The true airspeed (TAS) is The actual airspeed is displayed inside the black pointer. The pointer remains black until GLIDE SLOPE INDICATOR TRAFFIC ANNUNCIATION RADAR ALTIMETER HEIGHT AFCS STATUS ANNUNCIATION MARKER BEACON ANNUNCIATION COMPARATOR WINDOW SELECTED HEADING WIND DATA INSET MAP CAS MESSAGES WINDOW BEARING INFORMATION WINDOWS DME INFORMATION WINDOW ALERTS WINDOW MINIMUM DESCENT ALTITUDE/DECISION HEIGHT SELECTED COURSE Figure 16-9. Additional PFD Information 16-12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL AIRSPEED TREND VECTOR ACTUAL AIRSPEED VSPEED REFERENCE RED POINTER AT VMO SPEED RANGES TRUE AIRSPEED Figure 16-10. Airspeed Indicator and Pointer at VMO the aircraft reaches maximum operating speed (V MO ), at which point it turns red. A color-coded (white, green, and red/white striped barber pole) speed range strip is on the moving tape. The colors denote flap operating range, normal operating range, and maximum operating speed (V MO ). The red range is present for low speed awareness. The airspeed trend vector is a vertical, magenta line, extending up or down the airspeed scale, to the right of the color-coded speed range strip. The end of the trend vector corresponds to the predicted airspeed in 6 seconds if the current rate of acceleration is maintained. If the trend vector crosses V MO, the text of the actual airspeed readout changes to yellow. The trend vector is absent if the speed remains constant or if any data needed to calculate airspeed is unavailable because of a system failure. Attitude Indicator The attitude indicator information is displayed over a virtual blue sky and brown ground with a white horizon line. The attitude indicator displays the pitch (indicated by the yellow symbolic aircraft on the pitch scale), roll, and slip/skid information (Figure 16-11). Revision 1 The horizon line is part of the pitch scale. Above and below the horizon line, major pitch marks and numeric labels are shown for every 10°, up to 80°. Minor pitch marks are shown for intervening 5° increments, up to 25° below and 45° above the horizon line. Between 20° below to 20° above the horizon line, minor pitch marks occur every 2.5°. The inverted white triangle indicates 0° on the roll scale. Major tick marks at 30° and 60° and minor tick marks at 10°, 20°, and 45° are shown to the left and right of 0°. Angle of bank is indicated by the position of the pointer on the roll scale. Slip/Skid Indicator The slip/skid indicator is the bar beneath the roll pointer (Figure 16-12). The indicator moves with the roll pointer and moves laterally away from the pointer to indicate lateral acceleration. Slip/skid is indicated by the location of the bar relative to the pointer. One bar displacement is equal to one ball displacement on a traditional slip/skid indicator. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-13 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ROLL SCALE ZERO SKY REPRESENTATION ROLL POINTER SLIP/SKID INDICATOR ROLL SCALE PITCH SCALE HORIZON LINE AIRCRAFT SYMBOL (FORMATTED FOR SINGLE-CUE COMMAND BARS) LAND REPRESENTATION Figure 16-11. Attitude Indicator SELECTED ALTITUDE BUG SELECTED ALTITUDE Figure 16-12. Slip/Skid Indicator Altimeter The altimeter displays 600 feet of barometric altitude values at a time on a rolling number gauge using a moving tape (Figure 16-13). Numeric labels and major tick marks are at intervals of 100 feet. Minor tick marks are at intervals of 20 feet. The current altitude is displayed in the black pointer. The selected altitude is displayed above the altimeter in the box indicated by a selection bug. A bug corresponding to this altitude is shown on the tape. If the selected altitude exceeds the range shown on the tape, the bug appears at the corresponding edge of the tape. A magenta altitude trend vector extends up or down the left of the altitude tape, with the end resting at the approximate altitude to be reached in 6 seconds at the current vertical speed. The trend vector is not shown if altitude 16-14 ALTITUDE TREND VECTOR CURRENT ALTITUDE BAROMETRIC SETTING Figure 16-13. Altimeter remains constant. The barometric pressure setting is displayed below the altimeter in inches of mercury (in Hg). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Vertical Speed Indicator The vertical speed indicator (VSI) displays vertical speed with numeric labels and tick marks at 1,000 and 2,000 fpm intervals in each direction on the nonmoving tape. Minor tick marks are at intervals of 500 fpm (Figure 16-14). VNV TARGET ALTITUDE VERTICAL SPEED INDICATOR VERTICAL DEVIATION INDICATOR REQUIRED VERTICAL SPEED tion with the TOD within 1 minute alert. Fullscale deflection (two dots) is 1,000 feet. Glide Slope Indicator The glide slope indicator appears to the left of the altimeter whenever an ILS frequency is tuned in the active NAV field. A green diamond acts as the glide slope indicator, like a glide slope needle on a conventional indicator. If a localizer frequency is tuned and there is no glide slope the “NO GS” is annunciated (Figure 16-15). MARKER BEACON ANNUNCIATION VERTICAL SPEED POINTER GLIDE SLOPE INDICATOR Figure 16-14. Vertical Speed and Deviation Indicators (VSI and VDI) The current vertical speed is displayed in the pointer, which also points to that speed on the nonmoving tape. Digits appear in the pointer when the ascent or descent rate is greater than 100 fpm. If the rate of ascent/descent exceeds 2,000 fpm, the pointer appears at the corresponding edge of the tape and the rate appears inside the pointer. A magenta chevron bug shows the required vertical speed indication (RVSI) for reaching a VNV target altitude once the top of descent (TOD) within 1 minute alert is generated. Vertical Deviation Indicator The vertical deviation indicator (VDI) uses a magenta chevron to indicate the baro-VNV vertical deviation when vertical navigation (VNV) is in use. The VDI appears in conjunc- Revision 0 Figure 16-15. Glide Slope Indicator Glidepath The glidepath is analogous to the glide slope for GPS approaches supporting WAAS vertical guidance (LNAV+V, LNAV/VNAV, and LPV) and is system generated to reduce pilot workload during approach. When such an approach is in the flight plan and GPS is the selected navigation source, then the glidepath indicator (Figure 16-16) appears as a magenta diamond. If the approach type downgrades past the final approach fix (FAF), then the NO GP annunciation appears. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-15 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL meric labels at 30° intervals. Major tick marks are at 10° intervals and minor tick marks at 5° intervals. A digital reading of the current heading appears on top of the HSI and the current track is represented on the HSI by a magenta diamond. The HSI also presents turn rate, course deviation, bearing, and navigation source information. The 360° HSI contains a CDI with a course pointer, to/from indicator, and sliding deviation bar and scale (Figure 16-18). The course pointer is a single line arrow (GPS, VOR1, and LOC1) or a double line arrow (VOR2 and LOC2). The to/from arrow rotates with the course pointer and is displayed when the active NAVAID is received. GLIDEPATH INDICATOR FLIGHT PHASE NAVIGATION SOURCE SCALE Figure 16-16. Glidepath Indicator Horizontal Situation Indicator The HSI displays a rotating compass card in a heading-up orientation (Figure 16-17). Letters indicate the cardinal points, with nu- CROSSTRACK ERROR CDI Figure 16-18. Course Deviation Indicator CURRENT HEADING LUBBER LINE TURN RATE/HEADING TREND VECTOR TURN RATE INDICATOR SELECTED HEADING SELECTED COURSE CURRENT TRACK BUG LATERAL DEVIATION SCALE NAVIGATION SOURCE FLIGHT PHASE AIRCRAFT SYMBOL HEADING BUG COURSE POINTER COURSE DEVIATION INDICATOR (CDI) TO/FROM INDICATOR ROTATING COMPASS ROSE Figure 16-17. Horizontal Situation Indicator (HSI) 16-16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL The CDI can display the GPS or NAV (VOR, localizer) navigation sources (Figure 16-19). Color indicates the current navigation source: magenta for GPS or green for VOR and LOC. NAVIGATION SOURCE SELECTED ON BOTH PFDS The full scale limits for the CDI are defined by a GPS-derived distance when coupled to GPS (Table 16-4). When coupled to a VOR or a localizer (LOC), the CDI has the same angular limits as a mechanical CDI. If the CDI exceeds the maximum deviation on the scale (two dots) while coupled to GPS, the crosstrack error (XTK) is displayed below the white aircraft symbol. Enabling the omni-bearing selector (OBS) mode suspends the automatic sequencing of waypoints in a GPS flight plan (GPS must be the selected navigation source), but retains the current “active-to” waypoint as the navigation reference, even after passing the waypoint. The OBS is annunciated to the lower right of the aircraft symbol when OBS mode is selected (Figure 16-20). Figure 16-19. Navigation Sources While OBS mode is enabled, a course line is drawn through the active-to waypoint on the moving map. If desired, the course to/from waypoint can be adjusted. When OBS mode is disabled, the GPS flight plan returns to normal Table 16-4. AUTOMATIC GPS CDI SCALING Flight Phase Annunciation Automatic CDI Full-scale Deflection Departure DPRT 0.3 nm Terminal TERM 1.0 nm Enroute ENR 2.0 nm Oceanic OCN 2.0 nm Approach (Non-precision) LNAV Approach (Non-precision with vertical guidance) LNAV + V Approach (LNAV/VNAV) L/VNAV Approach (LPV) LPV 1.0 nm decreasing to a specified course width, then 0.3 nm, depending on variables (see Figure 2-31) Missed approach MAPR 0.3 nm 1.0 nm decreasing to 350 feet depending on variables (see Figure 2-30) NOTE: Flight phase annunciations are normally shown in magenta, but when cautionary conditions exist the color changes to yellow. Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-17 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL OBS COURSE GPS SELECTED OBS MODE ENABLED EXTENDED COURSE LINE OBS SOFTKEY ENABLES OBS MODE operation with automatic sequencing of waypoints, following the course set in OBS mode. The flightpath on the moving map retains the modified course line. As the aircraft crosses the missed approach point (MAP), automatic approach waypoint sequencing is suspended. The SUSP annunciation displays on the HSI to the lower right of the aircraft symbol in place of OBS and the OBS softkey label changes to SUSP. Pressing the SUSP softkey resumes automatic sequencing of approach waypoints (Figure 16-21). 16-18 Turn Rate Indicator The turn rate indicator is directly above the rotating compass rose (Figure 16-22). Tick marks left and right of the lubber line denote half-standard and standard turn rates. A magenta turn rate trend vector shows the current turn rate. The end of the trend vector gives the heading predicted in 6 seconds, based on the present turn rate. A standard rate turn is shown on the indicator by the trend vector stopping at the standard turn rate tick mark, corresponding to a predicted FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL heading of 18° from the current heading. At rates greater than 4°/second, an arrowhead appears at the end of the magenta trend vector and the prediction is no longer valid. Outside Air Temperature Bearing Pointers Wind Direction and Speed Two bearing pointers and the associated information can be displayed on the HSI for NAV, GPS, and ADF sources (Figure 16-23). The pointers are light blue and single- (BRG1) or double-lined (BRG2). An icon is shown in the respective information window to indicate the pointer type. The bearing pointers never override the CDI and are visually separated from the CDI by a white ring (shown when bearing pointers are selected but not necessarily visible due to data unavailability). Wind direction and speed (relative to the aircraft) in knots can be displayed in a window to the upper left of the HSI. When the window is selected for display, but wind information is invalid or unavailable, the window shows NO WIND DATA. Wind data can be displayed in three different ways, as illustrated in Figure 16-24. DME Information Window The DME information window is displayed above the BRG1 information window and shows the DME label, tuning mode (NAV1, NAV2, or HOLD), frequency, and distance. When a signal is invalid, the distance is replaced by –.– – NM. BEARING 1 POINTER TUNING MODE The OAT is displayed in degrees Celsius (°C) by default in the lower left of the PFD. Marker Beacon Annunciations Marker beacon annunciations are displayed on the PFD to the left of the selected altitude. Outer marker reception is indicated in blue, middle in yellow, and inner in white (Figure 16-25). System Alerting System alerting messages appear in the alerts window (in the lower right corner of the PFD), BEARING 2 POINTER FREQUENCY DISTANCE DETAIL A DME INFORMATION WINDOW NO WAYPOINT SELECTED DISTANCE TO BEARING SOURCE STATION IDENTIFIER A B C BEARING POINTER SOURCE ICON POINTER BEARING ICON SOURCE DETAIL C BEARING 2 INFORMATION WINDOW DETAIL B BEARING 1 INFORMATION WINDOW Figure 16-23. HSI with Bearing and DME Information Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-19 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL OPTION 1 OPTION 2 OPTION 3 NO DATA DETAIL A Figure 16-24. Wind Data OUTER MARKER MIDDLE MARKER INNER MARKER COMPARATOR WINDOW REVERSIONARY SENSOR WINDOW DETAIL A A ALTIMETER Figure 16-25. Marker Beacon Annunciations ALERTS WINDOW (Figure 16-26) when a warning, caution, advisory alert, or G1000 ® message advisory occurs. System alert messages are provided for awareness of G1000 ® system problems or status and may not require pilot action. The alerts window allows simultaneous display of system alerts. The FMS knob can be used to scroll through the alert messages. The alerts window is enabled/disabled by selecting the ALERTS softkey. If the window is already open when a new message is generated, selecting the ALERTS softkey to acknowledge the message causes it to turn gray. The ALERTS softkey label changes to display the appropriate annunciation when an alert is issued. 16-20 SOFTKEY ANNUNCIATION Figure 16-26. G1000® Alerting System The annunciation flashes and the appropriate aural alert sounds until acknowledged by pressing the softkey. The softkey reverts to the ALERTS softkey label, and when pressed again, displays the alerts window. The annunciation window appears to the right of the VSI and displays abbreviated annunciation text for aircraft alerts. Text color is based on alert level: warnings appear in red, cautions FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL in yellow, and advisory alerts in white. Alerts are displayed by priority. New warning and caution level alerts, are displayed at the top and advisories at the bottom, of the annunciation window. Warnings are time-critical and require immediate attention. A flashing WARNING softkey annunciation and single chime every 2 seconds indicates the presence of a warning. The WARNING softkey flashes and the chime continues until acknowledged by the WARNING softkey being pressed. Cautions indicate abnormal conditions that can require intervention. A flashing CAUTION softkey annunciation and single chime indicates the presence of a caution. The CAUTION softkey flashes until pressed. An advisory provides general information to the pilot that may not need immediate attention. A flashing ADVISORY softkey annunciation (no aural chime), indicates a message advisory. The ADVISORY softkey flashes until pressed. Critical values generated by redundant sensors are monitored by comparators. If differences in the sensors exceed a specified amount, the comparator window appears in the upper right corner of the PFD and the discrepancy is annunciated as MISCOMP (miscompare) in the comparator window. If either or both of the sensed values are unavailable, it is annunciated as a NO COMP (no compare). These annunciations reflect reversionary sensors selected on either or both PFDs. Pressing the SENSOR softkey accesses the ADC1, ADC2, AHRS1, and AHRS2 softkeys. These softkeys allow switching of the sensors being viewed on each PFD. Depending on the type of sensor failure, the G1000 ® can make some sensor selections automatically. The GPS sensor cannot be switched manually. Traffic Traffic is displayed symbolically on the inset map (PFD) (Figures 16-27 and 16-28). DETAIL A DETAIL B A B Figure 16-27. Traffic and TAWS Indications (Example) Reversionary sensor selection is annunciated in a window on the right side of the PFD. POTENTIAL IMPACT POINT PROJECTED FLIGHT PATH 100' THRESHOLD UNLIGHTED OBSTACLE 1,000' Figure 16-28. Terrain Colors Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-21 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Terrain Awareness and Warning System TAWS annunciations appear on the PFD to the upper left of the altimeter. Refer to the “Hazard Avoidance” section of the Pilot’s Operating Handbook and Airplane Flight Manual (POH/AFM) for more information. Figure 16-30. ALT Setting (Timer/ Refences/Window) Figure 16-31. RA as Altitude Source for MDA/DH Radar Altimeter When the radar height (the aircraft altitude above ground level detected by the radar altimeter) is between –40 and 2,500 feet, the current value is displayed in green above the current aircraft heading (Figure 16-29). The radar height display becomes less sensitive as the height above ground increases (Table 16-5). When the radar altimeter is selected as the altitude source for minimum descent altitude alerting function (Figure 16-30), the color of the radar height changes to yellow (Figure 16-31). A ground line is shown on the altimeter to display the aircraft height relative to the ground (Figure 1632). If the data becomes invalid, the message RA FAIL is displayed in yellow in place of the current radar height (Figure 16-33). GROUND LINE RADAR ALTIMETER MINIMUMS BOX Figure 16-32. Altimeter Displaying the Ground Line (RAD ALT) Figure 16-33. Radar Altimeter Invalid Data MFD DISPLAY Figure 16-29. Current Radar Height Table 16-5. RADAR ALTIMETER SENSITIVITY RADAR HEIGHT RANGE SHOWN TO NEAREST –40 TO 200 FEET 5 FEET 200 TO 1,500 FEET 10 FEET 1,500 TO 2,500 FEET 50 FEET 16-22 The MFD provides an alternate display for essential flight instrumentation from either PDF through the use of reversionary mode. Engine Information System Display The EIS displays critical engine, fuel, and electrical information on the left of the MFD during normal operation (Figure 16-34). In reversionary mode, the displays are reconfigured to present PFD symbology together with the EIS (Figure 16-35). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL The EIS information is on two displays, accessed using the ENGINE softkey on the MFD. The ENGINE display is shown by default. EIS If the EIS system display is currently shown, the engine display can be selected by pressing the ENGINE or BACK softkey. Critical changes in certain systems can automatically revert the EIS to the ENGINE display. Figure 16-34. MFD Normal Operations The top of the EIS displays indicators for torque, interstage turbine temperature (ITT), gas generator speed, and propeller speed (Figures 16-36 and 16-37, and Table 16-6). If one of the optional ice protection systems is installed, the amount of TKS fluid in gallons (A-ICE GAL) or the propeller deicing heater current (PROP AMPS) is displayed below the electrical indicators (Figure 16-38). System Display The system display is accessed by pressing the SYSTEM softkey. Besides the gauges, all indications on this display are digital readouts, separated into the following categories: • Fuel (quantities and flow) • Fuel totalizer (fuel remaining and used calculations) • Electrical Figure 16-35. MFD Reversionary Mode EIS information uses dial gauges, vertical slider indicators, horizontal bar indicators, and digital readouts. Green bands indicate normal range of operation; yellow and red bands indicate caution and warning, respectively. White or uncolored bands indicate areas outside of normal operation not yet in the caution and warning ranges. When unsafe operating conditions occur, readouts, pointers, and labels flash and change color based on the condition. If sensor data to an instrument becomes invalid or unavailable, a red X appears across the instrument. Revision 0 Figure 16-39 and Table 16-7 show the information displayed below the electrical indicator if the optional anti-ice system is installed (Figure 16-40). When the MENU key is pressed it displays a context-sensitive list of options. The options provide access to additional features or allow changes which specifically relate to the currently displayed window/page. The system has no all-encompassing menu. Some menus provide access to additional submenus that are used to view, edit, select, and review options. Menus display NO OPTIONS when no options are available for the selected page (Figure 16-41). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-23 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL TORQUE GAUGE (TRQ FT-LB) INTERSTAGE TURBINE TEMPERATURE GAUGE (ITT °C) GENERATOR SPEED GAUGE (NG% RPM) PROPELLER SPEED (PROP RPM) OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR (OIL PSI) OIL TEMP INDICATOR (OIL °C) FUEL QUANTITY INDICATOR (FUEL QTY LBS) FUEL FLOW (FFLOW PPH) AMMETER (BAT AMPS) VOLTMETER (BUS VOLTS) PROPELLER HEAT (PROP AMPS) Figure 16-36. Engine Indications 16-24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ENGINE OFF ENGINE START NORMAL Figure 16-37. ITT Gauge Status Annunciations Table 16-6. INDICATIONS AND DESCRIPTION INDICATIONS DESCRIPTION Torque gauge (TRQ FT-LB) Displays engine torque in foot-pounds (ft-lb). Warning indication is propeller-speed sensitive and changes for speeds between 1,800 and 1,900 rpm. A light blue bug represents the recommended cruise torque setting. The bug appears for certain combinations of propeller speed, OAT, airspeed, and altitude. Interstage turbine temperature gauge (ITT °C) Displays ITT in degrees Celsius (°C). Operating ranges differ for engine start and normal running conditions. When the engine is running, STRT is annunciated above the temperature readout. When the engine is off or is shutting down, OFF is annunciated (Figure 16-37). Generator speed gauge (NG % RPM) Displays gas generator speed as a percentage Propeller speed (PROP RPM) Displays propeller speed in revolutions per minute (rpm) Oil pressure indicator (OIL PSI) Displays engine oil pressure in pounds per square inch (psi) Oil temperature indicator (OIL °C) Displays engine oil temperature in °C Fuel quantity indicator (FUEL QTY LBS) Displays quantities of fuel in pounds (lb) in the left (L) and right (R) tanks Fuel flow (FFLOW PPH) Displays current fuel flow in pounds per hour (pph) Ammeter (BAT AMPS) Displays DC current in amperes (amps) for the battery Voltmeter (BUS VOLTS) Displays DC bus voltage Propeller heat (PROP AMPS) Displays propeller deicing heater current (Figure 16-38) ANTI-ICE FLUID PROPELLER HEAT Figure 16-38. Anti-Ice System Indications Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-25 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL TORQUE GAUGE INTERSTAGE TURBINE TEMPERATURE GAUGE GENERATOR SPEED GAUGE PROPELLER SPEED FUEL QUANTITIES FUEL FLOW SET FUEL REMAINING CALCULATED FUEL USED AMMETER VOLTMETER Figure 16-39. System Display ANTI-ICE FLUID PROPELLER HEAT Figure 16-40. Anti-Ice System Indications (Optional) 16-26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 16-7. SYSTEM GAUGE INDICATIONS AND DESCRIPTION INDICATIONS DESCRIPTION Torque gauge (TRQ FT-LB) Displays engine torque in foot-pounds (ft-lb). Warning indication is propeller-speed sensitive and changes for speeds between 1,800 and 1,900 rpm. A light blue bug represents the recommended cruise torque setting. The bug appears for certain combinations of propeller speed, OAT, airspeed, and altitude. Interstage turbine temperature gauge (ITT °C) Displays ITT in degrees Celsius (°C). Operating ranges differ for engine start and normal operation. When the engine is running, STRT is annunciated above the temperature readout. When the engine is off or shutting down, OFF is annunciated. Generator speed gauge (NG % RPM) Displays gas generator speed as a percentage Propeller speed (PROP RPM) Displays propeller speed in revolutions per minute (rpm) Fuel quantities (QTY L/R LB) Displays quantities of fuel in pounds (lb) in the left (L) and right (R) tanks Fuel flow (FFLOW PPH) Displays current fuel flow in pounds per hour (pph) Set fuel remaining (LB REM) Displays current fuel remaining in lb as set by the pilot and adjusted based on fuel flow since last set. Calculated fuel used (LB USED) Displays quantity of fuel used in pounds based on fuel flow since last reset. Ammeter (GEN, ALT, BAT AMPS) Displays generator (GEN), alternator (ALT), and battery (BAT) currents in amperes (amps). Voltmeter (BUS VOLTS) Displays DC bus voltage. Anti-ice (A-ICE GAL) Displays anti-ice fluid in gallons. Time remaining (TIME REM) Displays time remaining until anti-ice fluid is out. NO OPTIONS WITH NRST WINDOW DISPLAYED ON THE PFD OPTIONS WITH FPL WINDOWS DISPLAYED Figure 16-41. Page Menu Examples Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-27 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL MFD Page Groups The MFD page group and active page title box are displayed in the upper center of the screen, below the navigation status box. In the bottom right corner of the current page group, the number of pages available in the group, and the placement of the current page within the group are indicated. The MFD displays information in four main page groups. Specific pages within each group can vary depending on the configuration of optional equipment (Figure 16-42). The MFD has 28 different map ranges available, from 500 feet to 2,000 nm. The range is changed by the joystick knob. The current range is indicated in the lower right corner of the map and represents the top-to-bottom distance covered by the map. When the map range is decreased to a point that exceeds the capability of the G1000 ® to accurately represent the map, a magnifying glass icon appears to the left of the map range. To decrease the map range turn the joystick counterclockwise; to increase the range, turn the joystick clockwise. When the panning function is selected by pressing the joystick, the map pointer flashes on the map. A window also appears at the top of the map showing the latitude/longitude position of the pointer, the bearing and distance to the pointer from the aircraft present position, and the elevation of the land at the position of the pointer. When the map pointer is placed on an object, the name of the object is highlighted (even if the name was not originally displayed on the map). When any map feature or object is selected on the map display, pertinent information is displayed. Figure 16-42. Map Pages 16-28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL When the map pointer crosses an airspace boundary, the boundary is highlighted and airspace information is shown at the top of the display. The information includes the name and class of airspace, the ceiling in feet above mean sea level (MSL), and the floor in feet MSL. The MFD includes airport information and XM information pages, which are selected first from within a main page group with the FMS knobs, then with the applicable softkey at the bottom of the page. When either page is selected, the page remains displayed until a different page softkey is pressed. Waypoints can be selected by entering the International Civil Aviation Organization (ICAO) identifier, the facility name, or the city name. When either a waypoint identifier, facility name, or location is entered, the systems Spell ‘N’Find™ feature searches the database and displays those waypoints matching the characters entered. A direct-to navigation leg to the selected waypoint can be initiated by pressing the directto key on any of the waypoint pages. Communication and navigation frequencies can be tuned automatically from various waypoint information (WPT) pages (Figure 16-43), nearest (NRST) pages, and the nearest airports window (on the PFD). The autotuning feature simplifies frequency entry over manual tuning. Refer to the communication, navigation, and surveillance and the audio panel sections for details. AIRPORT INFORMATION PAGES Figure 16-43. Waypoint Pages Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-29 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Waypoint Pages (WPT) Auxiliary Pages (AUX) The waypoint pages (WPT) provide the following types of information: The auxiliary pages provide the following information (Figure 16-44): • Airport information pages ° ° ° ° ° • Trip planning Airport information (INFO softkey) • Utility Departure information (DP softkey) • GPS status Arrival information (STAR softkey) Approach information (APR softkey) Weather information (WX softkey) • Intersection information • Nondirectional beacon (NDB) information System setup: • XM satellite pages ° XM information (INFO softkey) ° XM radio (RADIO softkey) • System status • VOR information • User waypoint information XM Satellite Pages Figure 16-44. Auxiliary Pages 16-30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NRST Pages The NRST pages are: The nearest airports page is the first in the NRST page group because of its potential use if an in-flight emergency occurs (Figure 1645). The page displays a map of the currently selected airport and surrounding area, as well as the nearest airport information. The information appears in five boxes: • Nearest airports • Nearest intersections • Nearest NDB • Nearest VOR • Nearest user waypoints • Nearest airports • Nearest frequencies • Information • Nearest airspaces • Runways • Frequencies • Approaches Flight Plan Pages In addition to the main page groups accessed exclusively using the FMS knobs, pages for flight planning (FPL) and loading procedures Figure 16-45. Nearest Page Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-31 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL procedures (PROC) accessible using the bezel key. In some instances, softkeys can be used to access the procedure pages. The flight plan pages are accessed by pressing the FPL key on the MFD. Main pages within this group are selected by rotating the small FMS knob. The FPL pages include (Figure 16-46): • Active flight plan—Wide view, narrow view (VIEW softkey) • Flight plan catalog—Stored flight plan (NEW softkey) Flight planning consists of building a flight plan by entering waypoints one at a time, adding waypoints along airways, and inserting departures, airways, arrivals, or approaches as needed. 16-32 The G1000 ® allows entry of flight planning information from either the MFD or PFD. The flight plan is displayed on maps using different line widths, colors, and types, based on the leg and segment of the flight plan currently being flown (departure, enroute, arrival, approach, or missed approach). Up to 99 flight plans, each with up to 99 waypoints, can be created and stored in memory. One flight plan can be activated at a time to become the active flight plan. The vertical navigation (VNV) function provides vertical profile guidance during the enroute and terminal phases of flight. The VNV provides guidance based on specified altitudes at waypoints in the active flight plan or to a direct-to waypoint. It includes vertical path guidance to a descending path, which is FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL provided as a linear deviation from the desired path. The desired path is defined by a line joining two waypoints with specified altitudes or as a vertical angle from a specified waypoint/altitude. The vertical waypoints are integrated into the active flight plan. Both manual and autopilot-coupled guidance are supported. Procedure Pages (PROC) The procedure pages can be accessed any time by pressing the PROC key on the MFD. A menu is initialized, and when a departure, approach, or arrival is selected, the appropriate procedure page loads (Figure 16-47). Turning the FMS knob does not scroll through the procedure pages (note the single page symbol in the lower right corner). The following procedure pages are provided: • Departure loading • Arrival loading When an approach, departure, or arrival procedure is loaded into the active flight plan, a set of approach, departure, or arrival waypoints is loaded into the flight plan with a header describing the selected instrument procedure. The original enroute portion of the flight plan remains active when the procedure loads, unless an instrument procedure is activated. The WAAS GPS allows for flying LNAV/ LNAV+V, VNAV, and LPV approaches according to the published chart. LNAV+V is a standard LNAV approach with advisory vertical guidance provided for assistance in maintaining a constant vertical glidepath similar to an ILS glide slope on approach. This guidance is displayed on the PFD as a magenta diamond in the same location as the ILS glide slope. LNAV+V is indicated by the system during an approach, with LNAV minima used. The active approach type is annunciated on the HSI as shown in Table 16-8. • Approach loading Figure 16-47. Procedure Pages Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-33 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 16-8. APPROACH TYPES HSI ANNUNCIATION DESCRIPTION LNAV GPS approach using published LNAV minima. LNAV+V GPS approach using published LNAV minima. Advisory vertical guidance is provided. L/VNAV (Available only if WAAS equipped) GPS approach using published LNAV/VNAV minima. LPV (Available only if WAAS equipped) GPS approach using published LPV minima. Audio Panel The audio panel provides traditional audio selector functions, a microphone, and a receiver. The audio panel includes an intercom system (ICS) between the pilot, copilot, and passengers, a marker beacon receiver, and a COM clearance recorder. Ambient noise from the aircraft radios is reduced by the master avionics squelch (MASQ) feature. When no audio is detected, MASQ processing further reduces background radio noise. The COM frequency box has four fields: the two active frequencies are on the left and the two standby frequencies are on the right (Figure 16-48). The COM transceiver is selected for transmission by pressing the COM ACTIVE FIELDS EXAMPLE ON HSI APPROACH TYPE • LNAV • LNAV+V • L/VNAV • LPV MIC keys on the audio panel. During audio reception from the selected COM radio, audio from the other COM radio is muted. An active COM frequency displayed in green indicates that the COM transceiver is selected (COM1 MIC or COM2 MIC key). When both active COM frequencies appear in white, then no COM radio is selected for transmission. The PA k e y i s s e l e c t e d o n t h e a u d i o p a n e l . Frequencies in the standby field are displayed in white. Selecting the Radio Press the small COM knob to transfer the frequency tuning box and frequency transfer arrow between the upper and lower radio frequency STANDBY FIELDS TOP SECTION OF THE AUDIO PANEL TUNING BOX COM2 RADIO IS SELECTED ON THE AUDIO PANEL Figure 16-48. Selecting a COM Radio for Transmit 16-34 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL fields (Figure 16-49). The small COM knob on the MFD links to the pilot PFD (PFD1) only. The small COM knob on the copilot PFD (PFD2) operates independently. Activating 121.500 MHZ Press and hold the COM frequency transfer key for 2 seconds to automatically load the emergency COM frequency (121.500 MHz) in the active field of the selected COM radio (the radio indicated with the transfer arrow) (Figure 16-50). Selecting the Navigation Radio The NAV frequency controls and frequency boxes are on the left of the MFD and PFD (Figure 16-51). The MFD frequency controls and displays are linked to the PFD1 only. The active frequencies are on the right and the standby frequencies are on the left. Pressing the CDI softkey on the PFD selects a NAV radio for navigation (Figure 16-52). The selected NAV frequency is displayed in green. To select a NAV radio receiver, press the corresponding keys on the audio panel (Figure 1653). Pressing the NAV1, NAV2, ADF, or DME PRESS THE COM KNOB TO SWITCH THE TUNING BOX FROM ONE COM RADIO TO THE OTHER Figure 16-49. Switching COM Tuning Boxes PRESS FOR 2 SECONDS TO LOAD 121.500 MHz Figure 16-50. Tuning 121.500 MHz TURN VOL/ID KNOB TO ADJUST VOLUME. PRESS KNOB TO TURN MORSE CODE ON OR OFF PRESS THE FREQUENCY TRANSFER KEY TO TRANSFER NAV FREQUENCIES BETWEEN ACTIVE AND STANDBY FREQUENCY FIELDS TURN THE NAV KNOB TO TUNE THE FREQUENCY IN THE TUNING BOX Figure 16-51. NAV Frequency Tuning Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-35 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL STANDBY FIELDS TUNING BOX ACTIVE FIELDS THE NAV RADIO IS SELECTED BY PRESSING THE CDI SOFTKEY Figure 16-52. Selecting a NAV Radio for Navigation Figure 16-54. Intercom Controls Figure 16-53. Selecting a NAV Radio Receiver key selects and deselects the navigation radio source. Selected audio can be transmitted over the headset and speaker (if selected). All radios can be selected individually or simultaneously. Intercom The audio panel has a six-position intercom system (ICS) and a stereo music input for the pilot, copilot, and up to four passengers. The intercom provides pilot and copilot isolation from the passengers and aircraft radios (Figure 16-54). 16-36 Isolation Modes Pilot isolation is selected when the PILOT annunciator illuminates. During pilot isolation, the pilot can hear the selected radios and aural alerts and warnings. The copilot and passengers can communicate with each other. The copilot is isolated from aural alerts and warnings (Table 16-9). Copilot isolation is selected when the COPLT annunciator illuminates. The copilot is isolated from the selected radios, aural alerts and warnings, and everyone else. The pilot and passengers can hear the selected radios and communicate with each other. When the PILOT and COPLT annunciators are illuminated, the pilot and copilot can hear the selected radios and communicate with each other. The passengers are isolated from the pilot and copilot but can communicate with each other. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 16-9. ICS ISOLATION MODES PILOT KEY COPLT KEY ANNUNCIATOR ANNUNCIATOR PILOT HEARS COPILOT HEARS PASSENGER HEARS OFF OFF Selected radios, aural alerts, pilot, copilot, passengers, MUSIC 1 Selected radios, aural alerts, pilot, copilot, passengers, MUSIC 1 Selected radios, aural alerts, pilot, copilot passengers, MUSIC 2 ON OFF Selected radios, aural alerts, pilot Copilot, passengers, MUSIC 1 Copilot, passengers, MUSIC 2 OFF ON Selected radios, aural alerts, pilot, passengers, MUSIC 1 Copilot Selected radios, aural alerts, pilot, passengers, MUSIC 2 ON ON Selected radios, aural alerts, pilot, copilot Selected radios, aural alerts, pilot, copilot Passengers, MUSIC 2 When both the PILOT and COPLT annunciators extinguish, everyone hears the selected radios and can communicate with everyone else. The PILOT/PASS knob controls volume or manual squelch adjustment for the pilot and copilot/passenger. The small knob controls the pilot volume and squelch. The large knob controls the copilot/passenger volume and squelch. The VOL and SQ annunciations at the bottom of the unit indicate which function the knob is controlling. Pressing the PILOT/PASS knob switches between volume and squelch as indicated by illumination of the VOL or SQ annunciation (Figure 16-55). The MAN SQ key allows automatic or manual control of the squelch settings. When the MAN SQ annunciator is extinguished (automatic squelch is on), the PILOT/PASS knob controls only the volume, and pressing the P I L OT / PA S S k n o b h a s n o e ff e c t o n t h e VOL/SQ selection.When the MAN SQ annunciator is illuminated (manual squelch), the PILOT/PASS knob controls both volume and squelch. Revision 0 Clearance Recorder and Player The audio panel contains a digital clearance recorder that records up to 2.5 minutes of the selected COM radio signal (Figure 16-56). Recorded COM audio is stored in separate memory blocks. Once 2.5 minutes of recording time has elapsed, the recorder begins recording over the stored memory blocks, starting from the oldest block. AUTOMATIC FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM The GFC 700 is a AFCS fully integrated with the avionics system (Figure 16-57). The PLAY KEY CONTROLS THE MEMORY FUNCTION Figure 16-56. Clearance Recorder Play Function FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-37 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL MANUAL SQUELCH ANNUNCIATOR; OFF FOR AUTOMATIC SQUELCH, ON FOR MANUAL SQUELCH AUTOMATIC/MANUAL SQUELCH PILOT VOLUME OR MANUAL SQUELCH. PRESS TO SWITCH BETWEEN VOL AND SQ. TURN TO ADJUST SQUELCH WHEN SQ ANNUNCIATION IS LIT, VOLUME WHEN VOL ANNUNCIATION IS LIT. COPILOT/PASSENGER VOLUME OR MANUAL SQUELCH SQUELCH ANNUNCIATION VOLUME ANNUNCIATION Figure 16-55. Volume/Squelch Control Figure 16-57. GFC 700 Mode Control Unit AFCS functions are distributed across the following LRUs: The mode controller has the following main functions: • GDU 1040A PFDs (2) Flight director (FD) • GDU 1040A MFD Autopilot (AP) • GMC 710 mode controller Yaw damper (YD) • GIA 63W integrated avionics units (IAUs) (2) Manual electric pitch trim (MEPT) • GSA 80 AFCS servos (2) • GSA 81 AFCS servos (2) • GSM 85 servo mounts (4) 16-38 FD—The aircraft has two flight directors, each operating within an integrated avionics unit. Commands for the selected flight director are displayed on both PFDs. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL The flight director provides: • C o m m a n d b a r s s h ow i n g p i t c h / r o l l guidance • Vertical/lateral mode selection and processing • Autopilot communication AP)—Autopilot operation occurs within the pitch, roll, and pitch trim servos. It also provides servo monitoring and automatic flight control in response to flight director steering commands, AHRS attitude and rate information, and airspeed. YD—The yaw servo is self-monitoring and provides Dutch roll dampering and turn coordination in response to yaw rate, roll angle, lateral acceleration, and airspeed. MEPT—The pitch trim servo provides manual electric pitch trim capability when autopilot is not engaged. The following AFCS controls are in the cockpit, separate from the mode controller (Figure 16-58): AP TRIM DISC CONTROL WHEEL STEERING AP DISC switch (autopilot disconnect)— Disengages the autopilot and yaw damper and interrupts pitch trim operation. The AP DISC switch is on each control wheel and is used to acknowledge an autopilot disconnect alert and to mute the associated aural tone. CWS button (control wheel steering)—One button on each control wheel. While pressed, allows manual control of the aircraft while the autopilot is engaged and synchronizes the flight director command bars with the current aircraft pitch (if not in a vertical navigation, glide slope, or glidepath mode). When the button is released the FD can establish new pitch and roll references, depending on the current vertical and lateral modes. GA switch (go-around)—The GA switch, which is on the throttle, disengages the autopilot and selects the flight director takeoff (on ground) or go-around (in air) mode. If an approach procedure is loaded the switch activates the missed approach when the selected navigation source is GPS or when the navigation source is VOR/LOC and a valid frequency is tuned. The GA switch is on the throttle. GO AROUND MEPT SWITCH Figure 16-58. Additional AFCS Controls Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-39 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL MEPT switch—The MEPT switch on the each control wheel is used to command manual electric pitch trim. The composite switch has left and right sides. The left side is the ARM contact and the right side controls the DN (forward) and UP (rearward) contacts. Pressing the MEPT ARM switch disengages the autopilot, if currently engaged, but does not affect yaw damper operation. The MEPT ARM switch is used to acknowledge an autopilot disconnect alert and mute the associated aural tone. Manual trim commands are generated only when both sides of the switch are operated simultaneously. If either side of the switch is active separately for more than 3 seconds, the MEPT function is disabled and PTRM is displayed as the AFCS status on each PFD. The function remains disabled until both sides of the switch are inactivated. FLIGHT DIRECTOR The flight director provides pitch and roll commands to the AFCS and displays the commands on the PFDs. When the flight director is active, the aircraft can be hand-flown to follow the path shown by the command bars. Maximum commanded pitch (–15º, +20º) and roll (22º) angles, vertical acceleration, and roll rate are limited to values established during AFCS certification. The flight director also provides autopilot commands. Initially pressing any key listed in Table 16-10 (when the flight director is inactive) activates the pilot flight director in the listed modes. Pressing the FD key again deactivates the flight director and removes the command bars on all displays. The FD key is disabled when the autopilot is engaged. AFCS Status Box Flight director mode annunciations appear on each PFD when the flight director is active (Figure 16-59). Flight director selection and autopilot and yaw damper statuses appear in the center of the AFCS status box. Lateral modes appear on the left and vertical modes appear on the right. Armed modes appear in white and active modes appear in green. Table 16-10. FLIGHT DIRECTOR ACTIVATION CONTROL PRESSED FLIGHT DIRECTOR ACTIVATED MODES SELECTED VERTICAL LATERAL FD key (pilot-side) Pilot-side Pitch hold (default) Roll hold (default) AP key Pilot-side Pitch hold (default) Roll hold (default) CWS button Pilot-side Pitch hold (default) Roll hold (default) GA switch Pilot-side Takeoff (on ground) Go–around (in air) Takeoff (on ground) Go around (in air) ALT key Pilot-side Altitude hold Roll hold (default) VS key Pilot-side Vertical speed Roll hold (default) VNV key Pilot-side Vertical path tracking* Roll hold (default) NAV key Pilot-side Pitch hold (default) Navigation** APR key Pilot-side Pitch hold (default) Approach** HDG key Pilot-side Pitch hold (default) Heading select * Valid VNV flight plan must be entered before VNV key press activates flight director. ** The selected navigation receiver must have a valid VOR or LOC signal or active GPS course before NAV or APR key press activates flight director. 16-40 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL LATERAL MODES ARMED AUTOPILOT YAW STATUS DAMPER STATUS VERTICAL MODES ACTIVE ACTIVE ARMED MODE FLIGHT DIRECTOR INDICATOR ARROW REFERENCE SELECTED ALTITUDE VERTICAL SPEED REFERENCE COMMAND BARS SELECTED HEADING SELECTED COURSE GPS IS SELECTED NAVIGATION SOURCE Figure 16-59. PFD AFCS Display The aircraft has two flight directors, each operating within the integrated avionics system. Only one flight director is active (selected) at a time. Flight directors can be switched by pressing the XFR key. Both PFDs display the selected flight director, indicated by an arrow pointing toward either the pilot or copilot side, in the center of the AFCS status box. The arrow for the selected flight director also appears beside the XFR key. When the flight directors are switched, the vertical and lateral modes revert to default (Figure 16-60). Table 16-11 relates each vertical mode to its respective corresponding controls and annunciations. The mode reference displays next to Revision 0 the active mode annunciation for altitude hold, vertical speed, and flight level change modes. The NOSE UP/DN wheel can be used to change the vertical mode reference while operating under pitch hold, vertical speed, or flight level change mode. The increments of change and acceptable ranges of values for each reference using the NOSE UP/DN wheel are listed in Table 16-11. Table 16-12 relates each lateral mode to its respective control and annunciation. The CWS button does not change lateral references for heading select, navigation, back course, or approach modes. The autopilot guides the air- FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-41 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL PILOT FLIGHT DIRECTOR SELECTED COPILOT FLIGHT DIRECTOR SELECTED Figure 16-60. Flight Director Selection Indications Table 16-11. AFCS STATUS ALERTS CONTROL PRESSED FLIGHT DIRECTOR ACTIVATED MODES SELECTED VERTICAL LATERAL FD key (pilot-side) Pilot-side Pitch hold (default) Roll hold (default) AP key Pilot-side Pitch hold (default) Roll hold (default) CWS button Pilot-side Pitch hold (default) Roll hold (default) GA switch Pilot-side Takeoff (on ground) Go–around (in air) Takeoff (on ground) Go around (in air) ALT key Pilot-side Altitude hold Roll hold (default) VS key Pilot-side Vertical speed Roll hold (default) VNV key Pilot-side Vertical path tracking* Roll hold (default) NAV key Pilot-side Pitch hold (default) Navigation** APR key Pilot-side Pitch hold (default) Approach** HDG key Pilot-side Pitch hold (default) Heading select * Valid VNV flight plan must be entered before VNV key press activates flight director. ** The selected navigation receiver must have a valid VOR or LOC signal or active GPS course before NAV or APR key press activates flight director. craft back to the selected heading/course upon release of the CWS button (Figure 16-60). trol. Autopilot controls the pitch and roll attitudes based on the flight director commands. The annunciations described in Table 16-13 (listed in order of increasing priority) can appear on the PFDs above the Airspeed and Attitude indicators. Only one annunciation can occur at a time, and messages are prioritized by criticality. The pitch autotrim provides trim commands to the pitch trim servo to relieve any sustained effort required by the pitch servo. Autopilot operation is independent of the yaw damper. The yaw damper reduces Dutch roll tendencies and coordinates turns. It can operate independently of the autopilot and can be used during normal hand-flight maneuvers. AUTOPILOT AND YAW DAMPER OPERATION The autopilot and yaw damper operate the flight control surface servos for automatic flight con- 16-42 Yaw rate commands are limited to 6º per second by the yaw damper. Flight pitch and roll commands to the servos are based on the active flight director modes. The yaw servo FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 16-12. FLIGHT DIRECTOR VERTICAL MODES VERTICAL MODE DESCRIPTION Pitch Hold Holds aircraft pitch attitude, can be used to climb/descend to the selected altitude CONTROL ANNUNCIATION REFERENCE REFERENCE RANGE CHANGE INCREMENT (default) PIT * ALTS ALT key ALT nnnnnFT VS key Selected Altitude Captures the selected altitude Capture Altitude Hold Vertical Speed Flight Level Change Vertical Path Tracking VNV Target Altitude Capture Glidepath Holds current altitude reference Holds aircraft vertical speed; can be used to climb/descend to the selected altitude Holds aircraft airspeed (in IAS or Mach) while aircraft climbs/ descends to the selected altitude Captures and tracks desent leg on active vertical profile TBD 0.5° VS nnnn FPM TBD 100 FPM FLC nnn KT TBD 1kt FLC M. Nnn TBD M 0.01 FLC key VNV key VPTH ** ALTV Captures the vertical navigation (VNV) target altitude Captures and tracks the WAAS glidepath on approach GP APR key Glide Slope Captures and tracks the ILS glide slope on approach Takeoff (on ground) Disengages the autopilot and commands constant pitch angle; wings level on the ground in preparation for takeoff Go–around (in air) Disengages the autopilot and commands constant pitch angle; wings level while in the air GS TO TBD GA TBD GA switch * ALTS is armed automatically when PIT, VS, FLC, TO, or GA is active, and under VPTH when the selected altitude is captured instead of the VNV target altitude. ** ALTV is armed automatically under VPTH when the VNV target altitude is captured instead of the selected altitude. provides yaw dampering. The servo motor control limits the maximum servo speed and torque. The servo mounts have slip clutches, which allow the pilot to override the servos in case of an emergency. Pressing the AP key activates the autopilot, yaw damper, and flight director (if not already active). The flight director engages in pitch and roll hold modes when initially activated. Pressing the YD key engages the yaw damper Revision 1 independently of the autopilot, if not already engaged. Autopilot and yaw damper status appear in the center of the AFCS status box. Engagement is indicated by green AP and YD annunciations (Figure 16-61). During autopilot operation, the aircraft can be hand-flown without disengaging the autopilot. Pressing and holding the CWS button disen- FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-43 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 16-13. FLIGHT DIRECTOR LATERAL MODES LATERAL MODE DESCRIPTION CONTROL ANNUNCIATION MAXIMUM ROLL COMMAND LIMIT Roll Hold Holds the current aircraft roll attitude or rolls the wings level, depending on the commanded bank angle (default) ROL TBD Low Bank Limits the maximum commanded roll angle BANK key * TBD Heading Select Captures and tracks the selected heading HDG key HDG TBD GPS TBD VOR TBD LOC TBD BC TBD GPS TBD VAPP TBD LOC TBD TO Wings level GA Wings level Navigation, GPS Arm/ Capture/Track Navigation, VOR Enroute Arm/Capture/Track Navigation, LOC ARM/Capture/ Track (no glide slope) Backcourse Arm/Capture/ Track Captures and tracks he selected navigation source (GPS, VOR, LOC) Captures and tracks a localizer signal for backcourse approaches NAV key BC key Approach, GPS Arm/ Capture/Track Approach, VOR Arm/ Capture/Track Approach, ILS Arm/Capture/ Track (Glide slope mode automatically armed) Takeoff (on ground) Go Around (in air) Captures and tracks the selected navigation source (GPS, VOR, LOC) Disengages the autopilot and commands a constant pitch angle and wings level on the ground in preparation for takeoff Disengages the autopilot and commands a constant pitch angle and wings level while in the air APR key GA switch * No annunciation appears in the AFCS status box. The acceptable bank angle range is indicated in green along the roll scale of the attitude indicator. AUTOPILOT ENGAGED YAW DAMPER ENGAGED Figure 16-61. Autopilot and Yaw Damper Engaged 16-44 gages the pitch and roll servos from the flight control surfaces and allows hand-flying of the aircraft. At the same time, the flight director synchronizes to the aircraft attitude during the maneuver. CWS activity has no effect on yaw damper engagement. A white CWS annunciation replaces the AP annunciation for the duration of CWS maneuvers (Figure 16-62). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL • Yaw damper failure while both are engaged CONTROL WHEEL STEERING • Stall warning (YD also disengages) Figure 16-62. CWS Annunciation To manually disengage the autopilot either push the AP key on the mode controller, the GA switch or the MEPT ARM switch. Manual autopilot disengagement is indicated by a 5 second flashing yellow AP annunciation and a 3 second autopilot disconnect aural alert (Figure 16-63). Figure 16-63. Manual Autopilot Disengagement Pressing either the AP DISC switch or the YD key manually disengages both the yaw damper and the autopilot. When the yaw damper and autopilot are manually disengaged, both the AP and YD annunications turn yellow and flash for 5 seconds and a 3 second autopilot disconnect aural alert is generated (Figure 16-64). Figure 16-64. Yaw Damper Disengagement Pressing either the MEPT ARM switch or the AP DISC switch cancels the autopilot disconnect aural alert. Pressing AP DISC also cancels the flashing AP annunciation. Automatic autopilot disengagement is indicated by a flashing red and white AP annunciation and by the autopilot disconnect aural alert. Both indications continue until acknowledged by pressing the AP DISC or MEPT ARM switch. Automatic autopilot disengagement occurs because of: • System failure • Invalid sensor data Revision 0 • Inability to compute default FD modes (FD also disengages automatically) Yaw damper disengagement is indicated by a 5-second flashing yellow YD annunciation (Figure 16-65). Figure 16-65. Automatic Autopilot and Yaw Damper Disengagement Automatic yaw damper disengagement occurs when autopilot disengagement is caused by failure in a parameter also affects the yaw damper. The yaw damper can remain operational in some cases where the autopilot automatically disengages. A localized failure in the yaw damper system or invalid sensor data also can causes yaw damper disengagement. HAZARD AVOIDANCE Hazard avoidance instruments aid situational awareness and provide advisory information with regard to potential hazards to flight safety associated with: • Weather GDL 69A XM ® satellite weather ° (Optional) GWX 68 ™ airborne color weather ° radar (Optional) STORMSCOPE ® WX-500 series ° L-3 II weather mapping sensor (Optional) • Terrain avoidance (TAWS) • Traffic ® KTA 870 traffic advi° Honeywell sory system (TAS) FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-45 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL XM SATELLITE WEATHER® The XM Satellite Weather ® data provides information for avoiding hazardous weather. Do not use XM weather information to penetrate hazardous weather. XM Satellite Weather ® is provided through the optional GDL 69A, a remote data-link satellite receiver. Graphical weather information and associated text is displayed on the MFD and on the PFD inset map. The GDL 69A can also receive XM Satellite Radio ® entertainment services. Both weather data and entertainment programming operate in the S-band frequency range to provide continuous reception capabilities at any altitude throughout North America. XM Satellite Radio ® services are subscription-based. For more information on specific service packages, visit: www.xmradio.com. The weather data link page in the map page group is the primary map for viewing XM weather data (Figure 16-66). The map page is the only map display capable of showing information for all available XM weather products. GMX 68™ Airborne Color Weather Radar The optional GMX 68 ™ , is a 4-color digital pulsed radar with 6.5 kilowatts of output power. It combines excellent range and adjustable scanning profiles with a high-definition target display. The pulse width is 4 microseconds on all ranges except the 2.5 nm range. The GWX 68™ uses a 1 microsecond pulse width at this range to reduce the target smearing on the display and for better target definition at close range. The aircraft uses a 12-inch, phased array antenna, fully stabilized to accommodate 30º of pitch and roll. To focus radar scanning on specific areas, sector scanning offers pilot-adjustable horizontal scan angles of 20º, 40º, 60º, or 90º. A vertical scanning function helps analyze storm tops, gradients, and cell buildup activity at various altitudes. Figure 16-66. Weather Data Link Page 16-46 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL The radar has the following features: MPEL BOUNDARY • Extended sensitivity time constant (STC) logic that automatically correlates distance of the return echo with intensity, so cells do not suddenly appear larger as they get closer. • Weather attenuated color highlight (WATCH ™ ) helps identify possible shadowing effects of short-range cell activity, identifying areas where radar return signals are weakened or attenuated by intense precipitation (or large areas of lesser precipitation) and cannot fully reflect the weather behind a storm. 11’ FOR 12” ANTENNA • Weather alert that looks ahead for intense cell activity in the 80–320 nm range, even if these ranges are not being monitored. MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE EXPOSURE LEVEL The maximum permissible exposure level is a zone in which the radiation level exceeds the US government standard of 1 mW/cm2. It is the semicircular area of at least 11 feet from the 12-inch antenna (Figure 16-67). All personnel must remain outside of this zone. With a scanning or rotating beam, the average power density at the MPEL boundary is significantly reduced. When evaluating various target returns on the weather radar display, the colors denote precipitation intensity and rates shown in Table 16-14. TERRAIN AWARENESS AND WARNING SYSTEM The TAWS increases situational awareness and aids in reducing controlled flight into terrain (CFIT). The TAWS provides visual and aural annunciations when terrain and obstacles are within the given altitude threshold from the aircraft. The displayed alerts and warnings are advisory only. TAWS satisfies TSO-C151b Class B requirements for certification. Class B TAWS is re- Revision 0 Figure 16-67. MPEL Boundary Table 16-14. PRECIPITATION INTENSITY LEVELS WEATHER MODE COLOR INTENSITY APPROXIMATE PRECIPITATION RATE (IN/HR.) BLACK <23 DBZ <.01. GREEN 23 DBZ TO <32 DBZ .01–0.1. YELLOW 32 DBZ TO <41 DBZ 0.1–0.5 RED 41 DBZ TO <50 DBZ 0.5–2 MAGENTA 50 DBZ AND GREATER >2 quired for all Part 91 aircraft operations with six or more passenger seats and for Part 135 turbine aircraft operations with six to nine passenger seats (FAR Parts 91.223, 135.154). For proper operation, TAWS requires a valid terrain/obstacle/airport terrain database and valid 3-D GPS position solution. TAWS uses yellow (caution) and red (warning) to depict terrain and obstacles with heights greater than 200 feet above ground level (AGL) relative to aircraft altitude (Figure 16-68 and Table 16-15). The colors adjust automatically as aircraft altitude changes and represent terrain, obstacles, and potential impact points. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-47 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Aircraft Altitude Terrain Above Aircraft Altitude 1000 Feet Threshold 1,000 Feet Figure 16-68. Terrain Altitude/Color Correlation for TAWS Table 16-15. TAWS OBSTACLE COLORS AND SYMBOLOGY LIGHTED OBSTACLE <1,000 ft AGL > 1,000 ft AGL < 1,000 ft AGL > 1,000 ft AG OBSTACLE SYMBOL UNLIGHTED OBSTACLE COLOR RED YELLOW BLACK Alerts are issued when flight conditions meet the parameters set within TAWS software. TAWS alerts typically use a CAUTION or a WARNING severity level, or both. When an alert is issued, visual annunciations are displayed and aural alerts are simultaneously issued. Table 16-16 shows TAWS alert types with corresponding annunciations and aural messages. 16-48 TERRAIN/ OBSTACLE LOCATION TERRAIN/OBSTACLE ABOVE OR WITHIN 100 FEET BELOW THE AIRCRAFT ALTITUDE TERRAIN/OBSTACLE BETWEEN 100 FEET AND 1,000 FEET BELOW THE AIRCRAFT ALTITUDE TERRAIN/OBSTACLE MORE THAN 1,000 FEET BELOW THE AIRCRAFT ALTITUDE TRAFFIC ADVISORY SYSTEM The traffic advisory system (TAS) aids in detection and avoidance of other aircraft. TAS uses an onboard interrogator-processor and the Mode S transponder for the air-to-air traffic data link. Traffic is displayed according to traffic collision avoidance system (TCAS) symbology using four different symbols (Table 16-17). FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 16-16. TAWS ALERTS SUMMARY ALERT TYPE PFD/MFD TAWS PAGE ANNUNCIATION EXCESSIVE DESCENT RATE WARNING (EDR) PULL UP PULL-UP REDUCED REQUIRED TERRAIN CLEARANCE WARNING (RTC) PULL UP TERRAIN - PULL-UP IMMINATE TERRAIN IMPACT WARNING (ITI) PULL UP MFD MAP PAGE POP-UP ALERT AURAL MESSAGE “PULL UP” OR * TERRAIN AHEAD - PULL-UP TERRAIN AHEAD - PULL-UP OR * TERRAIN - PULL-UP REDUCED REQUIRED OBSTACLE CLEARANCE WARNING (ROC) PULL UP IMMINENT OBSTACLE IMPACT WARNING (IOI) PULL UP “OBSTACLE, OBSTACLE; PULL UP, PULL UP”* OR “OBSTACLE AHEAD, PULL UP; OBSTACLE AHEAD, PULL UP” * “OBSTACLE AHEAD, PULL UP; OBSTACLE * AHEAD, PULL UP” “OBSTACLE, OBSTACLE; PULL UP, PULL UP” * “CAUTION, TERRAIN; CAUTION, TERRAIN”* OR “TERRAIN AHEAD; TERRAIN AHEAD” * “TERRAIN AHEAD; TERRAIN AHEAD”* OR “CAUTION, TERRAIN; CAUTION, TERRAIN” * “CAUTION, OBSTACLE; CAUTION, OBSTACLE”* OR “OBSTACLE AHEAD; OBSTACLE AHEAD” * CAUTION - OBSTACLE “OBSTACLE AHEAD; OBSTACLE AHEAD”* OR “CAUTION, OBSTACLE; CAUTION, OBSTACLE” TOO LOW - TERRAIN “TOO LOW, TERRAIN” NONE “FIVE HUNDRED” “SINK RATE” OBSTACLE AHEAD - PULL-UP OBSTACLE AHEAD - PULL-UP OR OBSTACLE - PULL-UP TERRAIN IMMINENT TERRAIN IMPACT CAUTION (ITI) TERRAIN CAUTION - TERRAIN OR TERRAIN AHEAD TERRAIN AHEAD OR CAUTION - TERRAIN REDUCED REQUIRED OBSTACLE CLEARANCE CAUTION (ROC) TERRAIN IMMINENT OBSTACLE IMPACT CAUTION (IOI) TERRAIN “TERRAIN AHEAD, PULL UP; TERRAIN AHEAD,* PULL UP” OR “TERRAIN, TERRAIN; PULL UP, PULL UP” * OBSTACLE - PULL-UP OR REDUCED REQUIRED TERRAIN CLEARANCE CAUTION (RTC) “TERRAIN, TERRAIN; PULL UP, PULL UP”* OR “TERRAIN AHEAD, PULL UP; TERRAIN AHEAD, PULL UP” CAUTION - OBSTACLE OR OBSTACLE AHEAD OBSTACLE AHEAD OR PREMATURE DESCENT ALERT CAUTION (PDA) TERRAIN ALTITUDE CALLOUT “500” NONE EXCESSIVE DESCENT RATE CAUTION (EDR) TERRAIN SINK RATE NEGATIVE CLIMB RATE CAUTION (NCR) TERRAIN DON’T SINK OR * TOO LOW - TERRAIN “DON’T SINK”* OR “TOO LOW, TERRAIN” *INDICATES THE DEFAULT CONFIGURATION Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-49 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 16-17. TAS SYMBOL DESCRIPTIONS TAS SYMBOL DESCRIPTION than ±1,200 feet relative altitude or the distance is beyond 5 nm. Proximity advisory—Indicates that the intruding aircraft is within ±1,200 feet and 5 nm range, but is not considered a threat. No threat traffic Proximity advisory (PA) Traffic advisory (TA)—Indicates potentially hazardous intruding aircraft. Closing rate, distance, and vertical separation meet TA criteria. Traffic advisory (TA) Traffic advisory off scale Nonthreat advisory (white diamond)— Indicates that an intruding aircraft is at greater OPERATING MODE Traffic advisory off scale—Appears as a half TA symbol at the relative bearing of the intruding aircraft. The traffic map page shows surrounding TAS traffic data relative to the aircraft current position and altitude, without base map clutter (Figure 16-69). TRAFFIC ADVISORY, AIRCRAFT IS 200 FEET BELOW AND CLIMBING TRAFFIC, OUT OF RANGE ALTITUDE MODE NON BEARING TRAFFIC (SYSTEM IS UNABLE TO DETERMINE BEARING), DISTANCE IS 8.0 NM, 1,100 FEET ABOVE AND DESCENDING PROXIMITY TRAFFIC, 1,000 FEET ABOVE AND DESCENDING Figure 16-69. Traffic Map Page 16-50 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Aircraft orientation is always heading up unless there is no valid heading. Map range is adjustable with the RANGE knob from 2 to 40 nm, as indicated by the map range rings. The traffic mode and altitude display mode appear in the upper left corner. LIMITATIONS Navigation using the avionics system is not authorized north of 70° North latitude or south of 70° South latitude because of unsuitable magnetic fields near the North Pole and South Pole. Additionally, operations are not authorized in the following two regions: • North of 65° North latitude between longitude 75° W and 120° W (Northern Canada). • South of 55° South latitude between longitude 120° E and 165° E (region south of Australia and New Zealand). For more information on limitations refer to the POH/AFM. STUCK MICROPHONE If the push-to-talk (PTT) key is stuck, the COM transmitter stops transmission after 35 seconds of continuous operation. An advisory alert appears on the PFD indicating that the microphone is stuck. The COM1 MIC or COM2 MIC key on the audio panel flashes as long as the PTT key remains stuck (Figure 16-70). Figure 16-70. Stuck Microphone Alert COM TUNING FAILURE If a tuning failure occurs in either COM radio, the radio automatically tunes to the emergency frequency (121.500 MHz). Depending on the failure mode, a red X can appear on the frequency display (Figure 16-71). PFD FAILURE EMERGENCY/ ABNORMAL Abnormal operation of the avionics system includes failure of the system components and associated equipment, including switches and external devices. If PFD1 fails, COM1 and NAV1 display a red X on both remaining displays. NAV1 is unavailable. COM1 automatically tunes 121.500 MHz, but the frequency is not shown. The COM1 emergency frequency is available to both the copilot and pilot (Figure 16-72). EMERGENCY CHANNEL LOADED AUTOMATICALLY Figure 16-71. COM Tuning Failure Figure 16-72. Frequency Section of PFD2 Display After PFD1 Failure Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-51 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL If PFD2 fails, COM2 and NAV2 display a red X on the remaining PFD display. NAV2 is unavailable. COM2 tunes 121.500 MHz, but the frequency is not shown (Figure 16-73). The COM2 emergency frequency is available to both the copilot and pilot. Figure 16-74. Display Backup Button Figure 16-73. PDF1 Display After PFD2 Failure AUDIO PANEL FAILURE If a failure occurs in the audio panel, a failsafe circuit connects the pilot headset and microphone directly to the COM1 transceiver. Audio is not available on the speaker during fail-safe operation. REVERSIONARY MODE The red DISPLAY BACKUP button selects the reversionary mode (Figure 17-74). FAILURE MODE EFFECTS FOR G1000® LRU FAILURES Table 16-18 describes the failure mode effects for the G1000 ® LRU failures. 16-52 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 16-18. FAILURE MODE EFFECTS FOR G1000® LRU FAILURES FAILURE EFFECT/INDICATION TO CREW PFD #1 Failure NOTE: If PFD #1 fails, PFD #2 is no longer connected to the HSDB. Therefore, the only data that is still valid on PFD #2 in this failure mode is GDC #2 data, GRS #2 data, and GDL69A data (if installed). NOTE: The Altair ADASd engine trend monitor (ETM) still gathers engine data throughout this failure mode. However, the failure prevents communication between the ETM and the displays. Therefore, no ETM–related messages are displayed to the crew, and no ETM– related inputs to the display are received by the ETM. MFD failure Revision 0 • MFD enters reversionary mode • GFC700 disconnects (abnormal disconnect tone) • If flight director #1 (FD #1) is engaged, yaw damper disconnects • PFD2 enters reversionary mode, but receives no engine, GPS, NAV, or COM data • Red–X of COM1 and NAV1 on MFD • Red–X of all COM and NAV on PFD2 • Red–X of XPDR1 on MFD (dual GTX installation only) • Red–X of all EIS on PFD2 • Red–X of XPDR1 on PFD2 • Red–X of XPDR2 on PFD2 (dual GTX installation only) • Red–X of clock on PFD2 • “NO COMP” annunciations for HDG, ROL, PIT, IAS, and ALT on PFD2 • “GDL69 FAIL–GDL 69 has failed” alert message on MFD (if installed) • “GWX FAIL–GWX is inoperative” alert message on PFD 2 (if installed) • “XTALK ERROR–A flight display crosstalk error has occurred” alert message on MFD and PFD2 • “XPDR1 FAIL–XPDR1 is inoperative” alert message on MFD (dual GTX Installation only) • “XPDR1 FAIL–XPDR1 is inoperative” alert message on PFD2 • “XPDR2 FAIL–XPDR2 is inoperative” alert message on PFD2 (dual GTX installation only) • “GMA1 FAIL–GMA1 is inoperative” alert message on PFD2 • “GPS NAV LOST–Loss of GPS navigation GPS fail” alert message on PFD2 • “LOI” on HSI for GPS on PFD2 • “RA FAIL” on MFD and PFD2 (if installed) • “IGNITION ON” alert displays regardless of igniter state • PFD1 enters reversionary mode • PFD2 enters reversionary mode • If FD #2 is selected, AP and YD disconnect (abnormal disconnect tone) • Red–X of COM2 and NAV2 on PFD1 • Red–X of COM2 and NAV2 on PFD2 • “XPDR2 FAIL–XPDR2 is inoperative” alert message on PFD1 and PFD2 (dual GTX installation only) • “XTALK ERROR–A flight display crosstalk error has occurred” alert message on PFD1 and PFD2 • “GWX FAIL–GWX is inoperative” alert message on PFD1 and PFD2 (if installed) • “BOTH ON GPS1” annunciation on PFD1 and PFD2 • Loss of traffic data (if installed) • Loss of Stormscope™ data (if installed) FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-53 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 16-18. FAILURE MODE EFFECTS FOR G1000® LRU FAILURES (cont) FAILURE EFFECT/INDICATION TO CREW PFD #2 failure • Loss of GDL69 data • If FD #2 is selected, AP disconnect (abnormal disconnect tone) • “GDL69 FAIL–GDL 69 has failed” alert message on PFD1 • “XTALK ERROR–A flight display crosstalk error has occurred” alert message on PFD1 GIA #1 failure • Red–X of COM1 and NAV1 on PFD1, PFD2, and MFD • “AHRS1 GPS–AHRS1 using backup GPS source” alert message on PFD • “AHRS2 GPS–AHRS2 not receiving backup GPS information” alert message on PFD • “AFCS” annunciator, AP disconnect, and YD disconnect (abnormal tone) FD #2 still functions • “BOTH ON GPS2” annunciation • “XPDR1 FAIL–XPDR1 is inoperative” alert message (dual GTX installation only) • “RA FAIL” (if radar altimeter installed) • “IGNITION ON” alert displays regardless of igniter state NOTE: The Altair ADASd ETM communicates with the G1000 through GIA #1. Therefore, the ETM is effectively failed in this case. GIA #2 failure • Red–X of COM2 and NAV2 on PFD1, PFD2, and MFD • “AFCS” annunciator, AP disconnect, and YD disconnect (abnormal tone) FD #1 still functions • “AHRS2 GPS–AHRS2 using backup GPS source” alert message on PFD • “AHRS1 GPS–AHRS1 not receiving backup GPS information” alert message on PFD • “BOTH ON GPS1” annunciation • “XPDR2 FAIL–XPDR2 is inoperative” alert message (dual GTX installation only) • Traffic fail (if installed) • Stormscope™ in fail (if installed) GDC1 failure • Red–X of OAT and TAS gauges on PFD 1 • Red–X of airspeed tape with “AIRSPEED FAIL” displayed on PFD 1 • Red–X of altitude tape with “ALTITUDE FAIL” displayed on PFD 1 •Red–X of VSI tape with “VERT SPEED FAIL” displayed on PFD 1 • “AHRS TAS–AHRS not receiving airspeed” alert message on PFD 1 • If airborne, PFD1 (and MFD if in reversionary mode) autoreverts to ADC2 data NOTE: The indications described occur on any display which has ADC 1 sensor selected (the standard configuration has ADC 1 selected on PFD 1. GDC2 failure NOTE: The indications described occur on any display which has ADC 2 sensor selected (the standard configuration has ADC 2 selected on PFD 2. 16-54 • Red–X of OAT and TAS gauges on PFD 2 • Red–X of airspeed tape with “AIRSPEED FAIL” displayed on PFD 2 • Red–X of altitude tape with “ALTITUDE FAIL” displayed on PFD 2 • Red–X of VSI tape with “VERT SPEED FAIL” displayed on PFD 2 • “AHRS TAS–AHRS not receiving airspeed” alert message on PFD 2 • If airborne, PFD2 autoreverts to ADC1 data FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 16-18. FAILURE MODE EFFECTS FOR G1000® LRU FAILURES (Cont) FAILURE EFFECT/INDICATION TO CREW GMA failure • “GMA1 FAIL–GMA1 is inoperative” alert message on PFD • No digital audio is available to the crew (fail-safe COM1 is available to pilot headset). GMU1 failure On PFD 1: • Red–X of HDG display • Removal of any bearing pointers from compass rose • OBS pointer parks at 12 o’clock • “HDG FAULT–A magnetometer fault has occurred” alert message on PFD • If airborne, PFD1 (and MFD, if in reversionary mode) autoreverts to AHRS 2 data NOTE: The indications described occur on any display which has AHRS 1 sensor selected (the standard configuration has AHRS 1 selected on PFD 1. GMU2 failure NOTE: The indications described occur on any display which has AHRS 2 sensor selected (the standard configuration has AHRS 2 selected on PFD 2. GEA failure NOTE: Though the Altair ADASd ETM has not failed, most engine parameters used by the ETM are supplied by the GEA and are therefore unavailable to the ETM. GTX failure Revision 0 On PFD 2: • Red–X of HDG display • Removal of any bearing pointers from compass rose • OBS pointer parks at 12 o’clock • “HDG FAULT–A magnetometer fault has occurred” alert message on PFD • If airborne, PFD2 autoreverts to AHRS 1 data Red–X of all EIS gauges The following alerts no longer display: • OIL PRESS LOW • VOLTAGE LOW • VOLTAGE HIGH • ENGINGE FIRE • RSVR FUEL LOW • BATTERY OVHT (if NiCad installed) • EMERG PWR LVR • A–ICE PRESS LOW (if TKS installed) • GENERATOR OVHT (if alert installed) • BETA (if alert installed) • DOOR UNLATCHED • FUEL BOOST ON • STBY PWR INOP • ALTNR OVHT (if alert installed) • FUEL PRESS LOW • STARTER ON • GENERATOR AMPS • CHIP DETECT • BATTERY HOT (if NiCad installed) • A–ICE PRESS HI (if TKS installed) • L FUEL LOW • R FUEL LOW • L–R FUEL LOW The following alerts have only partial functionality: • FUEL SELECT OFF • PROP DE–ICE (if installed) • “TRAFFIC FAIL–Traffic device has failed” alert message on PFD • Red–X with “XPDR FAIL” message on PFD FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-55 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 16-18. FAILURE MODE EFFECTS FOR G1000® LRU FAILURES (Cont) FAILURE EFFECT/INDICATION TO CREW GRS1 failure NOTE: The indications described can occur on any display which has AHRS 1 sensor selected (the standard configuration has AHRS 1 selected on PFD 1). On PFD 1: • Horizon background blackout • Red–x over HDG and “ATTITUDE FAIL” message on AI • Removal of any bearing pointers from compass rose • OBS pointer parks at 12 o’clock • If airborne, PFD1 (and MFD, if in reversionary mode) autoreverts to AHRS2 data GRS2 failure On PFD 2: • Horizon background blackout • Red–x over HDG and “ATTITUDE FAIL” message on AI • Removal of any bearing pointers from compass rose • OBS pointer parks at 12 o’clock • If airborne, PFD2 autoreverts to AHRS1 data NOTE: The indications described can occur on any display which has AHRS 2 sensor selected (the standard configuration has AHRS 2 selected on PFD 2). Loss of GPS signal • “AHRS GPS–AHRS not receiving backup GPS information” alert message on PFD • “AHRS GPS–AHRS not receiving any GPS information” alert message on PFD • “LOI” message appears on compass rose • Loss of GPS signal strength observed on AUX–GPS status page on MFD • Aircraft symbol drops off of MFD map • NRST waypoints all drop off of NRST page group • Removal of affected GPS CDI indication from compass rose Loss of VOR/LOC signal • Removal of affected VOR/LOC CDI indication from compass rose Loss of G/S signal • Removal of affected LOC CDI indication from compass rose • Removal of GS diamond • “NO GS” annunciation on GS scale 16-56 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL QUESTIONS 1. The two GDC 74A air data computers supply information to which instruments? A. Standby airspeed indicator, standby altimeter, and standby attitude indicator B. PFD attitude indicator and horizontal direction indicator C. PFD airspeed indicators, altimeters, and vertical speed indicators D. MFD XM weather information system 2. The BARO MIN setting on the PFD is: A. The height above ground level for the minimums of an approach B. The desired altitude at which the aircraft levels when climbing to a selected altitude C. The desired altitude at which the aircraft descends when reaching the minimums of an approach D. The decision height altitude or minimum descent altitude on an approach 3. If the pilot PFD fails, the MFD and copilot PFD: A. Automatically go into reversionary mode on both PFDs whether or not the reversionary button on the audio panel is pressed B. Automatically go into reversionary mode on the pilot PFD but not the copilot PFD C. Either reversionary button on the pilot or copilot audio panel must be pressed D. Are blank and the pilot must declare an emergency and land the aircraft immediately Revision 0 4. When the pilot chooses a lateral or vertical mode on the mode controller, the AFCS status box indicates: A. Green for standby and white for active B. Magenta for standby and white for active C. White for standby and green for active D. Both white for standby and for active 5. The CWS button on the control yoke: A. Momentarily disengages the autopilot, but leave the servos engaged B. Momentarily disengages the roll and pitch servos, but not the autopilot C. Disengages the yaw damper D. Discontinues the pitch mode of the autopilot 6. The PLAY key on the audio panel allows: A. Playback of the previously recorded 2-minute block of a received audio transmission B. Playback of the last audio transmission on the No. 2 NAV C. Receipt of the last PA request from the passengers D. Playback of the XM radio song that is being uploaded 7. While operating the GWX weather radar system on the ground, ensure that: A. The gain is calibrated properly B. The radar system has been tested C. The No. 2 COM is set to the ATIS D. No one is within 11 feet of the radar antenna if the weather is activated while on the ground FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 16-57 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 17 MISCELLANEOUS SYSTEMS CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................. 17-1 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................ 17-1 OXYGEN SYSTEM ............................................................................................................. 17-2 Description..................................................................................................................... 17-2 Components ................................................................................................................... 17-2 Controls and Indications................................................................................................ 17-2 Operation ....................................................................................................................... 17-2 Limitations ..................................................................................................................... 17-4 Emergency/Abnormal .................................................................................................... 17-4 QUESTIONS ......................................................................................................................... 17-5 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 17-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 17-1 OXYGEN OFF-ON Lever and OXYGEN Gauge ................................................. 17-2 17-2 Oxygen Duration Chart.......................................................................................... 17-3 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 17-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 17 MISCELLANEOUS SYSTEMS INTRODUCTION This chapter describes the components, controls, and indications for the oxygen system on the Cessna Caravan 208 G1000. GENERAL An oxygen system provides the supplementary oxygen necessary for continuous flight at high Revision 0 altitude or for use in the event smoke or other toxic/noxious fumes are detected in the cabin. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 17-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL OXYGEN SYSTEM DESCRIPTION Passenger models of the aircraft have a 117cubic foot oxygen bottle and 2, 10, or 17 oxygen ports, depending on the model. Cargo models have a 51-cubic foot oxygen bottle and two oxygen ports, with the option for the 116.95-cubic foot bottle. COMPONENTS Figure 17-1. OXYGEN OFF-ON Lever and OXYGEN Gauge Oxygen Cylinder Oxygen is supplied from a cylinder in the tail cone and is reduced from cylinder pressure to operating pressure by a regulator on the cylinder. A remote shutoff valve control lever in the overhead console above the pilot and front passenger seat controls an oxygen shutoff valve, which is part of the regulator assembly. Oxygen Outlets/Masks In the cargo models of the aircraft, two oxygen ports are in the cabin ceiling–one each outboard of the pilot and front passenger seats. In the passenger models, additional ports are adjacent to each aft passenger ventilating air outlet. The standard masks are partial rebreathing masks with vinyl hoses and flow indicators. The pilot mask has a microphone for using the radio when using the oxygen system. Oxygen Pressure Gauge The oxygen gauge has two colored arcs and a colored line to indicate oxygen pressure. The yellow arc indicates 0 to 300 psi. The green arc indicates 1,550 to 1,850 psi. The red line indicates 2,000 psi or greater. CONTROLS AND INDICATIONS Oxygen cylinder pressure is indicated by a pressure gauge on the overhead console, adjacent to the OXYGEN OFF-ON lever (Figure 17-1). 17-2 OPERATION Oxygen Duration In order to make optimum use of the aircraft and oxygen system, it is important that the pilot understand the capabilities of the system as well as the duration of the oxygen supply. The oxygen duration chart (Figure 17-2) is used to calculate the oxygen use time remaining in the system. The chart shown is for a 117 cubic-foot-capacity oxygen system. The pressure reading is taken from the gauge on the oxygen control panel in the cabin ceiling above the pilot. Locate the pressure on the left side of the chart, and then follow the line over to the right until the appropriate altitude line is encountered. From that point, follow the vertical line to the bottom of the chart, and then read the time in hours. For example, with an oxygen pressure reading of 1,100 psi at an altitude of 15,000 feet, the oxygen duration for one person is 9.5 hours. If more than one person is using oxygen, divide the time derived above by the number of persons using oxygen. Refer to the Pilot’s Operating Handbook and the FAA-Approved Aircraft Flight Manual (POH/AFM), Section 9 for more information about the oxygen system operation. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL (117 CUBIC FEET CAPACITY) NOTE: OXYGEN DURATION IN HOURS = TOTAL HOURS DURATION NUMBER OF PERSONS Figure 17-2. Oxygen Duration Chart Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 17-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL LIMITATIONS Refer to the POH/AFM for information about the limitations of this aircraft. EMERGENCY/ABNORMAL WARNING Do not permit smoking when using oxygen. Oil, grease, soap, lipstick, lip balm, and other fatty materials constitute a serious fire hazard when in contact with oxygen. Be sure hands and clothing are oil-free before handling oxygen equipment. Refer to the POH/AFM for information about emergency/abnormal procedures. 17-4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL QUESTIONS 1. The oxygen system controls are: A. In the overhead console. B. On the instrument panel. C. On the center console. D. On the left sidewall switch and CB panel. Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 17-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 18 MANEUVERS AND PROCEDURES CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................. 18-1 GENERAL ............................................................................................................................ 18-1 Cold Weather Operation ................................................................................................ 18-1 Flight Profiles ................................................................................................................ 18-2 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 18-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 18-1 Takeoff and Initial Climb ....................................................................................... 18-3 18-2 Takeoff—Engine Failure Immediately After Takeoff ............................................ 18-3 18-3 Balked Landing ...................................................................................................... 18-4 18-4 Landing Pattern ...................................................................................................... 18-5 18-5 Instrument Approach.............................................................................................. 18-6 18-6 Emergency Descent Procedures............................................................................. 18-7 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 18-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 18 MANEUVERS AND PROCEDURES INTRODUCTION This chapter provides information for performing maneuvers and procedures with the Cessna Caravan 208 G1000. Flight profiles are provided for normal takeoff and initial climb, engine failure immediately after takeoff, go-around, landing pattern, instrument approach, and emergency descent procedures. GENERAL Flight profiles offer outlines on power lever settings, propeller control settings, flap position, degrees of pitch, rate of climb, airspeed, trim, torque, weights, traffic patterns, rate of descent, and minimum descent altitude (MDA) or decision height (DH). The profiles are used in normal and emergency operating procedures. Actual in-flight procedures can differ due to aircraft Revision 0 configuration, weight, weather, traffic, ATC instructions, etc. Procedures are consistent with the Pilot Operating Handbook and Airplane Flight Manual (POH/AFM). If a conflict develops between these procedures and the POH/AFM, the POH/AFM procedures must be followed. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 18-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL COLD WEATHER OPERATION Give special consideration to operation of the aircraft fuel system during the winter or prior to any flight in cold temperatures. Proper preflight draining of the fuel system eliminates any free water accumulation. The use of an additive is required for anti-ice protection. Refer to Section 8 of the POH/AFM for information on proper use of additives. Cold weather often causes conditions that require special care during aircraft operation. Even small accumulations of frost, ice, or snow must be removed from the wing, tail, and all control surfaces to ensure satisfactory flight performance. Control surfaces must be free of any internal accumulation of ice or snow. Use an external preheater to reduce wear and abuse to the engine and the electrical system. Preheating lowers the viscosity of the oil trapped in the oil cooler prior to starting in extremely cold temperatures. Use an auxiliary power unit (APU) when ambient temperatures are below 0°F (–18°C). Proper engine warmup ensures that oil temperature is in the green arc (10–99°) prior to flight operations. If snow or slush covers the takeoff surface, allowance must be made for takeoff distances, which increase as the snow or slush depth increases. The depth and consistency of this cover can prevent takeoff in many instances. FLIGHT PROFILES The following pages depict typical flight and maneuver profiles (Figures 18-1 through 18-6). The flight profiles are not meant to replace established procedures but to provide a suggested safe method for pilots without established procedures. The power settings shown are approximate while the airspeeds are the minimum recommended. The distances and speeds shown are not intended to replace those found in the POH/AFM. Consult the POH/AFM prior to and during each flight for detailed information. 18-2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL AFTER TAKEOFF OBSTACLES CLEARED: 1. AIRSPEED 85 KIAS—FLAPS 10Ëš 2. AIRSPEED 95 KIAS—FLAPS 0Ëš 3. CRUISE CLIMB—110-120 KIAS ROTATE 1. ROTATE—70-75 KIAS INITIAL CLIMB 1. CLIMB SPEED—85-95 KIAS BRAKE RELEASE 1. BRAKES—APPLY 2. POWER—SET FOR TAKEOFF 3. ANNUNCIATIONS—CHECK 4. BRAKES—RELEASE BEFORE TAKEOFF 1. BEFORE TAKEOFF CHECKLIST— COMPLETE 2. WINGS FLAPS—20Ëš Figure 18-1. Takeoff and Initial Climb WHEN PILOT DUTIES PERMIT, COMPLETE THE APPROPRIATE CHECKLIST EMERGENCY ITEMS AT ROTATE SPEED SMOOTHLY ROTATE THE AIRCRAFT TO AN 8-10° NOSEUP ATTITUDE AIRSPEED—85 KIAS WITH 20° FLAPS LOSS OF ENGINE AFTER LIFTOFF Figure 18-2. Takeoff—Engine Failure Immediately After Takeoff Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 18-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL MAXIMUM THRUST SECONDARY CLIMB OBSTACLES CLEARED: 1. AIRSPEED 85 KIAS—FLAPS 10Ëš 2. AIRSPEED 95 KIAS—FLAPS 0Ëš 3. CRUISE CLIMB CHECKLIST— COMPLETE FINAL APPROACH INITIAL CLIMB 1. BEFORE LANDING CHECKLIST— COMPLETE 2. LANDING CHECKLIST— COMPLETE 1. POWER LEVER—ADVANCE FOR TAKEOFF POWER 2. PITCH—ROTATE NOSE SMOOTHLY TO 8Ëš-10Ëš NOSE UP 3. WING FLAPS—20Ëš 4. AIRSPEED—80 KIAS (MIN) 400' AGL (MIN) "GO-AROUND" AIRPORT Figure 18-3. Balked Landing 18-4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL WHEN CLEAR OF RUNWAY 1. AFTER LANDING CHECKLIST—COMPLETE LANDING ASSURED AND LINED UP WITH RUNWAY 1. AIRSPEED—80 KIAS 2. TORQUE—AS NEEDED TO MAINTAIN AIRSPEED 3. WING FLAPS—30Ëš 4. RETARD POWER LEVER TO IDLE DURING FLARE OR AT TOUCHDOWN PATTERN ENTRY 1. BEFORE LANDING CHECKLIST— COMPLETE 2. WING FLAPS—10Ëš 3. TORQUE—AS REQUIRED 4. AIRSPEED—120 KIAS OR BELOW ABEAM LANDING POINT 1. AIRSPEED—100 KIAS 2. TORQUE—AS REQUIRED 3. LANDING CHECKLIST—COMPLETE FINAL TURN 1. AIRSPEED—90 KIAS 2. TORQUE—AS NEEDED TO MAINTAIN AIRSPEED 3. WING FLAPS—20Ëš Figure 18-4. Landing Pattern Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 18-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL OUTSIDE IAF PROCEDURE TURN OUTBOUND 1. BEFORE LANDING CHECKLIST—COMPLETE 2. WING FLAPS—10Ëš 3. AIRSPEED—120 KIAS 1. TORQUE—AS REQUIRED FOR AIRSPEED CONTROL 2. WING FLAPS—10Ëš 3. AIRSPEED—120 KIAS PRIOR TO FIX 1. TORQUE—AS REQUIRED FOR AIRSPEED CONTROL 2. WING FLAPS—10Ëš 3. AIRSPEED—120 KIAS 4. LANDING CHECKLIST—COMPLETE AT THE FINAL FIX 1. TORQUE—AS REQUIRED FOR AIRSPEED CONTROL 2. WING FLAPS—10Ëš 3. AIRSPEED—120 KIAS LANDING ASSURED AND LINED UP WITH RUNWAY 1. TORQUE—AS REQUIRED FOR LANDING 2. WING FLAPS—CONSIDERED 3. AIRSPEED—80 KIAS NOTE: FINAL LANDING CONFIGURATION AND AIRSPEED SHOULD BE ESTABLISHED BEFORE FINAL APPROACH FIX PASSAGE, IF PROXIMITY OF THE FINAL APPROACH FIX TO THE AIRFIELD DICTATES. Figure 18-5. Instrument Approach 18-6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL INITIAL DESCENT 1. ATC TRANSPONDER CODE—7700 2. NOTIFY AIR TRAFFIC CONTROL 3. REQUEST ALTIMETER SETTING SMOOTH AIR: 1. SEATS, SEAT BELTS, SHOULDER HARNESSES—SECURE 2. POWER LEVEL—IDLE 3. PROPELLER CONTROL LEVER—MAX (FULL FORWARD) 4. WING FLAPS—10Ëš 5. AIRSPEED—175 KIAS LEVEL-OFF 1. AT 1,000' TO 2,000' ABOVE DESIRED ALTITUDE, INITIATE THE LEVEL OFF PROCEDURES 2. CRUISE CHECKLIST— COMPLETE (WHEN PILOT DUTIES PERMIT) ROUGH AIR: 1. SEATS, SEAT BELTS, SHOULDER HARNESSES—SECURE 2. POWER LEVER—IDLE 3. PROPELLER CONTROL LEVER—MAX (FULL FORWARD) 4. WING FLAPS—0Ëš 5. AIRSPEED—VA WEIGHTS AND AIRSPEEDS: 208 AND 208 CARGO MASTER 8,000 LB 150 KIAS 6,300 LB 134 KIAS 4,500 LB 115 KIAS 208B AND 208B SUPER CARGO MASTER 8,750 LB 148 KIAS 7,500 LB 137 KIAS 6,250 LB 125 KIAS 5,000 LB 112 KIAS Figure 18-6. Emergency Descent Procedures Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 18-7 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 19 WEIGHT AND BALANCE CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................. 19-1 DESCRIPTION ..................................................................................................................... 19-2 Terminology................................................................................................................... 19-2 Weight and Balance Computation Form ....................................................................... 19-3 Fuel Weight and Moment .............................................................................................. 19-3 Baggage/Cargo Loading ................................................................................................ 19-9 Passenger Seating Configuration................................................................................. 19-16 Weights ........................................................................................................................ 19-16 Center-of-Gravity Limits ............................................................................................. 19-20 Flight Load Factor Limits............................................................................................ 19-21 Sample Weight and Balance Problems........................................................................ 19-21 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 19-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 19-1 Center-of-Gravity Moment Envelope—208B........................................................ 19-6 19-2 Center-of-Gravity Limits—208B........................................................................... 19-7 19-3 Internal Cabin Loading Arrangement .................................................................... 19-9 19-4 Maximum Zone/Compartment Loading and Internal Cabin Dimensions........... 19-11 19-5 Cargo Partition Net .............................................................................................. 19-13 19-6 Typical Cargo Restraint Methods ........................................................................ 19-14 19-7 Cargo Pod Specifications .................................................................................... 19-15 19-8 Cargo Pod Loading Arrangement ........................................................................ 19-16 19-9 Cargo Door Opening Restraining Net ................................................................. 19-17 19-10 Cargo Tiedown Attachments................................................................................ 19-18 19-11 Optional Seating Arrangements (208B Passenger Version) ................................ 19-19 TABLES Table Title Page 19-1 Aircraft Weight Limitations ................................................................................... 19-2 19-2 Weight and Balance Record (Loading Manifest) .................................................. 19-4 19-3 Fuel JP 6.7 LBS/Gal at 60°F ................................................................................. 19-5 19-4 Fuel AV Gas 6.0 LBS/Gal at 60°F......................................................................... 19-8 19-5 Maximum Certified Weights................................................................................ 19-20 19-6 Standard Aircraft Weights.................................................................................... 19-20 19-7 Specific Loading .................................................................................................. 19-20 19-8 Loading Table—208B.......................................................................................... 19-21 19-9 Weight and Balance Computation—208B........................................................... 19-22 19-10 Revised Weight and Balance Computation—208B............................................. 19-22 19-11 Landing Weight and Balance Computation—208B ............................................ 19-22 Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 19-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 19 WEIGHT AND BALANCE INTRODUCTION This chapter describes the weight and balance information for the Cessna Caravan 208 G1000 aircraft. Information includes common terminology, applicable forms, tables, and graphs used in determining that the aircraft meets the manufacturer’s weight and center-of-gravity (CG) limitations. Each section includes a sample of the charts and graphs and their use. Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 19-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL DESCRIPTION cruise, and landing performance also are adversely affected. This section describes how to ensure that the aircraft is operated within its weight and CG limitations. Two methods for determining weight and balance are shown: the Weight and Balance Computation Form and the Loading Manifest. In order to achieve its performance and flight characteristics, the aircraft must be flown within the approved weight and CG limits. Although the aircraft offers flexibility of loading, it cannot be flown with normal crew, full fuel tanks, and both cabin and cargo pod loading zones filled to maximum capacity. Use the loading flexibility to ensure that the aircraft does not exceed its maximum weight limits and is loaded within the CG range before takeoff (Table 19-1). Routinely determine the balance of the aircraft since it is possible to be within the maximum weight limits and still exceed the CG limits. An aircraft loading that exceeds the forward CG limit can place heavy loads on the nosewheel and cause the aircraft to be more difficult to rotate for takeoff or flare during landing. If the CG is too far aft, the aircraft can rotate prematurely on takeoff, depending upon trim settings. A properly loaded aircraft performs as intended. Before the aircraft is licensed, a basic empty weight, CG, and moment, are computed. Specific information about the weight, arm, moment, and installed equipment for a particular aircraft as delivered from the factory can be found in the plastic envelope in the back of the Pilot’s Operating Handbook and Airplane Flight Manual (POH/AFM). Table 19-1. AIRCRAFT WEIGHT LIMITATIONS 208B Maximum Ramp Weight 8,785 Maximum Takeoff Weight 8,750 Maximum Weight–Icing Cargo Pod 8,550 Maximum Weight–Icing Cargo Pod Removed 8,750 Maximum Landing Weight 8,500 Weight is the basis for numerous flight and structural characteristics. Flights at excess weight are possible and can be within the performance capability of the aircraft, but loads for which the aircraft was not designed can be imposed on the structure, especially during landing. Flight at weights over the maximum takeoff weight can be a contributing factor in an accident, especially when combined with other factors such as temperature, field elevations, and runway conditions. As weight increases, takeoff speed and stall speeds increase. During takeoff, the rate of acceleration decreases and the required takeoff distance increases. Climb, 19-2 WARNING It is the pilot responsibility to ensure that the aircraft is loaded properly. Operations outside of prescribed weight and balance limitations can result in an accident and serious or fatal injury. TERMINOLOGY Arm—Horizontal distance from the reference datum to the CG of an item. Basic empty weight—Standard empty weight plus the weight of optional equipment. CG—Point at which an aircraft balances if suspended. Its distance from the reference datum is found by dividing the total moment by the total weight of the aircraft. CG arm—Arm obtained by adding the aircraft individual moments and dividing the sum by the total weight. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CG limits—Extreme CG locations within which the aircraft must be operated at a given weight. Mean aerodynamic chord (MAC)—MAC of a wing is the chord of an imaginary airfoil, which throughout the flight range has the same force vectors as those of the wing. Maximum landing weight—Maximum weight approved for the landing touchdown. Maximum ramp weight—Maximum weight approved for ground maneuver. It includes the weight of start, taxi, and runup fuel. Cessna Weight and Balance Computation form (Table 19-2). • Enter the basic empty weight and moment from the most current line of the weight and balance record. • Record the total amount of fuel in pounds on the aircraft and determine the moment by reading directly from Table 19-3. • List the weight of the pilot, flight case, passengers, and cargo, including cargo pod, if installed. Determine the moment, per thousand, from Table 19-4 for each weight. Maximum takeoff weight—Maximum weight approved for the start of the takeoff roll. • Total all weights and moments, and then divide that sum by1,000. The new value must not exceed the maximum ramp weight of the aircraft. Moment—Product of the weight of an item multiplied by its arm. (Moment divided by the constant 1,000 is used in the POH to simplify balance calculations by reducing the number of digits.) • Allowing 35 pounds of fuel for taxiing, calculate the weight and balance for takeoff. This value must not exceed the maximum takeoff weight and the moment must fall within the CG envelope (Figures 19-1 and 19-2). Reference datum—Imaginary vertical plane 100 inches forward of the front face of the firewall. Standard empty weight—Weight of a standard aircraft including unusable fuel, full operating fluids, and full engine oil. Station—Location along the aircraft fuselage given in terms of the distance from the reference datum. Tare—Weight of chocks, blocks, stands, etc. used when weighing an aircraft, and is included in the scale readings. Tare is deducted from the scale reading to obtain the actual (net) aircraft weight. WEIGHT AND BALANCE COMPUTATION FORM The following information can help ensure operation of the aircraft within the prescribed weight and CG limitations when using the Revision 1 • Using the appropriate performance charts from Section 5 of the approved POH, determine the fuel burn for the proposed trip. Then deduct the weight of fuel burned from the takeoff weight and moment figures and verify that the landing weight and CG are within the limits. FUEL WEIGHT AND MOMENT Information on the fuel weight and moment tables in the POH and Table 19-3 are based on average fuel density at a fuel temperature of 60°F (15°C). However, fuel weight increases approximately 0.1 pounds per gallon (ppg) for each 25°F decrease in fuel temperature. Therefore, when environmental conditions are such that the fuel temperature is different from that shown in the chart headings, a new fuel weight calculation is to be made using the 0.1 ppg increase in fuel for each 25°F decrease in fuel temperature. For example, on the table for Jet A fuel, the weight is based on fuel having an average density of 6.7 ppg. For this example, assume that the tanks are completely filled and the fuel tem- FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 19-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 19-2. WEIGHT AND BALANCE RECORD (LOADING MANIFEST) 19-4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 19-3. FUEL JP 6.7 LBS/GAL AT 60°F Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 19-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Figure 19-1. Center-of-Gravity Moment Envelope—208B 19-6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Figure 19-2. Center-of-Gravity Limits—208B Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 19-7 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 19-4. FUEL AV GAS 6.0 LBS/GAL AT 60°F 19-8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL perature is at 35°F, which is 25°F below the 60°F on which the chart is based. X (revised weight) In order to calculate the increase in fuel weight, the following procedure must be used: 453.3 (average moment) 2,224 (average weight) X = (432.3 2257.6) X = 460.1 divided by 2,224 • With a full load of 332 gallons, the chart indicates a weight of 2,224 pounds. To find the actual weight at a fuel temperature of 35°F, use the following formula: Revised fuel weight = 332 (6.7 0.1 lb/gal) = 332 6.8 lb/gal = 2,257.6 lb • The resulting fuel weight increase due to lower fuel temperature is 33.6 pounds over the 2,224 pounds shown on the chart, which might be significant in an actual loading situation. • Next, calculate the revised fuel moment. The revised fuel moment is directly proportional to the revised fuel weight. = 2,257.6 (revised weight) • A value of 460 is the moment/1,000 of the fuel load. Enter this figure on the appropriate line of the weight and balance computation form or loading manifest. BAGGAGE/CARGO LOADING To facilitate carriage of large or bulky items, all aft seats (passenger version only) and the front passenger seat can be removed from the aircraft (Figure 19-3). If a cargo barrier and its three barrier nets are available, removal of the front passenger seat can be unacceptable. Figure 19-3. Internal Cabin Loading Arrangement Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 19-9 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL If seats are removed for hauling cargo and the cargo barrier and its nets added, then adjust the basic empty weight and CG moment of the aircraft so that these values accurately represent the weight and moment of the aircraft before loading. With all seats except the pilot seat removed, a large cabin volume is available for baggage/cargo. If the aircraft has a cargo barrier, the total volume available for cargo behind the barrier is 340 cubic feet. Cargo can be loaded through the large, almost square, two-piece cargo door. The floor is flat from the firewall at fuselage station 100.00, except in the rudder pedal area, to the aft side of the cargo door (station 332.00), and has a 200lb/square-foot allowable loading. Between station 332.00 and 356.00, additional cargo space with a capacity of 320 lbs is provided on a floorboard raised approximately 5 inches above the main floor. Plywood flooring is in the cargo area for ease of loading and distribution of concentrated loads. In the area of the removed front passenger seat, tie-down blocks can clamp to seat tracks from station 125.00 to 159.98 to serve as tiedown attachment points. From station 158 aft to the raised cargo floor, the seat tracks receive quick-release tiedown fasteners, which can be snapped into the tracks at 1-inch intervals. The raised cargo floor contains eight anchor plates to which quick-release tiedown fittings can be attached. Only rope, cable, or other fittings rated at a minimum of 2,100 pounds are to be used for tie-downs. Double-stud quick-release tie-downs require a 3,150 pound rating. Exercise caution while loading or unloading heavy cargo through the cargo doors. An ideal loading in every other respect can still cause tail tipping and structural damage if proper weight distribution is ignored. For example, heavy cargo loaded through the doors and placed momentarily in zones 4 and 5, plus the weight of personnel required to move it to a forward zone, could cause an out-of-balance condition during loading. Loading Zones The sidewalls in the cargo area are marked with vertical lines for identification of the six loading zones. The marks between the lines identify each zone by number and display the maximum load that can be carried within the zones. Refer to the table in Figure 19-4 for maximum zone weight limits. The maximum load values marked in each zone are based on all cargo being tied down within the zones. A horizontal line, labeled 75%, is marked along each sidewall as a loading reference. As indicated on a placard on the lower cargo door, zones forward of the last loaded zones must be at least 75% full by volume. Whenever possible, load each zone to its maximum available volume before loading the next zone. A cautionary placard on the right sidewall between zones 5 and 6 indicates that if zone 5 load exceeds 400 pounds, then either a cargo partition net is required aft of the load or the load must be secured to the floor. Cargo Nets CAUTION The maximum load value marked in each zone is based on all cargo being tied down within the zones. 19-10 CAUTION A cargo barrier and three barrier nets are directly behind the pilot and front passenger seats (see Figure 19-5). The barrier and nets prevent loose cargo from moving into the pilot and front passenger stations during abrupt deceleration. The barrier consists of a U-shaped assembly of honeycomb com- FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Figure 19-4. Maximum Zone/Compartment Loading and Internal Cabin Dimensions Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 19-11 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL posite construction. The assembly attaches to the four pilot and front passenger seat rails at station 153.00 and to the cabin top at station 166.00. The cargo barrier net consists of one net for the left sidewall, one for the right sidewall, and one for the center. The left and right nets cover the space between the barrier assembly and the aircraft sidewalls. The side nets fasten to the aircraft sidewalls and the edge of the barrier with six quick release fasteners each, three on each side. The center net covers the opening in the top center of the barrier. The center net fastens with four fasteners, two on each side. Horizontal lines, labeled 75%, are marked on the aft side of the cargo barrier. Placards above the horizontal lines caution that the maximum allowable load behind the barrier is 3,400 pounds.The zones forward of the last zone must be at least 75% full by volume. The load must be tied down if the zones are not at least 75% full. Refer to Figure 19-3 for maximum zone loadings. CAUTION The cargo barrier and its attached nets provide cargo forward crash load restraint to protect the pilot and front passenger. However, the cargo must be secured to prevent load shifting during takeoff, flight, landing, and taxi acceleration and deceleration. Secure the barrier net fasteners for takeoff, landing, and in-flight operations. Detach the fasteners only to move the nets for cargo loading and unloading through the crew area. Cargo partition nets can be installed at five locations to divide the cargo area into compartments. Three partition nets can be installed at stations 188.7, 246.8, 282.0, 307.0, and 332.0. 19-12 The canvas partitions have nylon webbing reinforcement straps crisscrossing at the partition for added strength. The straps have quick-release fasteners, which attach to the floor tracks, two floor-mounted anchor plates just forward of the raised cargo floor, and other anchor plates on the sidewalls and ceiling. Four straps have adjustable buckles for tightening the straps during installation of the partition (Figure 19-5). Zones Zones divided by cargo partitions can be loaded without additional tiedowns if the total loaded density for each partitioned zone does not exceed 7.9 pounds per cubic foot and if the zone is more than 75% full. Cargo loading that does not meet these requirements must be secured to the cabin floor (Figure 19-6). • The maximum cargo partition load is the sum of any two zones. No more than two adjacent zones can be divided by one partition. The partitions prevent the cargo from shifting forward and aft in flight. The partitions are not adequate to withstand crash loads and do not replace the need for a cargo barrier. The aircraft may be equipped with a cargo pod. The cargo pod has compartments A, B, C, and D, and holds a maximum weight of 1,090 pounds (Figure 19-7). The cargo pod zones are separated by bulkheads. The cargo pod floor has a maximum floor loading of 30 per square foot. Each compartment has a loading door on the left side of the pod. Each door has two latches and hinges at the bottom. Rotating the latch handles horizontally secures the doors. Figure 19-8 illustrates the cargo pod loading arrangements. Cargo Restraints A restraining net inside and over the cargo door opening prevents loose items from falling out of the cargo door when the doors open. The two halves of the net part in the center of FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL SIDEWALL AND CEILING ANCHOR PLATE (TYPICAL) QUICK-RELEASE FASTENER PARTITION REINFORCEMENT CARGO PARTITION NETS (TYPICAL) ADJUSTABLE BUCKLE STA. 246.8 STA. 188.7 STA. 307 STA. 282 STA. 332 QUICK-RELEASE FASTENER FLOOR-MOUNTED ANCHOR ANCHOR PLATE FORWARD OF RAISED CARGO FLOOR PARTITION REINFORCEMENT QUICK-RELEASE FASTENER FLOOR TRACK SECTION (TYPICAL) NOTES: 1. PARTITION NETS ARE AVAILABLE FOR INSTALLATION AT STATION 188.7, 246.8, 282.0, 307.0, AND 332.0. 2. IF PARTITION IS USED, THEY MUST BE IN CONJUNCTION WITH THE CARGO BARRIER. SINCE PARTITION ARE NOT DESIGNED TO WITHSTAND CRASH LOADS, THEY CANNOT BE CONSIDERED A REPLACEMENT FOR THE BARRIER. 3. EACH PARTITION WILL WITHSTAND THE FORWARD AND AFT OPERATIONAL LOADS APPLIED DURING TAKEOFF, FLIGHT, AND LANDING BY ANY TWO (2) ZONES FORWARD OR AFT OF THE PARTITION. USE OF THE PARTITION ALLOWS LOADING OF THE ZONES WITHOUT TYING DOWN THE CARGO IF THE LOAD DENSITY IS NO MORE THAN 75% FULL. CARGO LOADING THAT DOES NOT MEET THESE REQUIREMENTS MUST BE SECURED TO THE CABIN FLOOR. Figure 19-5. Cargo Partition Net Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 19-13 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CARGO IMPROPERLY TIED– SHIFTS OCCUR CARGO PROPERLY TIED– NO SHIFTS OCCUR MULTIPLE FORCES SECURED BY FEWER STRAPS UPWARD CARGO RESTRAINT CYLINDRICAL CARGO TIE DOWN PROPER TIE-DOWN FOR ALL FORCES Figure 19-6. Typical Cargo Restraint Methods the door opening. The front and rear halves slide fore and aft on a rod to open the net. The net attaches to the sidewall with screws and nutplates on the front and rear edges of the net. When the net is closed, the two halves are held together by snaps (Figure 19-9). Cargo restraint prevents cargo shift in five directions: forward, aft, vertical, left, and right. cargo shifts occur during acceleration or deceleration during takeoffs and landings and inflight during encounters with air turbulence. Correct cargo restraint provides the proper relationship among aircraft configuration (with or without the barrier), cargo weight, and the required restraint. Restraint is required for flight, landing, and taxi loads, and for crash loads. Cargo must be tied down for flight, landing, and taxi load restraint, and/or crash load restraint. Figure 19-10 illustrates the use of cargo tiedown attachments. Cargo partition nets can divide the cabin cargo area into com- 19-14 partments. If partitions are used, they must be used in conjunction with the cargo barrier. Partitions are not designed to withstand crash loads and cannot be considered a replacement for the barrier. Each partition withstands the forward and aft operational loads applied during takeoff, flight, and landing by any two zones forward or aft of the partition. The partitions allow loading of the zones without tying down cargo if the load density is no more than 7.9 pounds per cubic foot and the zone is more than 75% full. Cargo loads that do not meet these requirements must be secured to the cabin floor. Refer to Figure 19-6 for diagrams of typical cargo tie-down methods. Cargo of a piercing or penetrating nature is to be loaded such that the barrier/nets, partitions, rear wall, and other cargo provide a buffer between such cargo and the rest of the cargo space. The density of the buffering cargo is to be sufficient to restrain piercing or penetrating items from passing through the barrier/nets, parti- FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CARGO POD HEIGHT MEASUREMENT FORWARD DOOR FORWARD CENTER DOOR AFT CENTER DOOR AFT DOOR 7 1/4" 19 1/2" STATION 100 19 1/2" 154.75 19 1/2" 209.35 19 1/2" 14" 257.35 332 DOOR OPENING DIMENSIONS NOTES: 1. HEIGHT DIMENSIONS ARE APPROXIMATE AND MEASURED AT FUSELAGE STATION SHOWN FROM BOTTOM OF FUSELAGE TO INSIDE FLOOR. 2. WIDTH DIMENSIONS ARE APPROXIMATE AND MEASURED AT FUSELAGE STATION SHOWN AND ON WATERLINE 68.00 INSIDE POD. WIDTH HEIGHT (FRONT) HEIGHT (MID) HEIGHT (REAR) FORWARD DOOR 27 1/2" --- 14 1/2" --- FWD. CTR. DOOR 30 1/2" --- 15 1/4" --- AFT CTR. DOOR 27 1/2" --- 14 1/2" --- AFT DOOR 30 1/2" 13 1/2" --- 8 1/2" CARGO POD WIDTH MEASUREMENTS COMPARTMENT BULKHEADS 44'' 51'' 120 140 100 COMPARTMENT BULKHEADS 50'' 49'' 160 180 200 220 240 154.75 209.35 47'' 41 3/4'' 260 280 300 320 340 360 257.35 332 CARGO POD DOOR MARKINGS FWD. COMPARTMENT MAX. WEIGHT 230 LBS. CTR. COMPARTMENT – FWD MAX. WEIGHT 310 LBS. CTR. COMPARTMENT – AFT MAX. WEIGHT 270 LBS. AFT COMPARTMENT MAX. WEIGHT 280 LBS. MAX. FLOOR LOADING 30 LBS. PER SQ. FT. MAX. FLOOR LOADING 30 LBS. PER SQ. FT. MAX. FLOOR LOADING 30 LBS. PER SQ. FT. MAX. FLOOR LOADING 30 LBS. PER SQ. FT. NO SHARP EDGES NO SHARP EDGES NO SHARP EDGES NO SHARP EDGES Figure 19-7. Cargo Pod Specifications Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 19-15 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 100 * 132.4 C.G. ARM STATION (C.G. ARM) ZONE A ZONE A * 182.1 * 233.4 B 100 ZONE B 154.75 ZONE C 209.35 ZONE D 257.35 332 C * CARGO AREA CENTER OF GRAVITY IN ZONES A, B, C, AND D. * 287.6 D NOTE: COMPARTMENT BULKHEADS SEPARATING ZONES A AND B (STATION 154.75), ZONES B AND C (STATION 209.35), AND ZONES C AND D (STATION 257.35) CAN BE USED AS A REFERENCE POINT FOR DETERMINING THE LOCATION OF CARGO FUSELAGE STATION. Figure 19-8. Cargo Pod Loading Arrangement tions, and rear wall under critical emergency landing conditions. If cargo of a piercing or penetrating nature cannot be loaded as described above, then it must be tied down. on training subject matter, location references for this information, and guidelines for safe transport of hazardous materials are in the aircraft Cargo Loading Manual. Special aircraft protection and personnel training are key considerations in transporting approved hazardous materials. PASSENGER SEATING CONFIGURATION The fuselage bilge area under the cargo compartment from stations 168 to 356 is designed for transport of hazardous materials, which can be carried in any location within this area. The aircraft offers flexibility in seat arrangements (Figure 19-11). In addition to the pilot-in-command and flight crew (if used), other personnel such as cargo receiving and loading personnel are to be properly trained on accepting, handling, storing, loading, and unloading hazardous materials if such materials are transported. Maximum Certified Weights WEIGHTS Refer to Table 19-5. Standard Aircraft Weights Refer to Table 19-6. Information and regulations on air transport of hazardous materials is outlined in the Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 49 and the International Civil Aviation Organization (ICAO) Technical Instructions for the Safe Transport of Dangerous Goods by Air. Details 19-16 Specific Loading Refer to Table 19-7. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NOTES: 1. RESTRAINING NET INSTALLED INSIDE OF AIRCRAFT OVER CARGO DOOR OPENING. 2. NET HALVES MUST BE PULLED CLOSED AND SNAPPED TOGETHER TO PREVENT ARTICLES FROM FALLING OUT OF DOOR OPENING WHEN CARGO DOORS ARE OPENED. NET SUPPORT ROD FRONT HALF OF RESTRAINING NET REAR HALF OF RESTRAINING NET SNAP-TYPE FASTENER (TYPICAL) Figure 19-9. Cargo Door Opening Restraining Net Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 19-17 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Figure 19-10. Cargo Tiedown Attachments 19-18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 19-19 Figure 19-11. Optional Seating Arrangements (208B Passenger Version) CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 19-5. MAXIMUM CERTIFIED WEIGHTS Table 19-6. STANDARD AIRCRAFT WEIGHTS 208 208B AND 208B SUPER CARGO MASTER STANDARD EMPTY WEIGHT 3,835 lb 4,570 lb MAXIMUM USEFUL LOAD 4,200 lb 4,215 lb Table 19-7. SPECIFIC LOADING WING LOADING POWER LOADING 208 208B AND 208B SUPER CARGO MASTER 28.6 LB./SQ. FT. 31.3 LB./SQ. FT. 13.3 LB/SHP. 14.6 LB./SHP. CENTER-OF-GRAVITY LIMITS Model 208 Center of gravity range: • MAC—The leading edge of the MAC is 157.57 inches aft of the datum. The MAC length is 66.40 inches. 19-20 • Forward—162.41 inches (7.29% MAC) aft of datum at 4,200 pounds or less with straight line variations to 174.06 inches (24.83% MAC) aft of datum at 8,000 pounds. • Aft—184.25 inches (40.33% MAC) aft of datum at all weights up to 8,000 pounds. • Reference datum—100 inches forward of front face of firewall. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Model 208B Table 19-8. LOADING TABLE—208B Center of gravity range: • MAC—The leading edge of the MAC is 177.57 inches aft of the datum. The MAC length is 66.40 inches. • Forward—179.60 inches (3.06% MAC) aft of datum at 5,500 pounds or less, with straight line variation to 193.37 inches (23.80% MAC) aft of datum at 8,000 pounds and straight line variation to 199.15 inches (32.50% MAC) aft of datum at 8,750 pounds. • Aft—204.35 inches (40.33% MAC) aft of datum at all weights up to 8,750 pounds. • Reference datum—100 inches forward of front face of firewall. FLIGHT LOAD FACTOR LIMITS Flight load factors: • Flaps up .......................... +3.8 g–1.52 g • Flaps down (all settings) ........... +2.4 g NOTE The design load factors are 150% of the above. In all cases, the structure meets or exceeds design loads. SAMPLE WEIGHT AND BALANCE PROBLEMS A sample weight and balance is used for the 208B. The flight is a continuation of the performance problem earlier in this chapter. The 208B sample problem also is a continuation of the earlier performance problem. In each problem, the 208B has a cargo pod and is loaded according to Table 19-8. Revision 0 208B ITEM PILOT AND FRONT PASSENGER PASSENGER 3 PASSENGERS 4 AND 5 PASSENGER 6 PASSENGERS 7 AND 8 PASSENGERS 9 AND 10 PASSENGER 11 CABIN ZONE 6 CARGO POD ZONE A CARGO POD ZONE B CARGO POD ZONE C CARGO POD ZONE D FUEL WEIGHT WEIGHT 400 200 400 200 400 400 200 320 230 202 200 200 858 By referring to the weight and moment charts (refer to the POH/AFM) and entering the appropriate moment on the weight and balance computation form, the aircraft weight and CG can be determined as follows: • The CG envelope in Figures 19-1 and 192 indicates that the sample loading in Table 19-9 for the 208B falls outside of the approved flight envelope. Therefore, weight has to be moved from cargo pod zone A to pod zones B and C in order to shift the CG. Since no weight is removed or added, compute the difference in the moments of the weights when the cargo is moved to a different zone. Also, because of the maximum weight limits for zones B and C, only 150 pounds can be removed from zone A (70 pounds in zone B, and 80 pounds in zone C) (Table 19-10). • When the CG envelope is consulted, the revised moment at 8,750 pounds takeoff weight falls within the envelope, thus the aircraft is legal for takeoff. • A landing weight and balance is computed in Table 19-11. The fuel used must be subtracted from the weight of the aircraft, along with the moment of the fuel burned. FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 19-21 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL Table 19-9. WEIGHT AND BALANCE COMPUTATION—208B 208B ITEM AIRCRAFT EMPTY WEIGHT FUEL LOAD PILOT AND FRONT PASSENGER PASSENGER 3 PASSENGERS 4 AND 5 PASSENGER 6 PASSENGERS 7 AND 8 PASSENGERS 9 AND 10 PASSENGER 11 CARGO ZONE 6 CARGO POD ZONE A CARGO POD ZONE B CARGO POD ZONE C CARGO POD ZONE D RAMP WEIGHT TAXI FUEL TAKEOFF WEIGHT WT MOM/1000 4575 858 400 200 400 200 400 400 200 320 230 202 200 200 8,785 –35 8,750 846.5 174.4 54.2 19.0 69.6 45.2 84.0 98.4 52.4 110.1 30.5 36.8 46.7 57.5 1,729.3 –7.2 1,722.1 Table 19-10. REVISED WEIGHT AND BALANCE COMPUTATION— 208B TAKEOFF MOMENT REMOVAL OF 150 LBS IN ZONE A ADDITION OF 70 LBS IN ZONE B ADDITION OF 80 LBS IN ZONE C REVISED TAKEOFF MOMENT 1,722.1 –19.8 16.3 23.0 1,741.6 Table 19-11. LANDING WEIGHT AND BALANCE COMPUTATION—208B 208B TAKEOFF WEIGHT FUEL USED DURING FLIGHT LANDING WEIGHT 8,750 –306 8,444 1,722.1 61.8 1,679.8 By examining the weight and balance chart, the intersection between weight and moment axis indicates that the landing weight and moment are within the CG envelope. 19-22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 The information normally contained in this chapter is in the Pilot’s Operating Handbook and the FAA-approved Airplane Flight Manual (POH/AFM). Refer to Section 5—“Performance”, of the POH/AFM for information on flight planning and performance. CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 21 CREW RESOURCE MANAGEMENT CONTENTS Page INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................. 21-1 CREW CONCEPT BRIEFING GUIDE ............................................................................... 21-3 Description..................................................................................................................... 21-3 COMMON TERMS .............................................................................................................. 21-3 Pretakeoff Briefing (IFR/VFR)...................................................................................... 21-3 Crew Coordination Approach Sequence........................................................................ 21-5 ALTITUDE CALLOUTS...................................................................................................... 21-8 Enroute........................................................................................................................... 21-8 Approach—Precision..................................................................................................... 21-8 Approach—Nonprecision .............................................................................................. 21-9 Significant Deviation Callouts..................................................................................... 21-10 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-i CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ILLUSTRATIONS Figure Title Page 21-1 Situational Awareness in the Cockpit..................................................................... 21-2 21-2 Command and Leadership...................................................................................... 21-2 21-3 Communication Process......................................................................................... 21-4 21-4 Decision-Making Process....................................................................................... 21-4 21-5 Crew Performance Standards ................................................................................. 21-6 Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-iii CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CHAPTER 21 CREW RESOURCE MANAGEMENT INTRODUCTION This chapter describes crew resource management (CRM) program. Information is provided on the crew concept briefing guide and altitude callouts between pilots. Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CAPTAIN INDIVIDUAL S/A COPILOT INDIVIDUAL S/A GROUP S/A Remember 2+2=2 - or 2+2=5 (Synergy) IT's UP TO YOU! CLUES TO IDENTIFYING: HUMAN OPERATIONAL • Loss of Situational Awareness • Links in the Error Chain 1. FAILURE TO MEET TARGETS 2. UNDOCUMENTED PROCEDURE 3. DEPARTURE FROM SOP 4. VIOLATING MINIMUMS OR LIMITATIONS 5. NO ONE "FLYING AIRPLANE" 6. NO ONE "LOOKING OUT WINDOW" 7. COMMUNICATIONS 8. AMBIGUITY 9. UNRESOLVED DISCREPANCIES 10. PREOCCUPATION OR DISTRACTION 11. CONFUSION OR EMPTY FEELING 12. Figure 21-1. Situational Awareness in the Cockpit LEADERSHIP STYLES AUTOCRATIC AUTHORITARIAN STYLE LEADERSHIP (EXTREME) STYLE DEMOCRATIC LEADERSHIP STYLE LAISSEZFAIRE STYLE (EXTREME) PARTICIPATION LOW HIGH Command— Designated by Organization — Cannot be Shared Leadership — Shared among Crewmembers — Focuses on "What's right," not "Who's right" Figure 21-2. Command and Leadership 21-2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CREW CONCEPT BRIEFING GUIDE DESCRIPTION Experience has shown that adherence to SOPs helps to enhance individual and crew cockpit situational awareness and allows a higher performance level to be attained. Our objective is for standards to be agreed upon prior to flight and then adhered to, such that maximum crew performance is achieved. These procedures are not intended to supercede any individual company SOP, but rather are examples of good operating practices. COMMON TERMS PIC Pilot in Command Designated by the company for flights requiring more than one pilot. Responsible for conduct and safety of the flight. Designates pilot flying and pilot not flying duties. F Pilot Flying Controls the aircraft with respect to assigned airway, course, altitude, airspeed, etc., during normal and emergency conditions. Accomplishes other tasks as directed by the PIC. N Pilot Not Flying Maintains ATC communications, copies clearances, accomplishes checklists and other tasks as directed by the PIC. B Both PRETAKEOFF BRIEFING (IFR/VFR) NOTE The following briefing is to be completed during item 1 of the pretakeoff checklist. The pilot flying will accomplish the briefing. 1. Review the departure procedure (route and altitude, type of takeoff, significant terrain features, etc.) 2. Review anything out of the ordinary 3. Review required callouts, unless standard calls have been agreed upon, in which case a request for "Standard Callouts" may be used 4. Review the procedures to be used in case of an emergency on departure 5. As a final item, ask if there are any questions 6. State that the pretakeoff briefing is complete Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-3 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL EXTERNAL BARRIERS INTERNAL BARRIERS NEED SEND INTERNAL BARRIERS RECEIVE OPERATIONAL GOAL FEEDBACK ADVOCACY: to increase others' S/A • State Position • Suggest Solutions • Be Persistent and Focused • Listen Carefully THINK: • Solicit and give feedback • Listen carefully • Focus on behavior, not people • Maintain focus on the goal • Verify operation outcome is achieved INQUIRY: to increase your own S/A • Decide What, Whom, How to ask • Ask Clear, Concise Questions • Draw Conclusions from Valid Information • Keep an Open Mind — REMEMBER— Questions enhance communication flow. Don't give in to the temptation to ask questions when Advocacy is required. Use of Advocacy or inquiry should raise a "red flag." Figure 21-3. Communication Process EVALUATE RESULT RECOGNIZE NEED IDENTIFY AND DEFINE PROBLEM IMPLEMENT RESPONSE COLLECT FACTS SELECT A RESPONSE IDENTIFY ALTERNATIVES WEIGH IMPACT OF ALTERNATIVES HINTS: • Identify the problem: — Communicate it — Achieve agreement — Obtain commitment • Consider appropriate SOP's • Think beyond the obvious alternatives • Make decisions as a result of the process • Resist the temptation to make an immediate decision and then support it with facts Figure 21-4. Decision-Making Process 21-4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CREW COORDINATION APPROACH SEQUENCE NOTE The following crew coordination approach sequence must be completed as early as possible, prior to initiating an IFR approach. These items are accomplished during the “APPROACH (IN RANGE)” checklist. F—Requests the pilot not flying to obtain destination weather—Transfer of communication duties to the pilot flying can facilitate the accomplishment of this task. N—Advises the pilot of current destination weather, approach in use, and special information pertinent to the destination. F—Requests the pilot not flying to perform the approach setup. N—Accomplishes the approach setup and advises of frequency tuned, identified, and course set F—Transfers control of the aircraft to the pilot not flying, advising, “You have control, heading ____________ , altitude ____________ ” and special instructions. (Communications duties must be transferred back to the pilot not flying at this point.) N—Responds, “I have control, heading ___________ , altitude ___________ .” F—Advises, "Approach briefing." F—At the completion of the approach briefing, the pilot flying advises, “Approach briefing complete.” F—Advises, “I have control, heading ___________ , altitude ___________ .” N—Confirms “You have control, heading ___________, altitude ___________ .” F—“Before Landing checklist.” N—“Before Landing checklist complete.” NOTE The above sequence must be completed prior to the FAF. NOTE During the above sequence, the terms F and N have not been reversed during the time that transfer of control occurs. Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL SITUATIONAL AWARENESS a. Accomplishes appropriate preflight planning. b. Sets and monitors targets. c. Stays ahead of the aircraft by preparing for expected or contingency situations. d. Monitors weather, aircraft systems, instruments, and ATC communications. e. Shares relevant information with the rest of the crew. f. Uses advocacy/inquiry to maintain/regain situational awareness. g. Recognizes error chain clues and takes actions to break links in the chain. h. Communicates objectives and gains agreement when appropriate. i. Uses effective listening techniques to maintain/regain situational awareness. STRESS a. Recognizes symptoms of stress in self and others. b. Maintains composure, calmness, and rational decision making under stress. c. Adaptable to stressful situations/personalities. d. Uses stress management techniques to reduce effects of stress. e. Maintains open, clear lines of communications when under stress. COMMUNICATION a. Establishes open environment for interactive communication. b. Conducts adequate briefings to convey required information. c. Recognizes and works to overcome barriers to communications. d. Operational decisions are clearly stated to other crewmembers and acknowledged. e. Crewmembers are encouraged to state their own ideas, opinions, and recommendations. f. Crewmembers are encouraged to ask questions regarding crew actions. g. Assignments of blame is avoided. Focuses on WHAT is right, and not WHO is right. h. Keeps feedback loop active until operational goal/decision is achieved. i. Conducts debriefings to correct substandard/inappropriate performance and to reinforce desired performance. Figure 21-5. Crew Performance Standards (Sheet 1 of 2) 21-6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL SYNERGY AND CREW CONCEPT a. Ensures that group climate is appropriate to operational situation. b. Coordinates flight crew activities to achieve optimum performance. c. Uses effective team building techniques. d. Demonstrates effective leadership and motivation techniques. e. Uses all available resources. f. Adapt leadership style to meet operational and human requirements. WORKLOAD MANAGEMENT a. Communicates crew duties and receives acknowledgement. b. Sets priorities for crew activities. c. Recognizes and reports overloads in self and in others. d. Eliminates distractions in high workload situations. e. Maintains receptive attitude during high workload situations. f. Uses other crewmember. g. Avoids being a "one man show." DECISION MAKING a. Anticipates problems in advance. b. Uses SOPs in decision making process. c. Seeks information from all available resources when appropriate. d. Avoids biasing source of information. e. Considers and weighs impact of alternatives. f. Selects appropriate courses of action in a timely manner. g. Evaluates outcome and adjusts/reprioritizes. h. Recognizes stress factors when making decisions and adjusts accordingly. i. Avoids making a decision and then going in search of facts that support it. ADVANCED/AUTOMATED COCKPITS a. Follows automation related SOPs. b. Specifies pilot and copilot duties and responsibilities with regard to automation. c. Verbalizes and acknowledges entries and changes in flight operation. d. Verifies status and programming of automation. e. Selects appropriate levels of automation. f. Programs automation well in advance of maneuvers. g. Recognizes automation failure/invalid output indications. Figure 21-5. Crew Performance Standards (Sheet 2 of 2) Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-7 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ALTITUDE CALLOUTS ENROUTE 1,000 Feet Prior to Level-Off N F State altitude leaving and assigned level-off altitude “ROGER” “100 above/below” “LEVELING” APPROACH—PRECISION N F At 1,000 feet above minimums “1,000 feet above minimums” “DH __________” At 500 feet above minimums “500 feet above minimums” “NO FLAGS” At 100 feet above minimums “100 feet above minimums” “APPROACHING MINIMUMS” At decision height (DH) “Minimums, approach lights at “CONTINUING” (clock position)" OR “Minimums, runway at (clock position)” “CONTINUING” OR “Minimums, runway not in sight” 21-8 “GO AROUND” FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL APPROACH—NONPRECISION N F At 1,000 feet above minimums “1,000 feet above minimums” “MDA _____________” At 500 feet above minimums “500 feet above minimums” “NO FLAGS” At 100 feet above minimums “100 feet above minimums” “APPROACHING MINIMUMS” At minimum descent altitude (MDA) “Minimums” “LEVEL” At missed approach point (MAP) “Approach lights at (clock position)” “CONTINUING” OR “Runway at (clock position)” “CONTINUING” OR “Runway not in sight” Revision 0 “GO AROUND” FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 21-9 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL SIGNIFICANT DEVIATION CALLOUTS N F IAS ± 10 KIAS “VREF ± ______” “CORRECTING TO ________” Heading ±10° enroute, 5° on approach “Heading ________ degrees left/right “CORRECTING TO ________” Altitude ±100 feet enroute, +50/–0 feet on final approach “Altitude _________ high/low” “CORRECTING TO ________” CDI left or right one dot “Left/right of course ________ dot” “CORRECTING” RMI course left or right ±5° “Left/right of course ________ degrees” “CORRECTING” Vertical descent speed greater than 1,000 fpm on final approach “Sink rate _________” “CORRECTING” Bank in excess of 30° “Bank ________ degrees” 21-10 “CORRECTING” FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 0 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL WALKAROUND The following section is a pictorial walkaround. Each item listed in the exterior power-off preflight inspection is displayed. The foldout pages contain photographs that depict the specific area to be inspected. The general photographs contain circled numbers that correspond to specific steps displayed on the subsequent pages. Revision 0 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY WA-1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL LEFT SIDE 1 4 1. WING LIGHT—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION) 2. FUEL RESERVOIR DRAIN—DRAIN (USING FUEL SAMPLER) 3. MAIN LANDING GEAR—CHECK 4. INBOARD FUEL TANK SUMP AND EXTERNAL SUMP QUICK DRAIN VALVES—DRAIN (USING FUEL SAMPLER) 5 2 3 5. FILL DOOR AND SIGHT GAUGE—CHECK WA-2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL LEFT WING LEADING EDGE 5 3 2 4 6 8 7 1 WA-4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 1. WING TIE-DOWN—DISCONNECT 2. STALL WARNING VANE—CHECK 3. PITOT/STATIC TUBE—CHECK 4. LDG AND TAXI/RECOG LIGHTS—CHECK 5. FUEL QUANTITY—VISUALLY CHECK 6. FUEL FILLER CAP—SECURE FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 7. OUTBOARD FUEL TANK SUMP QUICK-DRAIN VALVE— DRAIN (USING FUEL SAMPLER) Revision 1 8. NAV AND STROBE LIGHTS—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND CLEANLINESS) FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY WA-5 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL LEFT WING TRAILING EDGE 1 2 3 4 5 6 1. FUEL TANK VENT—CHECK (VERIFY NO OBSTRUCTIONS) 2. AILERON AND SERVO TAB—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND SECURITY) 3. STATIC WICKS (4)—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION) 4. SPOILER—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND SECURITY) 5. FLAP LEADING EDGE VORTEX GENERATORS—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND SECURITY) WA-6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 6. FLAP—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND SECURITY) FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL WA-8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 7. NAV LIGHT—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND CLEANLINESS) 8. TAIL TIE-DOWN—DISCONNECT 9. OXYGEN FILLER DOOR (IF INSTALLED)—SECURE 10. PASSENGER ENTRY DOOR (IF INSTALLED)—CHECK (CONDITION AND SECURITY) Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY WA-9 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL RIGHT WING TRAILING EDGE 2 1 WA-10 4 5 1. FLAP—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND SECURITY) 2 SPOILER—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND SECURITY) 3. FLAP LEADING EDGE VORTEX GENERATORS—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND SECURITY) 4. AILERON AND TRIM TAB—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND SECURITY) 5. STATIC WICKS (4 TOTAL)—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION) 6. FUEL TANK VENT—CHECK (VERIFY NO OBSTRUCTIONS) 6 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL RIGHT WING LEADING EDGE 1 2 1. NAV AND STROBE LIGHTS—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND CLEANLINESS) 2 FUEL QUANTITY—VISUALLY CHECK 3. FUEL FILLER CAP—SECURE 4. OUTBOARD FUEL TANK SUMP QUICK-DRAIN VALVE— DRAIN (USING FUEL SAMPLER) 3 6 4 5 7 8 9 10 5. LND AND TAXI/RECOG LIGHTS—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND CLEANLINESS) WA-12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 6. PITOT/STATIC TUBE—CHECK (VERIFY SECURITY, OPENINGS FOR STOPPAGE, AND WARMTH) FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 7. RADOME (IF INSTALLED)—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND SECURITY) 8. WING TIE-DOWN—DISCONNECT 9. INBOARD FUEL TANK SUMP AND EXTERNAL SUMP QUICK-DRAIN VALVES—DRAIN (USING FUEL SAMPLER) 10. MAIN LANDING GEAR—CHECK (CHECK PROPER TIRE INFLATION AND CONDITION OF GEAR) Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY WA-13 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NOSE 1 7 2 1. RIGHT CREW DOOR—CLOSED 2 EXHAUST COVER (IF INSTALLED)—REMOVE 3. COWLING—OPEN (RIGHT SIDE OF UPPER COWLING FOR ACCESS AND CHECK CONDITION AND SECURITY) 4. ENGINE (RIGHT SIDE)—CHECK (VERIFY GENERAL CONDITION, SECURITY, FUEL AND OIL LEAKAGE, AND DAMAGE TO ANY COMPONENTS) 5. BATTERY—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND POWER CABLES SECURITY) 6. EXHAUST SYSTEM—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION, SECURITY, CRACKS, DISTORTION, AND DAMAGE) 6 23 24 25 3 4 5 6 WA-14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 7. COWLING—CLOSE AND LATCH (RIGHT SIDE) Revision 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY WA-15 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL NOSE 12 9 10 9 10 11 9. AIR INLET COVERS—REMOVE 8. PROPELLER ANCHOR—REMOVE 8 13 14 18 19 16 11. PROPELLER—CHECK 10. AIR INLETS—CHECK 22 17 15 21 20 WA-16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 12. PROPELLER SPINNER—CHECK (VERIFY CONDITION AND SECURITY) Revision 1 13. NOSE WHEEL STRUT AND TIRE—CHECK FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 14. COWLING—OPEN (LEFT SIDE OF UPPER COWLING FOR ACCESS AND CHECK CONDITION AND SECURITY) 15. ENGINE (LEFT SIDE)—CHECK (VERIFY GENERAL CONDITION, SECURITY, FUEL AND OIL LEAKAGE, AND DAMAGE TO ANY COMPONENTS) 16. INERTIAL SEPARATOR BYPASS OUTLET—CHECK CLOSED (VERIFY DUCT FREE OF DEBRIS) 17. OIL DIPSTICK/FILLER CAP—CHECK 18. ELECTRICAL POWER BOX CIRCUIT BREAKERS— CHECK IN (VERIFY ALL CIRCUIT BREAKERS, INCLUDING STANDBY ALTERNATOR ARE IN) 19. STANDBY ALTERNATOR AND BELT—CHECK (CONDITION) CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL 20. FUEL FILTER—CHECK FUEL FILTER BYPASS FLAG (FOR PROPER LOCATION–FLUSH) 22. COWLING—CLOSE AND LATCH (LEFT SIDE) FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY 24. FUEL DRAIN CAN—DRAIN (UNTIL EMPTY) Revision 1 21. BRAKE FLUID RESERVOIR—CHECK LEVEL 23. FUEL FILTER QUICK-DRAIN VALVE—DRAIN (USING FUEL SAMPLER) 25. FUEL PUMP DRAIN RESERVOIR—DRAIN (UNTIL EMPTY) FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY WA-17 CESSNA CARAVAN 208 GARMIN 1000 PILOT TRAINING MANUAL ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS CHAPTER 2 1. C 2. A 3. C 4. A 5. D 6. C 7. C 8. C CHAPTER 3 1. A 2. C 3. B 4. B 5. D CHAPTER 4 1. C 2. A CHAPTER 5 1. C 2. A 3. C 4. B 5. D 6. D 7. A CHAPTER 7 1. B 2. D 3. C 4. B 5. B 6. A 7. D 8. D 9. B 10. B 11. B 12. C Revision 0 CHAPTER 8 1. B 2. B 3. A 4. B 5. C CHAPTER 9 1. D 2. A 3. A 4. B CHAPTER 16 1. C 2. D 3. A 4. C 5. B 6. A 7. D CHAPTER 17 1. A CHAPTER 10 1. C 2. B 3. D 4. C 5. A 6. D 7. B 8. B 9. A CHAPTER 11 1. D 2. A 3. A 4. C CHAPTER 14 1. A 2. C 3. C CHAPTER 15 1. B 2. C 3. C 4. B FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY APP-1